arm_adi_v5: do not deactivate power domains while trying to clear sticky error
[openocd.git] / doc / openocd.texi
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c %**start of header
3 @setfilename openocd.info
4 @settitle OpenOCD User's Guide
5 @dircategory Development
6 @direntry
7 * OpenOCD: (openocd). OpenOCD User's Guide
8 @end direntry
9 @paragraphindent 0
10 @c %**end of header
11
12 @include version.texi
13
14 @copying
15
16 This User's Guide documents
17 release @value{VERSION},
18 dated @value{UPDATED},
19 of the Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD).
20
21 @itemize @bullet
22 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 The OpenOCD Project
23 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2007-2008 Spencer Oliver @email{spen@@spen-soft.co.uk}
24 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008-2010 Oyvind Harboe @email{oyvind.harboe@@zylin.com}
25 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2008 Duane Ellis @email{openocd@@duaneellis.com}
26 @item Copyright @copyright{} 2009-2010 David Brownell
27 @end itemize
28
29 @quotation
30 Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
31 under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.2 or
32 any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with no
33 Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no Back-Cover
34 Texts. A copy of the license is included in the section entitled ``GNU
35 Free Documentation License''.
36 @end quotation
37 @end copying
38
39 @titlepage
40 @titlefont{@emph{Open On-Chip Debugger:}}
41 @sp 1
42 @title OpenOCD User's Guide
43 @subtitle for release @value{VERSION}
44 @subtitle @value{UPDATED}
45
46 @page
47 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
48 @insertcopying
49 @end titlepage
50
51 @summarycontents
52 @contents
53
54 @ifnottex
55 @node Top
56 @top OpenOCD User's Guide
57
58 @insertcopying
59 @end ifnottex
60
61 @menu
62 * About:: About OpenOCD
63 * Developers:: OpenOCD Developer Resources
64 * Debug Adapter Hardware:: Debug Adapter Hardware
65 * About Jim-Tcl:: About Jim-Tcl
66 * Running:: Running OpenOCD
67 * OpenOCD Project Setup:: OpenOCD Project Setup
68 * Config File Guidelines:: Config File Guidelines
69 * Server Configuration:: Server Configuration
70 * Debug Adapter Configuration:: Debug Adapter Configuration
71 * Reset Configuration:: Reset Configuration
72 * TAP Declaration:: TAP Declaration
73 * CPU Configuration:: CPU Configuration
74 * Flash Commands:: Flash Commands
75 * Flash Programming:: Flash Programming
76 * PLD/FPGA Commands:: PLD/FPGA Commands
77 * General Commands:: General Commands
78 * Architecture and Core Commands:: Architecture and Core Commands
79 * JTAG Commands:: JTAG Commands
80 * Boundary Scan Commands:: Boundary Scan Commands
81 * Utility Commands:: Utility Commands
82 * TFTP:: TFTP
83 * GDB and OpenOCD:: Using GDB and OpenOCD
84 * Tcl Scripting API:: Tcl Scripting API
85 * FAQ:: Frequently Asked Questions
86 * Tcl Crash Course:: Tcl Crash Course
87 * License:: GNU Free Documentation License
88
89 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
90 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
91 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
92 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
93 * OpenOCD Concept Index:: Concept Index
94 * Command and Driver Index:: Command and Driver Index
95 @end menu
96
97 @node About
98 @unnumbered About
99 @cindex about
100
101 OpenOCD was created by Dominic Rath as part of a 2005 diploma thesis written
102 at the University of Applied Sciences Augsburg (@uref{http://www.hs-augsburg.de}).
103 Since that time, the project has grown into an active open-source project,
104 supported by a diverse community of software and hardware developers from
105 around the world.
106
107 @section What is OpenOCD?
108 @cindex TAP
109 @cindex JTAG
110
111 The Open On-Chip Debugger (OpenOCD) aims to provide debugging,
112 in-system programming and boundary-scan testing for embedded target
113 devices.
114
115 It does so with the assistance of a @dfn{debug adapter}, which is
116 a small hardware module which helps provide the right kind of
117 electrical signaling to the target being debugged. These are
118 required since the debug host (on which OpenOCD runs) won't
119 usually have native support for such signaling, or the connector
120 needed to hook up to the target.
121
122 Such debug adapters support one or more @dfn{transport} protocols,
123 each of which involves different electrical signaling (and uses
124 different messaging protocols on top of that signaling). There
125 are many types of debug adapter, and little uniformity in what
126 they are called. (There are also product naming differences.)
127
128 These adapters are sometimes packaged as discrete dongles, which
129 may generically be called @dfn{hardware interface dongles}.
130 Some development boards also integrate them directly, which may
131 let the development board connect directly to the debug
132 host over USB (and sometimes also to power it over USB).
133
134 For example, a @dfn{JTAG Adapter} supports JTAG
135 signaling, and is used to communicate
136 with JTAG (IEEE 1149.1) compliant TAPs on your target board.
137 A @dfn{TAP} is a ``Test Access Port'', a module which processes
138 special instructions and data. TAPs are daisy-chained within and
139 between chips and boards. JTAG supports debugging and boundary
140 scan operations.
141
142 There are also @dfn{SWD Adapters} that support Serial Wire Debug (SWD)
143 signaling to communicate with some newer ARM cores, as well as debug
144 adapters which support both JTAG and SWD transports. SWD supports only
145 debugging, whereas JTAG also supports boundary scan operations.
146
147 For some chips, there are also @dfn{Programming Adapters} supporting
148 special transports used only to write code to flash memory, without
149 support for on-chip debugging or boundary scan.
150 (At this writing, OpenOCD does not support such non-debug adapters.)
151
152
153 @b{Dongles:} OpenOCD currently supports many types of hardware dongles:
154 USB-based, parallel port-based, and other standalone boxes that run
155 OpenOCD internally. @xref{Debug Adapter Hardware}.
156
157 @b{GDB Debug:} It allows ARM7 (ARM7TDMI and ARM720t), ARM9 (ARM920T,
158 ARM922T, ARM926EJ--S, ARM966E--S), XScale (PXA25x, IXP42x), Cortex-M3
159 (Stellaris LM3, ST STM32 and Energy Micro EFM32) and Intel Quark (x10xx)
160 based cores to be debugged via the GDB protocol.
161
162 @b{Flash Programming:} Flash writing is supported for external
163 CFI-compatible NOR flashes (Intel and AMD/Spansion command set) and several
164 internal flashes (LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4300, AT91SAM7, AT91SAM3U,
165 STR7x, STR9x, LM3, STM32x and EFM32). Preliminary support for various NAND flash
166 controllers (LPC3180, Orion, S3C24xx, more) is included.
167
168 @section OpenOCD Web Site
169
170 The OpenOCD web site provides the latest public news from the community:
171
172 @uref{http://openocd.org/}
173
174 @section Latest User's Guide:
175
176 The user's guide you are now reading may not be the latest one
177 available. A version for more recent code may be available.
178 Its HTML form is published regularly at:
179
180 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/html/index.html}
181
182 PDF form is likewise published at:
183
184 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/pdf/openocd.pdf}
185
186 @section OpenOCD User's Forum
187
188 There is an OpenOCD forum (phpBB) hosted by SparkFun,
189 which might be helpful to you. Note that if you want
190 anything to come to the attention of developers, you
191 should post it to the OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
192 instead of this forum.
193
194 @uref{http://forum.sparkfun.com/viewforum.php?f=18}
195
196 @section OpenOCD User's Mailing List
197
198 The OpenOCD User Mailing List provides the primary means of
199 communication between users:
200
201 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-user}
202
203 @section OpenOCD IRC
204
205 Support can also be found on irc:
206 @uref{irc://irc.freenode.net/openocd}
207
208 @node Developers
209 @chapter OpenOCD Developer Resources
210 @cindex developers
211
212 If you are interested in improving the state of OpenOCD's debugging and
213 testing support, new contributions will be welcome. Motivated developers
214 can produce new target, flash or interface drivers, improve the
215 documentation, as well as more conventional bug fixes and enhancements.
216
217 The resources in this chapter are available for developers wishing to explore
218 or expand the OpenOCD source code.
219
220 @section OpenOCD Git Repository
221
222 During the 0.3.x release cycle, OpenOCD switched from Subversion to
223 a Git repository hosted at SourceForge. The repository URL is:
224
225 @uref{git://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
226
227 or via http
228
229 @uref{http://git.code.sf.net/p/openocd/code}
230
231 You may prefer to use a mirror and the HTTP protocol:
232
233 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/r/openocd.git}
234
235 With standard Git tools, use @command{git clone} to initialize
236 a local repository, and @command{git pull} to update it.
237 There are also gitweb pages letting you browse the repository
238 with a web browser, or download arbitrary snapshots without
239 needing a Git client:
240
241 @uref{http://repo.or.cz/w/openocd.git}
242
243 The @file{README} file contains the instructions for building the project
244 from the repository or a snapshot.
245
246 Developers that want to contribute patches to the OpenOCD system are
247 @b{strongly} encouraged to work against mainline.
248 Patches created against older versions may require additional
249 work from their submitter in order to be updated for newer releases.
250
251 @section Doxygen Developer Manual
252
253 During the 0.2.x release cycle, the OpenOCD project began
254 providing a Doxygen reference manual. This document contains more
255 technical information about the software internals, development
256 processes, and similar documentation:
257
258 @uref{http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/html/index.html}
259
260 This document is a work-in-progress, but contributions would be welcome
261 to fill in the gaps. All of the source files are provided in-tree,
262 listed in the Doxyfile configuration at the top of the source tree.
263
264 @section Gerrit Review System
265
266 All changes in the OpenOCD Git repository go through the web-based Gerrit
267 Code Review System:
268
269 @uref{http://openocd.zylin.com/}
270
271 After a one-time registration and repository setup, anyone can push commits
272 from their local Git repository directly into Gerrit.
273 All users and developers are encouraged to review, test, discuss and vote
274 for changes in Gerrit. The feedback provides the basis for a maintainer to
275 eventually submit the change to the main Git repository.
276
277 The @file{HACKING} file, also available as the Patch Guide in the Doxygen
278 Developer Manual, contains basic information about how to connect a
279 repository to Gerrit, prepare and push patches. Patch authors are expected to
280 maintain their changes while they're in Gerrit, respond to feedback and if
281 necessary rework and push improved versions of the change.
282
283 @section OpenOCD Developer Mailing List
284
285 The OpenOCD Developer Mailing List provides the primary means of
286 communication between developers:
287
288 @uref{https://lists.sourceforge.net/mailman/listinfo/openocd-devel}
289
290 @section OpenOCD Bug Tracker
291
292 The OpenOCD Bug Tracker is hosted on SourceForge:
293
294 @uref{http://bugs.openocd.org/}
295
296
297 @node Debug Adapter Hardware
298 @chapter Debug Adapter Hardware
299 @cindex dongles
300 @cindex FTDI
301 @cindex wiggler
302 @cindex zy1000
303 @cindex printer port
304 @cindex USB Adapter
305 @cindex RTCK
306
307 Defined: @b{dongle}: A small device that plugs into a computer and serves as
308 an adapter .... [snip]
309
310 In the OpenOCD case, this generally refers to @b{a small adapter} that
311 attaches to your computer via USB or the parallel port. One
312 exception is the Ultimate Solutions ZY1000, packaged as a small box you
313 attach via an ethernet cable. The ZY1000 has the advantage that it does not
314 require any drivers to be installed on the developer PC. It also has
315 a built in web interface. It supports RTCK/RCLK or adaptive clocking
316 and has a built-in relay to power cycle targets remotely.
317
318
319 @section Choosing a Dongle
320
321 There are several things you should keep in mind when choosing a dongle.
322
323 @enumerate
324 @item @b{Transport} Does it support the kind of communication that you need?
325 OpenOCD focusses mostly on JTAG. Your version may also support
326 other ways to communicate with target devices.
327 @item @b{Voltage} What voltage is your target - 1.8, 2.8, 3.3, or 5V?
328 Does your dongle support it? You might need a level converter.
329 @item @b{Pinout} What pinout does your target board use?
330 Does your dongle support it? You may be able to use jumper
331 wires, or an "octopus" connector, to convert pinouts.
332 @item @b{Connection} Does your computer have the USB, parallel, or
333 Ethernet port needed?
334 @item @b{RTCK} Do you expect to use it with ARM chips and boards with
335 RTCK support (also known as ``adaptive clocking'')?
336 @end enumerate
337
338 @section Stand-alone JTAG Probe
339
340 The ZY1000 from Ultimate Solutions is technically not a dongle but a
341 stand-alone JTAG probe that, unlike most dongles, doesn't require any drivers
342 running on the developer's host computer.
343 Once installed on a network using DHCP or a static IP assignment, users can
344 access the ZY1000 probe locally or remotely from any host with access to the
345 IP address assigned to the probe.
346 The ZY1000 provides an intuitive web interface with direct access to the
347 OpenOCD debugger.
348 Users may also run a GDBSERVER directly on the ZY1000 to take full advantage
349 of GCC & GDB to debug any distribution of embedded Linux or NetBSD running on
350 the target.
351 The ZY1000 supports RTCK & RCLK or adaptive clocking and has a built-in relay
352 to power cycle the target remotely.
353
354 For more information, visit:
355
356 @b{ZY1000} See: @url{http://www.ultsol.com/index.php/component/content/article/8/210-zylin-zy1000-main}
357
358 @section USB FT2232 Based
359
360 There are many USB JTAG dongles on the market, many of them based
361 on a chip from ``Future Technology Devices International'' (FTDI)
362 known as the FTDI FT2232; this is a USB full speed (12 Mbps) chip.
363 See: @url{http://www.ftdichip.com} for more information.
364 In summer 2009, USB high speed (480 Mbps) versions of these FTDI
365 chips started to become available in JTAG adapters. Around 2012, a new
366 variant appeared - FT232H - this is a single-channel version of FT2232H.
367 (Adapters using those high speed FT2232H or FT232H chips may support adaptive
368 clocking.)
369
370 The FT2232 chips are flexible enough to support some other
371 transport options, such as SWD or the SPI variants used to
372 program some chips. They have two communications channels,
373 and one can be used for a UART adapter at the same time the
374 other one is used to provide a debug adapter.
375
376 Also, some development boards integrate an FT2232 chip to serve as
377 a built-in low-cost debug adapter and USB-to-serial solution.
378
379 @itemize @bullet
380 @item @b{usbjtag}
381 @* Link @url{http://elk.informatik.fh-augsburg.de/hhweb/doc/openocd/usbjtag/usbjtag.html}
382 @item @b{jtagkey}
383 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey.shtml}
384 @item @b{jtagkey2}
385 @* See: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtagkey2.shtml}
386 @item @b{oocdlink}
387 @* See: @url{http://www.oocdlink.com} By Joern Kaipf
388 @item @b{signalyzer}
389 @* See: @url{http://www.signalyzer.com}
390 @item @b{Stellaris Eval Boards}
391 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - The Stellaris eval boards
392 bundle FT2232-based JTAG and SWD support, which can be used to debug
393 the Stellaris chips. Using separate JTAG adapters is optional.
394 These boards can also be used in a "pass through" mode as JTAG adapters
395 to other target boards, disabling the Stellaris chip.
396 @item @b{TI/Luminary ICDI}
397 @* See: @url{http://www.ti.com} - TI/Luminary In-Circuit Debug
398 Interface (ICDI) Boards are included in Stellaris LM3S9B9x
399 Evaluation Kits. Like the non-detachable FT2232 support on the other
400 Stellaris eval boards, they can be used to debug other target boards.
401 @item @b{olimex-jtag}
402 @* See: @url{http://www.olimex.com}
403 @item @b{Flyswatter/Flyswatter2}
404 @* See: @url{http://www.tincantools.com}
405 @item @b{turtelizer2}
406 @* See:
407 @uref{http://www.ethernut.de/en/hardware/turtelizer/index.html, Turtelizer 2}, or
408 @url{http://www.ethernut.de}
409 @item @b{comstick}
410 @* Link: @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=383}
411 @item @b{stm32stick}
412 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/stm32-stick}
413 @item @b{axm0432_jtag}
414 @* Axiom AXM-0432 Link @url{http://www.axman.com} - NOTE: This JTAG does not appear
415 to be available anymore as of April 2012.
416 @item @b{cortino}
417 @* Link @url{http://www.hitex.com/index.php?id=cortino}
418 @item @b{dlp-usb1232h}
419 @* Link @url{http://www.dlpdesign.com/usb/usb1232h.shtml}
420 @item @b{digilent-hs1}
421 @* Link @url{http://www.digilentinc.com/Products/Detail.cfm?Prod=JTAG-HS1}
422 @item @b{opendous}
423 @* Link @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous/wiki/JTAG} FT2232H-based
424 (OpenHardware).
425 @item @b{JTAG-lock-pick Tiny 2}
426 @* Link @url{http://www.distortec.com/jtag-lock-pick-tiny-2} FT232H-based
427
428 @item @b{GW16042}
429 @* Link: @url{http://shop.gateworks.com/index.php?route=product/product&path=70_80&product_id=64}
430 FT2232H-based
431
432 @end itemize
433 @section USB-JTAG / Altera USB-Blaster compatibles
434
435 These devices also show up as FTDI devices, but are not
436 protocol-compatible with the FT2232 devices. They are, however,
437 protocol-compatible among themselves. USB-JTAG devices typically consist
438 of a FT245 followed by a CPLD that understands a particular protocol,
439 or emulates this protocol using some other hardware.
440
441 They may appear under different USB VID/PID depending on the particular
442 product. The driver can be configured to search for any VID/PID pair
443 (see the section on driver commands).
444
445 @itemize
446 @item @b{USB-JTAG} Kolja Waschk's USB Blaster-compatible adapter
447 @* Link: @url{http://ixo-jtag.sourceforge.net/}
448 @item @b{Altera USB-Blaster}
449 @* Link: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_usb_blstr.pdf}
450 @end itemize
451
452 @section USB J-Link based
453 There are several OEM versions of the SEGGER @b{J-Link} adapter. It is
454 an example of a microcontroller based JTAG adapter, it uses an
455 AT91SAM764 internally.
456
457 @itemize @bullet
458 @item @b{SEGGER J-Link}
459 @* Link: @url{http://www.segger.com/jlink.html}
460 @item @b{Atmel SAM-ICE} (Only works with Atmel chips!)
461 @* Link: @url{http://www.atmel.com/tools/atmelsam-ice.aspx}
462 @item @b{IAR J-Link}
463 @end itemize
464
465 @section USB RLINK based
466 Raisonance has an adapter called @b{RLink}. It exists in a stripped-down form on the STM32 Primer,
467 permanently attached to the JTAG lines. It also exists on the STM32 Primer2, but that is wired for
468 SWD and not JTAG, thus not supported.
469
470 @itemize @bullet
471 @item @b{Raisonance RLink}
472 @* Link: @url{http://www.mcu-raisonance.com/~rlink-debugger-programmer__@/microcontrollers__tool~tool__T018:4cn9ziz4bnx6.html}
473 @item @b{STM32 Primer}
474 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer.php}
475 @item @b{STM32 Primer2}
476 @* Link: @url{http://www.stm32circle.com/resources/stm32primer2.php}
477 @end itemize
478
479 @section USB ST-LINK based
480 ST Micro has an adapter called @b{ST-LINK}.
481 They only work with ST Micro chips, notably STM32 and STM8.
482
483 @itemize @bullet
484 @item @b{ST-LINK}
485 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32VLDISCOVERY.
486 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/219866.jsp}
487 @item @b{ST-LINK/V2}
488 @* This is available standalone and as part of some kits, eg. STM32F4DISCOVERY.
489 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/evalboard/product/251168.jsp}
490 @end itemize
491
492 For info the original ST-LINK enumerates using the mass storage usb class; however,
493 its implementation is completely broken. The result is this causes issues under Linux.
494 The simplest solution is to get Linux to ignore the ST-LINK using one of the following methods:
495 @itemize @bullet
496 @item modprobe -r usb-storage && modprobe usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i
497 @item add "options usb-storage quirks=483:3744:i" to /etc/modprobe.conf
498 @end itemize
499
500 @section USB TI/Stellaris ICDI based
501 Texas Instruments has an adapter called @b{ICDI}.
502 It is not to be confused with the FTDI based adapters that were originally fitted to their
503 evaluation boards. This is the adapter fitted to the Stellaris LaunchPad.
504
505 @section USB CMSIS-DAP based
506 ARM has released a interface standard called CMSIS-DAP that simplifies connecting
507 debuggers to ARM Cortex based targets @url{http://www.keil.com/support/man/docs/dapdebug/dapdebug_introduction.htm}.
508
509 @section USB Other
510 @itemize @bullet
511 @item @b{USBprog}
512 @* Link: @url{http://shop.embedded-projects.net/} - which uses an Atmel MEGA32 and a UBN9604
513
514 @item @b{USB - Presto}
515 @* Link: @url{http://tools.asix.net/prg_presto.htm}
516
517 @item @b{Versaloon-Link}
518 @* Link: @url{http://www.versaloon.com}
519
520 @item @b{ARM-JTAG-EW}
521 @* Link: @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag-ew.html}
522
523 @item @b{Buspirate}
524 @* Link: @url{http://dangerousprototypes.com/bus-pirate-manual/}
525
526 @item @b{opendous}
527 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/opendous-jtag/} - which uses an AT90USB162
528
529 @item @b{estick}
530 @* Link: @url{http://code.google.com/p/estick-jtag/}
531
532 @item @b{Keil ULINK v1}
533 @* Link: @url{http://www.keil.com/ulink1/}
534
535 @item @b{TI XDS110 Debug Probe}
536 @* The XDS110 is included as the embedded debug probe on many Texas Instruments
537 LaunchPad evaluation boards.
538 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS110}
539 @* Link: @url{http://processors.wiki.ti.com/index.php/XDS_Emulation_Software_Package#XDS110_Support_Utilities}
540 @end itemize
541
542 @section IBM PC Parallel Printer Port Based
543
544 The two well-known ``JTAG Parallel Ports'' cables are the Xilinx DLC5
545 and the Macraigor Wiggler. There are many clones and variations of
546 these on the market.
547
548 Note that parallel ports are becoming much less common, so if you
549 have the choice you should probably avoid these adapters in favor
550 of USB-based ones.
551
552 @itemize @bullet
553
554 @item @b{Wiggler} - There are many clones of this.
555 @* Link: @url{http://www.macraigor.com/wiggler.htm}
556
557 @item @b{DLC5} - From XILINX - There are many clones of this
558 @* Link: Search the web for: ``XILINX DLC5'' - it is no longer
559 produced, PDF schematics are easily found and it is easy to make.
560
561 @item @b{Amontec - JTAG Accelerator}
562 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/jtag_accelerator.shtml}
563
564 @item @b{Wiggler2}
565 @* Link: @url{http://www.ccac.rwth-aachen.de/~michaels/index.php/hardware/armjtag}
566
567 @item @b{Wiggler_ntrst_inverted}
568 @* Yet another variation - See the source code, src/jtag/parport.c
569
570 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler}
571 @* Unknown - probably not on the market today
572
573 @item @b{arm-jtag}
574 @* Link: Most likely @url{http://www.olimex.com/dev/arm-jtag.html} [another wiggler clone]
575
576 @item @b{chameleon}
577 @* Link: @url{http://www.amontec.com/chameleon.shtml}
578
579 @item @b{Triton}
580 @* Unknown.
581
582 @item @b{Lattice}
583 @* ispDownload from Lattice Semiconductor
584 @url{http://www.latticesemi.com/lit/docs/@/devtools/dlcable.pdf}
585
586 @item @b{flashlink}
587 @* From STMicroelectronics;
588 @* Link: @url{http://www.st.com/internet/com/TECHNICAL_RESOURCES/TECHNICAL_LITERATURE/DATA_BRIEF/DM00039500.pdf}
589
590 @end itemize
591
592 @section Other...
593 @itemize @bullet
594
595 @item @b{ep93xx}
596 @* An EP93xx based Linux machine using the GPIO pins directly.
597
598 @item @b{at91rm9200}
599 @* Like the EP93xx - but an ATMEL AT91RM9200 based solution using the GPIO pins on the chip.
600
601 @item @b{bcm2835gpio}
602 @* A BCM2835-based board (e.g. Raspberry Pi) using the GPIO pins of the expansion header.
603
604 @item @b{imx_gpio}
605 @* A NXP i.MX-based board (e.g. Wandboard) using the GPIO pins (should work on any i.MX processor).
606
607 @item @b{jtag_vpi}
608 @* A JTAG driver acting as a client for the JTAG VPI server interface.
609 @* Link: @url{http://github.com/fjullien/jtag_vpi}
610
611 @end itemize
612
613 @node About Jim-Tcl
614 @chapter About Jim-Tcl
615 @cindex Jim-Tcl
616 @cindex tcl
617
618 OpenOCD uses a small ``Tcl Interpreter'' known as Jim-Tcl.
619 This programming language provides a simple and extensible
620 command interpreter.
621
622 All commands presented in this Guide are extensions to Jim-Tcl.
623 You can use them as simple commands, without needing to learn
624 much of anything about Tcl.
625 Alternatively, you can write Tcl programs with them.
626
627 You can learn more about Jim at its website, @url{http://jim.tcl.tk}.
628 There is an active and responsive community, get on the mailing list
629 if you have any questions. Jim-Tcl maintainers also lurk on the
630 OpenOCD mailing list.
631
632 @itemize @bullet
633 @item @b{Jim vs. Tcl}
634 @* Jim-Tcl is a stripped down version of the well known Tcl language,
635 which can be found here: @url{http://www.tcl.tk}. Jim-Tcl has far
636 fewer features. Jim-Tcl is several dozens of .C files and .H files and
637 implements the basic Tcl command set. In contrast: Tcl 8.6 is a
638 4.2 MB .zip file containing 1540 files.
639
640 @item @b{Missing Features}
641 @* Our practice has been: Add/clone the real Tcl feature if/when
642 needed. We welcome Jim-Tcl improvements, not bloat. Also there
643 are a large number of optional Jim-Tcl features that are not
644 enabled in OpenOCD.
645
646 @item @b{Scripts}
647 @* OpenOCD configuration scripts are Jim-Tcl Scripts. OpenOCD's
648 command interpreter today is a mixture of (newer)
649 Jim-Tcl commands, and the (older) original command interpreter.
650
651 @item @b{Commands}
652 @* At the OpenOCD telnet command line (or via the GDB monitor command) one
653 can type a Tcl for() loop, set variables, etc.
654 Some of the commands documented in this guide are implemented
655 as Tcl scripts, from a @file{startup.tcl} file internal to the server.
656
657 @item @b{Historical Note}
658 @* Jim-Tcl was introduced to OpenOCD in spring 2008. Fall 2010,
659 before OpenOCD 0.5 release, OpenOCD switched to using Jim-Tcl
660 as a Git submodule, which greatly simplified upgrading Jim-Tcl
661 to benefit from new features and bugfixes in Jim-Tcl.
662
663 @item @b{Need a crash course in Tcl?}
664 @*@xref{Tcl Crash Course}.
665 @end itemize
666
667 @node Running
668 @chapter Running
669 @cindex command line options
670 @cindex logfile
671 @cindex directory search
672
673 Properly installing OpenOCD sets up your operating system to grant it access
674 to the debug adapters. On Linux, this usually involves installing a file
675 in @file{/etc/udev/rules.d,} so OpenOCD has permissions. An example rules file
676 that works for many common adapters is shipped with OpenOCD in the
677 @file{contrib} directory. MS-Windows needs
678 complex and confusing driver configuration for every peripheral. Such issues
679 are unique to each operating system, and are not detailed in this User's Guide.
680
681 Then later you will invoke the OpenOCD server, with various options to
682 tell it how each debug session should work.
683 The @option{--help} option shows:
684 @verbatim
685 bash$ openocd --help
686
687 --help | -h display this help
688 --version | -v display OpenOCD version
689 --file | -f use configuration file <name>
690 --search | -s dir to search for config files and scripts
691 --debug | -d set debug level to 3
692 | -d<n> set debug level to <level>
693 --log_output | -l redirect log output to file <name>
694 --command | -c run <command>
695 @end verbatim
696
697 If you don't give any @option{-f} or @option{-c} options,
698 OpenOCD tries to read the configuration file @file{openocd.cfg}.
699 To specify one or more different
700 configuration files, use @option{-f} options. For example:
701
702 @example
703 openocd -f config1.cfg -f config2.cfg -f config3.cfg
704 @end example
705
706 Configuration files and scripts are searched for in
707 @enumerate
708 @item the current directory,
709 @item any search dir specified on the command line using the @option{-s} option,
710 @item any search dir specified using the @command{add_script_search_dir} command,
711 @item @file{$HOME/.openocd} (not on Windows),
712 @item a directory in the @env{OPENOCD_SCRIPTS} environment variable (if set),
713 @item the site wide script library @file{$pkgdatadir/site} and
714 @item the OpenOCD-supplied script library @file{$pkgdatadir/scripts}.
715 @end enumerate
716 The first found file with a matching file name will be used.
717
718 @quotation Note
719 Don't try to use configuration script names or paths which
720 include the "#" character. That character begins Tcl comments.
721 @end quotation
722
723 @section Simple setup, no customization
724
725 In the best case, you can use two scripts from one of the script
726 libraries, hook up your JTAG adapter, and start the server ... and
727 your JTAG setup will just work "out of the box". Always try to
728 start by reusing those scripts, but assume you'll need more
729 customization even if this works. @xref{OpenOCD Project Setup}.
730
731 If you find a script for your JTAG adapter, and for your board or
732 target, you may be able to hook up your JTAG adapter then start
733 the server with some variation of one of the following:
734
735 @example
736 openocd -f interface/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
737 openocd -f interface/ftdi/ADAPTER.cfg -f board/MYBOARD.cfg
738 @end example
739
740 You might also need to configure which reset signals are present,
741 using @option{-c 'reset_config trst_and_srst'} or something similar.
742 If all goes well you'll see output something like
743
744 @example
745 Open On-Chip Debugger 0.4.0 (2010-01-14-15:06)
746 For bug reports, read
747 http://openocd.org/doc/doxygen/bugs.html
748 Info : JTAG tap: lm3s.cpu tap/device found: 0x3ba00477
749 (mfg: 0x23b, part: 0xba00, ver: 0x3)
750 @end example
751
752 Seeing that "tap/device found" message, and no warnings, means
753 the JTAG communication is working. That's a key milestone, but
754 you'll probably need more project-specific setup.
755
756 @section What OpenOCD does as it starts
757
758 OpenOCD starts by processing the configuration commands provided
759 on the command line or, if there were no @option{-c command} or
760 @option{-f file.cfg} options given, in @file{openocd.cfg}.
761 @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage}.
762 At the end of the configuration stage it verifies the JTAG scan
763 chain defined using those commands; your configuration should
764 ensure that this always succeeds.
765 Normally, OpenOCD then starts running as a server.
766 Alternatively, commands may be used to terminate the configuration
767 stage early, perform work (such as updating some flash memory),
768 and then shut down without acting as a server.
769
770 Once OpenOCD starts running as a server, it waits for connections from
771 clients (Telnet, GDB, RPC) and processes the commands issued through
772 those channels.
773
774 If you are having problems, you can enable internal debug messages via
775 the @option{-d} option.
776
777 Also it is possible to interleave Jim-Tcl commands w/config scripts using the
778 @option{-c} command line switch.
779
780 To enable debug output (when reporting problems or working on OpenOCD
781 itself), use the @option{-d} command line switch. This sets the
782 @option{debug_level} to "3", outputting the most information,
783 including debug messages. The default setting is "2", outputting only
784 informational messages, warnings and errors. You can also change this
785 setting from within a telnet or gdb session using @command{debug_level<n>}
786 (@pxref{debuglevel,,debug_level}).
787
788 You can redirect all output from the server to a file using the
789 @option{-l <logfile>} switch.
790
791 Note! OpenOCD will launch the GDB & telnet server even if it can not
792 establish a connection with the target. In general, it is possible for
793 the JTAG controller to be unresponsive until the target is set up
794 correctly via e.g. GDB monitor commands in a GDB init script.
795
796 @node OpenOCD Project Setup
797 @chapter OpenOCD Project Setup
798
799 To use OpenOCD with your development projects, you need to do more than
800 just connect the JTAG adapter hardware (dongle) to your development board
801 and start the OpenOCD server.
802 You also need to configure your OpenOCD server so that it knows
803 about your adapter and board, and helps your work.
804 You may also want to connect OpenOCD to GDB, possibly
805 using Eclipse or some other GUI.
806
807 @section Hooking up the JTAG Adapter
808
809 Today's most common case is a dongle with a JTAG cable on one side
810 (such as a ribbon cable with a 10-pin or 20-pin IDC connector)
811 and a USB cable on the other.
812 Instead of USB, some cables use Ethernet;
813 older ones may use a PC parallel port, or even a serial port.
814
815 @enumerate
816 @item @emph{Start with power to your target board turned off},
817 and nothing connected to your JTAG adapter.
818 If you're particularly paranoid, unplug power to the board.
819 It's important to have the ground signal properly set up,
820 unless you are using a JTAG adapter which provides
821 galvanic isolation between the target board and the
822 debugging host.
823
824 @item @emph{Be sure it's the right kind of JTAG connector.}
825 If your dongle has a 20-pin ARM connector, you need some kind
826 of adapter (or octopus, see below) to hook it up to
827 boards using 14-pin or 10-pin connectors ... or to 20-pin
828 connectors which don't use ARM's pinout.
829
830 In the same vein, make sure the voltage levels are compatible.
831 Not all JTAG adapters have the level shifters needed to work
832 with 1.2 Volt boards.
833
834 @item @emph{Be certain the cable is properly oriented} or you might
835 damage your board. In most cases there are only two possible
836 ways to connect the cable.
837 Connect the JTAG cable from your adapter to the board.
838 Be sure it's firmly connected.
839
840 In the best case, the connector is keyed to physically
841 prevent you from inserting it wrong.
842 This is most often done using a slot on the board's male connector
843 housing, which must match a key on the JTAG cable's female connector.
844 If there's no housing, then you must look carefully and
845 make sure pin 1 on the cable hooks up to pin 1 on the board.
846 Ribbon cables are frequently all grey except for a wire on one
847 edge, which is red. The red wire is pin 1.
848
849 Sometimes dongles provide cables where one end is an ``octopus'' of
850 color coded single-wire connectors, instead of a connector block.
851 These are great when converting from one JTAG pinout to another,
852 but are tedious to set up.
853 Use these with connector pinout diagrams to help you match up the
854 adapter signals to the right board pins.
855
856 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's other end} once the JTAG cable is connected.
857 A USB, parallel, or serial port connector will go to the host which
858 you are using to run OpenOCD.
859 For Ethernet, consult the documentation and your network administrator.
860
861 For USB-based JTAG adapters you have an easy sanity check at this point:
862 does the host operating system see the JTAG adapter? If you're running
863 Linux, try the @command{lsusb} command. If that host is an
864 MS-Windows host, you'll need to install a driver before OpenOCD works.
865
866 @item @emph{Connect the adapter's power supply, if needed.}
867 This step is primarily for non-USB adapters,
868 but sometimes USB adapters need extra power.
869
870 @item @emph{Power up the target board.}
871 Unless you just let the magic smoke escape,
872 you're now ready to set up the OpenOCD server
873 so you can use JTAG to work with that board.
874
875 @end enumerate
876
877 Talk with the OpenOCD server using
878 telnet (@code{telnet localhost 4444} on many systems) or GDB.
879 @xref{GDB and OpenOCD}.
880
881 @section Project Directory
882
883 There are many ways you can configure OpenOCD and start it up.
884
885 A simple way to organize them all involves keeping a
886 single directory for your work with a given board.
887 When you start OpenOCD from that directory,
888 it searches there first for configuration files, scripts,
889 files accessed through semihosting,
890 and for code you upload to the target board.
891 It is also the natural place to write files,
892 such as log files and data you download from the board.
893
894 @section Configuration Basics
895
896 There are two basic ways of configuring OpenOCD, and
897 a variety of ways you can mix them.
898 Think of the difference as just being how you start the server:
899
900 @itemize
901 @item Many @option{-f file} or @option{-c command} options on the command line
902 @item No options, but a @dfn{user config file}
903 in the current directory named @file{openocd.cfg}
904 @end itemize
905
906 Here is an example @file{openocd.cfg} file for a setup
907 using a Signalyzer FT2232-based JTAG adapter to talk to
908 a board with an Atmel AT91SAM7X256 microcontroller:
909
910 @example
911 source [find interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg]
912
913 # GDB can also flash my flash!
914 gdb_memory_map enable
915 gdb_flash_program enable
916
917 source [find target/sam7x256.cfg]
918 @end example
919
920 Here is the command line equivalent of that configuration:
921
922 @example
923 openocd -f interface/ftdi/signalyzer.cfg \
924 -c "gdb_memory_map enable" \
925 -c "gdb_flash_program enable" \
926 -f target/sam7x256.cfg
927 @end example
928
929 You could wrap such long command lines in shell scripts,
930 each supporting a different development task.
931 One might re-flash the board with a specific firmware version.
932 Another might set up a particular debugging or run-time environment.
933
934 @quotation Important
935 At this writing (October 2009) the command line method has
936 problems with how it treats variables.
937 For example, after @option{-c "set VAR value"}, or doing the
938 same in a script, the variable @var{VAR} will have no value
939 that can be tested in a later script.
940 @end quotation
941
942 Here we will focus on the simpler solution: one user config
943 file, including basic configuration plus any TCL procedures
944 to simplify your work.
945
946 @section User Config Files
947 @cindex config file, user
948 @cindex user config file
949 @cindex config file, overview
950
951 A user configuration file ties together all the parts of a project
952 in one place.
953 One of the following will match your situation best:
954
955 @itemize
956 @item Ideally almost everything comes from configuration files
957 provided by someone else.
958 For example, OpenOCD distributes a @file{scripts} directory
959 (probably in @file{/usr/share/openocd/scripts} on Linux).
960 Board and tool vendors can provide these too, as can individual
961 user sites; the @option{-s} command line option lets you say
962 where to find these files. (@xref{Running}.)
963 The AT91SAM7X256 example above works this way.
964
965 Three main types of non-user configuration file each have their
966 own subdirectory in the @file{scripts} directory:
967
968 @enumerate
969 @item @b{interface} -- one for each different debug adapter;
970 @item @b{board} -- one for each different board
971 @item @b{target} -- the chips which integrate CPUs and other JTAG TAPs
972 @end enumerate
973
974 Best case: include just two files, and they handle everything else.
975 The first is an interface config file.
976 The second is board-specific, and it sets up the JTAG TAPs and
977 their GDB targets (by deferring to some @file{target.cfg} file),
978 declares all flash memory, and leaves you nothing to do except
979 meet your deadline:
980
981 @example
982 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
983 source [find board/csb337.cfg]
984 @end example
985
986 Boards with a single microcontroller often won't need more
987 than the target config file, as in the AT91SAM7X256 example.
988 That's because there is no external memory (flash, DDR RAM), and
989 the board differences are encapsulated by application code.
990
991 @item Maybe you don't know yet what your board looks like to JTAG.
992 Once you know the @file{interface.cfg} file to use, you may
993 need help from OpenOCD to discover what's on the board.
994 Once you find the JTAG TAPs, you can just search for appropriate
995 target and board
996 configuration files ... or write your own, from the bottom up.
997 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
998
999 @item You can often reuse some standard config files but
1000 need to write a few new ones, probably a @file{board.cfg} file.
1001 You will be using commands described later in this User's Guide,
1002 and working with the guidelines in the next chapter.
1003
1004 For example, there may be configuration files for your JTAG adapter
1005 and target chip, but you need a new board-specific config file
1006 giving access to your particular flash chips.
1007 Or you might need to write another target chip configuration file
1008 for a new chip built around the Cortex-M3 core.
1009
1010 @quotation Note
1011 When you write new configuration files, please submit
1012 them for inclusion in the next OpenOCD release.
1013 For example, a @file{board/newboard.cfg} file will help the
1014 next users of that board, and a @file{target/newcpu.cfg}
1015 will help support users of any board using that chip.
1016 @end quotation
1017
1018 @item
1019 You may may need to write some C code.
1020 It may be as simple as supporting a new FT2232 or parport
1021 based adapter; a bit more involved, like a NAND or NOR flash
1022 controller driver; or a big piece of work like supporting
1023 a new chip architecture.
1024 @end itemize
1025
1026 Reuse the existing config files when you can.
1027 Look first in the @file{scripts/boards} area, then @file{scripts/targets}.
1028 You may find a board configuration that's a good example to follow.
1029
1030 When you write config files, separate the reusable parts
1031 (things every user of that interface, chip, or board needs)
1032 from ones specific to your environment and debugging approach.
1033 @itemize
1034
1035 @item
1036 For example, a @code{gdb-attach} event handler that invokes
1037 the @command{reset init} command will interfere with debugging
1038 early boot code, which performs some of the same actions
1039 that the @code{reset-init} event handler does.
1040
1041 @item
1042 Likewise, the @command{arm9 vector_catch} command (or
1043 @cindex vector_catch
1044 its siblings @command{xscale vector_catch}
1045 and @command{cortex_m vector_catch}) can be a time-saver
1046 during some debug sessions, but don't make everyone use that either.
1047 Keep those kinds of debugging aids in your user config file,
1048 along with messaging and tracing setup.
1049 (@xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.)
1050
1051 @item
1052 You might need to override some defaults.
1053 For example, you might need to move, shrink, or back up the target's
1054 work area if your application needs much SRAM.
1055
1056 @item
1057 TCP/IP port configuration is another example of something which
1058 is environment-specific, and should only appear in
1059 a user config file. @xref{tcpipports,,TCP/IP Ports}.
1060 @end itemize
1061
1062 @section Project-Specific Utilities
1063
1064 A few project-specific utility
1065 routines may well speed up your work.
1066 Write them, and keep them in your project's user config file.
1067
1068 For example, if you are making a boot loader work on a
1069 board, it's nice to be able to debug the ``after it's
1070 loaded to RAM'' parts separately from the finicky early
1071 code which sets up the DDR RAM controller and clocks.
1072 A script like this one, or a more GDB-aware sibling,
1073 may help:
1074
1075 @example
1076 proc ramboot @{ @} @{
1077 # Reset, running the target's "reset-init" scripts
1078 # to initialize clocks and the DDR RAM controller.
1079 # Leave the CPU halted.
1080 reset init
1081
1082 # Load CONFIG_SKIP_LOWLEVEL_INIT version into DDR RAM.
1083 load_image u-boot.bin 0x20000000
1084
1085 # Start running.
1086 resume 0x20000000
1087 @}
1088 @end example
1089
1090 Then once that code is working you will need to make it
1091 boot from NOR flash; a different utility would help.
1092 Alternatively, some developers write to flash using GDB.
1093 (You might use a similar script if you're working with a flash
1094 based microcontroller application instead of a boot loader.)
1095
1096 @example
1097 proc newboot @{ @} @{
1098 # Reset, leaving the CPU halted. The "reset-init" event
1099 # proc gives faster access to the CPU and to NOR flash;
1100 # "reset halt" would be slower.
1101 reset init
1102
1103 # Write standard version of U-Boot into the first two
1104 # sectors of NOR flash ... the standard version should
1105 # do the same lowlevel init as "reset-init".
1106 flash protect 0 0 1 off
1107 flash erase_sector 0 0 1
1108 flash write_bank 0 u-boot.bin 0x0
1109 flash protect 0 0 1 on
1110
1111 # Reboot from scratch using that new boot loader.
1112 reset run
1113 @}
1114 @end example
1115
1116 You may need more complicated utility procedures when booting
1117 from NAND.
1118 That often involves an extra bootloader stage,
1119 running from on-chip SRAM to perform DDR RAM setup so it can load
1120 the main bootloader code (which won't fit into that SRAM).
1121
1122 Other helper scripts might be used to write production system images,
1123 involving considerably more than just a three stage bootloader.
1124
1125 @section Target Software Changes
1126
1127 Sometimes you may want to make some small changes to the software
1128 you're developing, to help make JTAG debugging work better.
1129 For example, in C or assembly language code you might
1130 use @code{#ifdef JTAG_DEBUG} (or its converse) around code
1131 handling issues like:
1132
1133 @itemize @bullet
1134
1135 @item @b{Watchdog Timers}...
1136 Watchdog timers are typically used to automatically reset systems if
1137 some application task doesn't periodically reset the timer. (The
1138 assumption is that the system has locked up if the task can't run.)
1139 When a JTAG debugger halts the system, that task won't be able to run
1140 and reset the timer ... potentially causing resets in the middle of
1141 your debug sessions.
1142
1143 It's rarely a good idea to disable such watchdogs, since their usage
1144 needs to be debugged just like all other parts of your firmware.
1145 That might however be your only option.
1146
1147 Look instead for chip-specific ways to stop the watchdog from counting
1148 while the system is in a debug halt state. It may be simplest to set
1149 that non-counting mode in your debugger startup scripts. You may however
1150 need a different approach when, for example, a motor could be physically
1151 damaged by firmware remaining inactive in a debug halt state. That might
1152 involve a type of firmware mode where that "non-counting" mode is disabled
1153 at the beginning then re-enabled at the end; a watchdog reset might fire
1154 and complicate the debug session, but hardware (or people) would be
1155 protected.@footnote{Note that many systems support a "monitor mode" debug
1156 that is a somewhat cleaner way to address such issues. You can think of
1157 it as only halting part of the system, maybe just one task,
1158 instead of the whole thing.
1159 At this writing, January 2010, OpenOCD based debugging does not support
1160 monitor mode debug, only "halt mode" debug.}
1161
1162 @item @b{ARM Semihosting}...
1163 @cindex ARM semihosting
1164 When linked with a special runtime library provided with many
1165 toolchains@footnote{See chapter 8 "Semihosting" in
1166 @uref{http://infocenter.arm.com/help/topic/com.arm.doc.dui0203i/DUI0203I_rvct_developer_guide.pdf,
1167 ARM DUI 0203I}, the "RealView Compilation Tools Developer Guide".
1168 The CodeSourcery EABI toolchain also includes a semihosting library.},
1169 your target code can use I/O facilities on the debug host. That library
1170 provides a small set of system calls which are handled by OpenOCD.
1171 It can let the debugger provide your system console and a file system,
1172 helping with early debugging or providing a more capable environment
1173 for sometimes-complex tasks like installing system firmware onto
1174 NAND or SPI flash.
1175
1176 @item @b{ARM Wait-For-Interrupt}...
1177 Many ARM chips synchronize the JTAG clock using the core clock.
1178 Low power states which stop that core clock thus prevent JTAG access.
1179 Idle loops in tasking environments often enter those low power states
1180 via the @code{WFI} instruction (or its coprocessor equivalent, before ARMv7).
1181
1182 You may want to @emph{disable that instruction} in source code,
1183 or otherwise prevent using that state,
1184 to ensure you can get JTAG access at any time.@footnote{As a more
1185 polite alternative, some processors have special debug-oriented
1186 registers which can be used to change various features including
1187 how the low power states are clocked while debugging.
1188 The STM32 DBGMCU_CR register is an example; at the cost of extra
1189 power consumption, JTAG can be used during low power states.}
1190 For example, the OpenOCD @command{halt} command may not
1191 work for an idle processor otherwise.
1192
1193 @item @b{Delay after reset}...
1194 Not all chips have good support for debugger access
1195 right after reset; many LPC2xxx chips have issues here.
1196 Similarly, applications that reconfigure pins used for
1197 JTAG access as they start will also block debugger access.
1198
1199 To work with boards like this, @emph{enable a short delay loop}
1200 the first thing after reset, before "real" startup activities.
1201 For example, one second's delay is usually more than enough
1202 time for a JTAG debugger to attach, so that
1203 early code execution can be debugged
1204 or firmware can be replaced.
1205
1206 @item @b{Debug Communications Channel (DCC)}...
1207 Some processors include mechanisms to send messages over JTAG.
1208 Many ARM cores support these, as do some cores from other vendors.
1209 (OpenOCD may be able to use this DCC internally, speeding up some
1210 operations like writing to memory.)
1211
1212 Your application may want to deliver various debugging messages
1213 over JTAG, by @emph{linking with a small library of code}
1214 provided with OpenOCD and using the utilities there to send
1215 various kinds of message.
1216 @xref{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing,,Software Debug Messages and Tracing}.
1217
1218 @end itemize
1219
1220 @section Target Hardware Setup
1221
1222 Chip vendors often provide software development boards which
1223 are highly configurable, so that they can support all options
1224 that product boards may require. @emph{Make sure that any
1225 jumpers or switches match the system configuration you are
1226 working with.}
1227
1228 Common issues include:
1229
1230 @itemize @bullet
1231
1232 @item @b{JTAG setup} ...
1233 Boards may support more than one JTAG configuration.
1234 Examples include jumpers controlling pullups versus pulldowns
1235 on the nTRST and/or nSRST signals, and choice of connectors
1236 (e.g. which of two headers on the base board,
1237 or one from a daughtercard).
1238 For some Texas Instruments boards, you may need to jumper the
1239 EMU0 and EMU1 signals (which OpenOCD won't currently control).
1240
1241 @item @b{Boot Modes} ...
1242 Complex chips often support multiple boot modes, controlled
1243 by external jumpers. Make sure this is set up correctly.
1244 For example many i.MX boards from NXP need to be jumpered
1245 to "ATX mode" to start booting using the on-chip ROM, when
1246 using second stage bootloader code stored in a NAND flash chip.
1247
1248 Such explicit configuration is common, and not limited to
1249 booting from NAND. You might also need to set jumpers to
1250 start booting using code loaded from an MMC/SD card; external
1251 SPI flash; Ethernet, UART, or USB links; NOR flash; OneNAND
1252 flash; some external host; or various other sources.
1253
1254
1255 @item @b{Memory Addressing} ...
1256 Boards which support multiple boot modes may also have jumpers
1257 to configure memory addressing. One board, for example, jumpers
1258 external chipselect 0 (used for booting) to address either
1259 a large SRAM (which must be pre-loaded via JTAG), NOR flash,
1260 or NAND flash. When it's jumpered to address NAND flash, that
1261 board must also be told to start booting from on-chip ROM.
1262
1263 Your @file{board.cfg} file may also need to be told this jumper
1264 configuration, so that it can know whether to declare NOR flash
1265 using @command{flash bank} or instead declare NAND flash with
1266 @command{nand device}; and likewise which probe to perform in
1267 its @code{reset-init} handler.
1268
1269 A closely related issue is bus width. Jumpers might need to
1270 distinguish between 8 bit or 16 bit bus access for the flash
1271 used to start booting.
1272
1273 @item @b{Peripheral Access} ...
1274 Development boards generally provide access to every peripheral
1275 on the chip, sometimes in multiple modes (such as by providing
1276 multiple audio codec chips).
1277 This interacts with software
1278 configuration of pin multiplexing, where for example a
1279 given pin may be routed either to the MMC/SD controller
1280 or the GPIO controller. It also often interacts with
1281 configuration jumpers. One jumper may be used to route
1282 signals to an MMC/SD card slot or an expansion bus (which
1283 might in turn affect booting); others might control which
1284 audio or video codecs are used.
1285
1286 @end itemize
1287
1288 Plus you should of course have @code{reset-init} event handlers
1289 which set up the hardware to match that jumper configuration.
1290 That includes in particular any oscillator or PLL used to clock
1291 the CPU, and any memory controllers needed to access external
1292 memory and peripherals. Without such handlers, you won't be
1293 able to access those resources without working target firmware
1294 which can do that setup ... this can be awkward when you're
1295 trying to debug that target firmware. Even if there's a ROM
1296 bootloader which handles a few issues, it rarely provides full
1297 access to all board-specific capabilities.
1298
1299
1300 @node Config File Guidelines
1301 @chapter Config File Guidelines
1302
1303 This chapter is aimed at any user who needs to write a config file,
1304 including developers and integrators of OpenOCD and any user who
1305 needs to get a new board working smoothly.
1306 It provides guidelines for creating those files.
1307
1308 You should find the following directories under
1309 @t{$(INSTALLDIR)/scripts}, with config files maintained upstream. Use
1310 them as-is where you can; or as models for new files.
1311 @itemize @bullet
1312 @item @file{interface} ...
1313 These are for debug adapters. Files that specify configuration to use
1314 specific JTAG, SWD and other adapters go here.
1315 @item @file{board} ...
1316 Think Circuit Board, PWA, PCB, they go by many names. Board files
1317 contain initialization items that are specific to a board.
1318
1319 They reuse target configuration files, since the same
1320 microprocessor chips are used on many boards,
1321 but support for external parts varies widely. For
1322 example, the SDRAM initialization sequence for the board, or the type
1323 of external flash and what address it uses. Any initialization
1324 sequence to enable that external flash or SDRAM should be found in the
1325 board file. Boards may also contain multiple targets: two CPUs; or
1326 a CPU and an FPGA.
1327 @item @file{target} ...
1328 Think chip. The ``target'' directory represents the JTAG TAPs
1329 on a chip
1330 which OpenOCD should control, not a board. Two common types of targets
1331 are ARM chips and FPGA or CPLD chips.
1332 When a chip has multiple TAPs (maybe it has both ARM and DSP cores),
1333 the target config file defines all of them.
1334 @item @emph{more} ... browse for other library files which may be useful.
1335 For example, there are various generic and CPU-specific utilities.
1336 @end itemize
1337
1338 The @file{openocd.cfg} user config
1339 file may override features in any of the above files by
1340 setting variables before sourcing the target file, or by adding
1341 commands specific to their situation.
1342
1343 @section Interface Config Files
1344
1345 The user config file
1346 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1347
1348 @example
1349 source [find interface/FOOBAR.cfg]
1350 @end example
1351
1352 A preconfigured interface file should exist for every debug adapter
1353 in use today with OpenOCD.
1354 That said, perhaps some of these config files
1355 have only been used by the developer who created it.
1356
1357 A separate chapter gives information about how to set these up.
1358 @xref{Debug Adapter Configuration}.
1359 Read the OpenOCD source code (and Developer's Guide)
1360 if you have a new kind of hardware interface
1361 and need to provide a driver for it.
1362
1363 @section Board Config Files
1364 @cindex config file, board
1365 @cindex board config file
1366
1367 The user config file
1368 should be able to source one of these files with a command like this:
1369
1370 @example
1371 source [find board/FOOBAR.cfg]
1372 @end example
1373
1374 The point of a board config file is to package everything
1375 about a given board that user config files need to know.
1376 In summary the board files should contain (if present)
1377
1378 @enumerate
1379 @item One or more @command{source [find target/...cfg]} statements
1380 @item NOR flash configuration (@pxref{norconfiguration,,NOR Configuration})
1381 @item NAND flash configuration (@pxref{nandconfiguration,,NAND Configuration})
1382 @item Target @code{reset} handlers for SDRAM and I/O configuration
1383 @item JTAG adapter reset configuration (@pxref{Reset Configuration})
1384 @item All things that are not ``inside a chip''
1385 @end enumerate
1386
1387 Generic things inside target chips belong in target config files,
1388 not board config files. So for example a @code{reset-init} event
1389 handler should know board-specific oscillator and PLL parameters,
1390 which it passes to target-specific utility code.
1391
1392 The most complex task of a board config file is creating such a
1393 @code{reset-init} event handler.
1394 Define those handlers last, after you verify the rest of the board
1395 configuration works.
1396
1397 @subsection Communication Between Config files
1398
1399 In addition to target-specific utility code, another way that
1400 board and target config files communicate is by following a
1401 convention on how to use certain variables.
1402
1403 The full Tcl/Tk language supports ``namespaces'', but Jim-Tcl does not.
1404 Thus the rule we follow in OpenOCD is this: Variables that begin with
1405 a leading underscore are temporary in nature, and can be modified and
1406 used at will within a target configuration file.
1407
1408 Complex board config files can do the things like this,
1409 for a board with three chips:
1410
1411 @example
1412 # Chip #1: PXA270 for network side, big endian
1413 set CHIPNAME network
1414 set ENDIAN big
1415 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1416 # on return: _TARGETNAME = network.cpu
1417 # other commands can refer to the "network.cpu" target.
1418 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1419
1420 # Chip #2: PXA270 for video side, little endian
1421 set CHIPNAME video
1422 set ENDIAN little
1423 source [find target/pxa270.cfg]
1424 # on return: _TARGETNAME = video.cpu
1425 # other commands can refer to the "video.cpu" target.
1426 $_TARGETNAME configure .... events for this CPU..
1427
1428 # Chip #3: Xilinx FPGA for glue logic
1429 set CHIPNAME xilinx
1430 unset ENDIAN
1431 source [find target/spartan3.cfg]
1432 @end example
1433
1434 That example is oversimplified because it doesn't show any flash memory,
1435 or the @code{reset-init} event handlers to initialize external DRAM
1436 or (assuming it needs it) load a configuration into the FPGA.
1437 Such features are usually needed for low-level work with many boards,
1438 where ``low level'' implies that the board initialization software may
1439 not be working. (That's a common reason to need JTAG tools. Another
1440 is to enable working with microcontroller-based systems, which often
1441 have no debugging support except a JTAG connector.)
1442
1443 Target config files may also export utility functions to board and user
1444 config files. Such functions should use name prefixes, to help avoid
1445 naming collisions.
1446
1447 Board files could also accept input variables from user config files.
1448 For example, there might be a @code{J4_JUMPER} setting used to identify
1449 what kind of flash memory a development board is using, or how to set
1450 up other clocks and peripherals.
1451
1452 @subsection Variable Naming Convention
1453 @cindex variable names
1454
1455 Most boards have only one instance of a chip.
1456 However, it should be easy to create a board with more than
1457 one such chip (as shown above).
1458 Accordingly, we encourage these conventions for naming
1459 variables associated with different @file{target.cfg} files,
1460 to promote consistency and
1461 so that board files can override target defaults.
1462
1463 Inputs to target config files include:
1464
1465 @itemize @bullet
1466 @item @code{CHIPNAME} ...
1467 This gives a name to the overall chip, and is used as part of
1468 tap identifier dotted names.
1469 While the default is normally provided by the chip manufacturer,
1470 board files may need to distinguish between instances of a chip.
1471 @item @code{ENDIAN} ...
1472 By default @option{little} - although chips may hard-wire @option{big}.
1473 Chips that can't change endianess don't need to use this variable.
1474 @item @code{CPUTAPID} ...
1475 When OpenOCD examines the JTAG chain, it can be told verify the
1476 chips against the JTAG IDCODE register.
1477 The target file will hold one or more defaults, but sometimes the
1478 chip in a board will use a different ID (perhaps a newer revision).
1479 @end itemize
1480
1481 Outputs from target config files include:
1482
1483 @itemize @bullet
1484 @item @code{_TARGETNAME} ...
1485 By convention, this variable is created by the target configuration
1486 script. The board configuration file may make use of this variable to
1487 configure things like a ``reset init'' script, or other things
1488 specific to that board and that target.
1489 If the chip has 2 targets, the names are @code{_TARGETNAME0},
1490 @code{_TARGETNAME1}, ... etc.
1491 @end itemize
1492
1493 @subsection The reset-init Event Handler
1494 @cindex event, reset-init
1495 @cindex reset-init handler
1496
1497 Board config files run in the OpenOCD configuration stage;
1498 they can't use TAPs or targets, since they haven't been
1499 fully set up yet.
1500 This means you can't write memory or access chip registers;
1501 you can't even verify that a flash chip is present.
1502 That's done later in event handlers, of which the target @code{reset-init}
1503 handler is one of the most important.
1504
1505 Except on microcontrollers, the basic job of @code{reset-init} event
1506 handlers is setting up flash and DRAM, as normally handled by boot loaders.
1507 Microcontrollers rarely use boot loaders; they run right out of their
1508 on-chip flash and SRAM memory. But they may want to use one of these
1509 handlers too, if just for developer convenience.
1510
1511 @quotation Note
1512 Because this is so very board-specific, and chip-specific, no examples
1513 are included here.
1514 Instead, look at the board config files distributed with OpenOCD.
1515 If you have a boot loader, its source code will help; so will
1516 configuration files for other JTAG tools
1517 (@pxref{translatingconfigurationfiles,,Translating Configuration Files}).
1518 @end quotation
1519
1520 Some of this code could probably be shared between different boards.
1521 For example, setting up a DRAM controller often doesn't differ by
1522 much except the bus width (16 bits or 32?) and memory timings, so a
1523 reusable TCL procedure loaded by the @file{target.cfg} file might take
1524 those as parameters.
1525 Similarly with oscillator, PLL, and clock setup;
1526 and disabling the watchdog.
1527 Structure the code cleanly, and provide comments to help
1528 the next developer doing such work.
1529 (@emph{You might be that next person} trying to reuse init code!)
1530
1531 The last thing normally done in a @code{reset-init} handler is probing
1532 whatever flash memory was configured. For most chips that needs to be
1533 done while the associated target is halted, either because JTAG memory
1534 access uses the CPU or to prevent conflicting CPU access.
1535
1536 @subsection JTAG Clock Rate
1537
1538 Before your @code{reset-init} handler has set up
1539 the PLLs and clocking, you may need to run with
1540 a low JTAG clock rate.
1541 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1542 Then you'd increase that rate after your handler has
1543 made it possible to use the faster JTAG clock.
1544 When the initial low speed is board-specific, for example
1545 because it depends on a board-specific oscillator speed, then
1546 you should probably set it up in the board config file;
1547 if it's target-specific, it belongs in the target config file.
1548
1549 For most ARM-based processors the fastest JTAG clock@footnote{A FAQ
1550 @uref{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} gives details.}
1551 is one sixth of the CPU clock; or one eighth for ARM11 cores.
1552 Consult chip documentation to determine the peak JTAG clock rate,
1553 which might be less than that.
1554
1555 @quotation Warning
1556 On most ARMs, JTAG clock detection is coupled to the core clock, so
1557 software using a @option{wait for interrupt} operation blocks JTAG access.
1558 Adaptive clocking provides a partial workaround, but a more complete
1559 solution just avoids using that instruction with JTAG debuggers.
1560 @end quotation
1561
1562 If both the chip and the board support adaptive clocking,
1563 use the @command{jtag_rclk}
1564 command, in case your board is used with JTAG adapter which
1565 also supports it. Otherwise use @command{adapter_khz}.
1566 Set the slow rate at the beginning of the reset sequence,
1567 and the faster rate as soon as the clocks are at full speed.
1568
1569 @anchor{theinitboardprocedure}
1570 @subsection The init_board procedure
1571 @cindex init_board procedure
1572
1573 The concept of @code{init_board} procedure is very similar to @code{init_targets}
1574 (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets procedure}.) - it's a replacement of ``linear''
1575 configuration scripts. This procedure is meant to be executed when OpenOCD enters run stage
1576 (@xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage},) after @code{init_targets}. The idea to have
1577 separate @code{init_targets} and @code{init_board} procedures is to allow the first one to configure
1578 everything target specific (internal flash, internal RAM, etc.) and the second one to configure
1579 everything board specific (reset signals, chip frequency, reset-init event handler, external memory, etc.).
1580 Additionally ``linear'' board config file will most likely fail when target config file uses
1581 @code{init_targets} scheme (``linear'' script is executed before @code{init} and @code{init_targets} - after),
1582 so separating these two configuration stages is very convenient, as the easiest way to overcome this
1583 problem is to convert board config file to use @code{init_board} procedure. Board config scripts don't
1584 need to override @code{init_targets} defined in target config files when they only need to add some specifics.
1585
1586 Just as @code{init_targets}, the @code{init_board} procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources
1587 the original), allowing greater code reuse.
1588
1589 @example
1590 ### board_file.cfg ###
1591
1592 # source target file that does most of the config in init_targets
1593 source [find target/target.cfg]
1594
1595 proc enable_fast_clock @{@} @{
1596 # enables fast on-board clock source
1597 # configures the chip to use it
1598 @}
1599
1600 # initialize only board specifics - reset, clock, adapter frequency
1601 proc init_board @{@} @{
1602 reset_config trst_and_srst trst_pulls_srst
1603
1604 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-start @{
1605 adapter_khz 100
1606 @}
1607
1608 $_TARGETNAME configure -event reset-init @{
1609 enable_fast_clock
1610 adapter_khz 10000
1611 @}
1612 @}
1613 @end example
1614
1615 @section Target Config Files
1616 @cindex config file, target
1617 @cindex target config file
1618
1619 Board config files communicate with target config files using
1620 naming conventions as described above, and may source one or
1621 more target config files like this:
1622
1623 @example
1624 source [find target/FOOBAR.cfg]
1625 @end example
1626
1627 The point of a target config file is to package everything
1628 about a given chip that board config files need to know.
1629 In summary the target files should contain
1630
1631 @enumerate
1632 @item Set defaults
1633 @item Add TAPs to the scan chain
1634 @item Add CPU targets (includes GDB support)
1635 @item CPU/Chip/CPU-Core specific features
1636 @item On-Chip flash
1637 @end enumerate
1638
1639 As a rule of thumb, a target file sets up only one chip.
1640 For a microcontroller, that will often include a single TAP,
1641 which is a CPU needing a GDB target, and its on-chip flash.
1642
1643 More complex chips may include multiple TAPs, and the target
1644 config file may need to define them all before OpenOCD
1645 can talk to the chip.
1646 For example, some phone chips have JTAG scan chains that include
1647 an ARM core for operating system use, a DSP,
1648 another ARM core embedded in an image processing engine,
1649 and other processing engines.
1650
1651 @subsection Default Value Boiler Plate Code
1652
1653 All target configuration files should start with code like this,
1654 letting board config files express environment-specific
1655 differences in how things should be set up.
1656
1657 @example
1658 # Boards may override chip names, perhaps based on role,
1659 # but the default should match what the vendor uses
1660 if @{ [info exists CHIPNAME] @} @{
1661 set _CHIPNAME $CHIPNAME
1662 @} else @{
1663 set _CHIPNAME sam7x256
1664 @}
1665
1666 # ONLY use ENDIAN with targets that can change it.
1667 if @{ [info exists ENDIAN] @} @{
1668 set _ENDIAN $ENDIAN
1669 @} else @{
1670 set _ENDIAN little
1671 @}
1672
1673 # TAP identifiers may change as chips mature, for example with
1674 # new revision fields (the "3" here). Pick a good default; you
1675 # can pass several such identifiers to the "jtag newtap" command.
1676 if @{ [info exists CPUTAPID ] @} @{
1677 set _CPUTAPID $CPUTAPID
1678 @} else @{
1679 set _CPUTAPID 0x3f0f0f0f
1680 @}
1681 @end example
1682 @c but 0x3f0f0f0f is for an str73x part ...
1683
1684 @emph{Remember:} Board config files may include multiple target
1685 config files, or the same target file multiple times
1686 (changing at least @code{CHIPNAME}).
1687
1688 Likewise, the target configuration file should define
1689 @code{_TARGETNAME} (or @code{_TARGETNAME0} etc) and
1690 use it later on when defining debug targets:
1691
1692 @example
1693 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1694 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1695 @end example
1696
1697 @subsection Adding TAPs to the Scan Chain
1698 After the ``defaults'' are set up,
1699 add the TAPs on each chip to the JTAG scan chain.
1700 @xref{TAP Declaration}, and the naming convention
1701 for taps.
1702
1703 In the simplest case the chip has only one TAP,
1704 probably for a CPU or FPGA.
1705 The config file for the Atmel AT91SAM7X256
1706 looks (in part) like this:
1707
1708 @example
1709 jtag newtap $_CHIPNAME cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id $_CPUTAPID
1710 @end example
1711
1712 A board with two such at91sam7 chips would be able
1713 to source such a config file twice, with different
1714 values for @code{CHIPNAME}, so
1715 it adds a different TAP each time.
1716
1717 If there are nonzero @option{-expected-id} values,
1718 OpenOCD attempts to verify the actual tap id against those values.
1719 It will issue error messages if there is mismatch, which
1720 can help to pinpoint problems in OpenOCD configurations.
1721
1722 @example
1723 JTAG tap: sam7x256.cpu tap/device found: 0x3f0f0f0f
1724 (Manufacturer: 0x787, Part: 0xf0f0, Version: 0x3)
1725 ERROR: Tap: sam7x256.cpu - Expected id: 0x12345678, Got: 0x3f0f0f0f
1726 ERROR: expected: mfg: 0x33c, part: 0x2345, ver: 0x1
1727 ERROR: got: mfg: 0x787, part: 0xf0f0, ver: 0x3
1728 @end example
1729
1730 There are more complex examples too, with chips that have
1731 multiple TAPs. Ones worth looking at include:
1732
1733 @itemize
1734 @item @file{target/omap3530.cfg} -- with disabled ARM and DSP,
1735 plus a JRC to enable them
1736 @item @file{target/str912.cfg} -- with flash, CPU, and boundary scan
1737 @item @file{target/ti_dm355.cfg} -- with ETM, ARM, and JRC (this JRC
1738 is not currently used)
1739 @end itemize
1740
1741 @subsection Add CPU targets
1742
1743 After adding a TAP for a CPU, you should set it up so that
1744 GDB and other commands can use it.
1745 @xref{CPU Configuration}.
1746 For the at91sam7 example above, the command can look like this;
1747 note that @code{$_ENDIAN} is not needed, since OpenOCD defaults
1748 to little endian, and this chip doesn't support changing that.
1749
1750 @example
1751 set _TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.cpu
1752 target create $_TARGETNAME arm7tdmi -chain-position $_TARGETNAME
1753 @end example
1754
1755 Work areas are small RAM areas associated with CPU targets.
1756 They are used by OpenOCD to speed up downloads,
1757 and to download small snippets of code to program flash chips.
1758 If the chip includes a form of ``on-chip-ram'' - and many do - define
1759 a work area if you can.
1760 Again using the at91sam7 as an example, this can look like:
1761
1762 @example
1763 $_TARGETNAME configure -work-area-phys 0x00200000 \
1764 -work-area-size 0x4000 -work-area-backup 0
1765 @end example
1766
1767 @anchor{definecputargetsworkinginsmp}
1768 @subsection Define CPU targets working in SMP
1769 @cindex SMP
1770 After setting targets, you can define a list of targets working in SMP.
1771
1772 @example
1773 set _TARGETNAME_1 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1774 set _TARGETNAME_2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu2
1775 target create $_TARGETNAME_1 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1776 -coreid 0 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG1
1777 target create $_TARGETNAME_2 cortex_a -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.dap \
1778 -coreid 1 -dbgbase $_DAP_DBG2
1779 #define 2 targets working in smp.
1780 target smp $_CHIPNAME.cpu2 $_CHIPNAME.cpu1
1781 @end example
1782 In the above example on cortex_a, 2 cpus are working in SMP.
1783 In SMP only one GDB instance is created and :
1784 @itemize @bullet
1785 @item a set of hardware breakpoint sets the same breakpoint on all targets in the list.
1786 @item halt command triggers the halt of all targets in the list.
1787 @item resume command triggers the write context and the restart of all targets in the list.
1788 @item following a breakpoint: the target stopped by the breakpoint is displayed to the GDB session.
1789 @item dedicated GDB serial protocol packets are implemented for switching/retrieving the target
1790 displayed by the GDB session @pxref{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb,,Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB}.
1791 @end itemize
1792
1793 The SMP behaviour can be disabled/enabled dynamically. On cortex_a following
1794 command have been implemented.
1795 @itemize @bullet
1796 @item cortex_a smp_on : enable SMP mode, behaviour is as described above.
1797 @item cortex_a smp_off : disable SMP mode, the current target is the one
1798 displayed in the GDB session, only this target is now controlled by GDB
1799 session. This behaviour is useful during system boot up.
1800 @item cortex_a smp_gdb : display/fix the core id displayed in GDB session see
1801 following example.
1802 @end itemize
1803
1804 @example
1805 >cortex_a smp_gdb
1806 gdb coreid 0 -> -1
1807 #0 : coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1808 #-> -1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1809 > cortex_a smp_gdb 1
1810 gdb coreid 0 -> 1
1811 #0 :coreid 0 is displayed to GDB ,
1812 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1813 > resume
1814 > cortex_a smp_gdb
1815 gdb coreid 1 -> 1
1816 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB ,
1817 #->1 : next resume displays coreid 1 to GDB
1818 > cortex_a smp_gdb -1
1819 gdb coreid 1 -> -1
1820 #1 :coreid 1 is displayed to GDB,
1821 #->-1 : next resume triggers a real resume
1822 @end example
1823
1824
1825 @subsection Chip Reset Setup
1826
1827 As a rule, you should put the @command{reset_config} command
1828 into the board file. Most things you think you know about a
1829 chip can be tweaked by the board.
1830
1831 Some chips have specific ways the TRST and SRST signals are
1832 managed. In the unusual case that these are @emph{chip specific}
1833 and can never be changed by board wiring, they could go here.
1834 For example, some chips can't support JTAG debugging without
1835 both signals.
1836
1837 Provide a @code{reset-assert} event handler if you can.
1838 Such a handler uses JTAG operations to reset the target,
1839 letting this target config be used in systems which don't
1840 provide the optional SRST signal, or on systems where you
1841 don't want to reset all targets at once.
1842 Such a handler might write to chip registers to force a reset,
1843 use a JRC to do that (preferable -- the target may be wedged!),
1844 or force a watchdog timer to trigger.
1845 (For Cortex-M targets, this is not necessary. The target
1846 driver knows how to use trigger an NVIC reset when SRST is
1847 not available.)
1848
1849 Some chips need special attention during reset handling if
1850 they're going to be used with JTAG.
1851 An example might be needing to send some commands right
1852 after the target's TAP has been reset, providing a
1853 @code{reset-deassert-post} event handler that writes a chip
1854 register to report that JTAG debugging is being done.
1855 Another would be reconfiguring the watchdog so that it stops
1856 counting while the core is halted in the debugger.
1857
1858 JTAG clocking constraints often change during reset, and in
1859 some cases target config files (rather than board config files)
1860 are the right places to handle some of those issues.
1861 For example, immediately after reset most chips run using a
1862 slower clock than they will use later.
1863 That means that after reset (and potentially, as OpenOCD
1864 first starts up) they must use a slower JTAG clock rate
1865 than they will use later.
1866 @xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.
1867
1868 @quotation Important
1869 When you are debugging code that runs right after chip
1870 reset, getting these issues right is critical.
1871 In particular, if you see intermittent failures when
1872 OpenOCD verifies the scan chain after reset,
1873 look at how you are setting up JTAG clocking.
1874 @end quotation
1875
1876 @anchor{theinittargetsprocedure}
1877 @subsection The init_targets procedure
1878 @cindex init_targets procedure
1879
1880 Target config files can either be ``linear'' (script executed line-by-line when parsed in
1881 configuration stage, @xref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage},) or they can contain a special
1882 procedure called @code{init_targets}, which will be executed when entering run stage
1883 (after parsing all config files or after @code{init} command, @xref{enteringtherunstage,,Entering the Run Stage}.)
1884 Such procedure can be overridden by ``next level'' script (which sources the original).
1885 This concept facilitates code reuse when basic target config files provide generic configuration
1886 procedures and @code{init_targets} procedure, which can then be sourced and enhanced or changed in
1887 a ``more specific'' target config file. This is not possible with ``linear'' config scripts,
1888 because sourcing them executes every initialization commands they provide.
1889
1890 @example
1891 ### generic_file.cfg ###
1892
1893 proc setup_my_chip @{chip_name flash_size ram_size@} @{
1894 # basic initialization procedure ...
1895 @}
1896
1897 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1898 # initializes generic chip with 4kB of flash and 1kB of RAM
1899 setup_my_chip MY_GENERIC_CHIP 4096 1024
1900 @}
1901
1902 ### specific_file.cfg ###
1903
1904 source [find target/generic_file.cfg]
1905
1906 proc init_targets @{@} @{
1907 # initializes specific chip with 128kB of flash and 64kB of RAM
1908 setup_my_chip MY_CHIP_WITH_128K_FLASH_64KB_RAM 131072 65536
1909 @}
1910 @end example
1911
1912 The easiest way to convert ``linear'' config files to @code{init_targets} version is to
1913 enclose every line of ``code'' (i.e. not @code{source} commands, procedures, etc.) in this procedure.
1914
1915 For an example of this scheme see LPC2000 target config files.
1916
1917 The @code{init_boards} procedure is a similar concept concerning board config files
1918 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.)
1919
1920 @anchor{theinittargeteventsprocedure}
1921 @subsection The init_target_events procedure
1922 @cindex init_target_events procedure
1923
1924 A special procedure called @code{init_target_events} is run just after
1925 @code{init_targets} (@xref{theinittargetsprocedure,,The init_targets
1926 procedure}.) and before @code{init_board}
1927 (@xref{theinitboardprocedure,,The init_board procedure}.) It is used
1928 to set up default target events for the targets that do not have those
1929 events already assigned.
1930
1931 @subsection ARM Core Specific Hacks
1932
1933 If the chip has a DCC, enable it. If the chip is an ARM9 with some
1934 special high speed download features - enable it.
1935
1936 If present, the MMU, the MPU and the CACHE should be disabled.
1937
1938 Some ARM cores are equipped with trace support, which permits
1939 examination of the instruction and data bus activity. Trace
1940 activity is controlled through an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM)
1941 on one of the core's scan chains. The ETM emits voluminous data
1942 through a ``trace port''. (@xref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.)
1943 If you are using an external trace port,
1944 configure it in your board config file.
1945 If you are using an on-chip ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB),
1946 configure it in your target config file.
1947
1948 @example
1949 etm config $_TARGETNAME 16 normal full etb
1950 etb config $_TARGETNAME $_CHIPNAME.etb
1951 @end example
1952
1953 @subsection Internal Flash Configuration
1954
1955 This applies @b{ONLY TO MICROCONTROLLERS} that have flash built in.
1956
1957 @b{Never ever} in the ``target configuration file'' define any type of
1958 flash that is external to the chip. (For example a BOOT flash on
1959 Chip Select 0.) Such flash information goes in a board file - not
1960 the TARGET (chip) file.
1961
1962 Examples:
1963 @itemize @bullet
1964 @item at91sam7x256 - has 256K flash YES enable it.
1965 @item str912 - has flash internal YES enable it.
1966 @item imx27 - uses boot flash on CS0 - it goes in the board file.
1967 @item pxa270 - again - CS0 flash - it goes in the board file.
1968 @end itemize
1969
1970 @anchor{translatingconfigurationfiles}
1971 @section Translating Configuration Files
1972 @cindex translation
1973 If you have a configuration file for another hardware debugger
1974 or toolset (Abatron, BDI2000, BDI3000, CCS,
1975 Lauterbach, SEGGER, Macraigor, etc.), translating
1976 it into OpenOCD syntax is often quite straightforward. The most tricky
1977 part of creating a configuration script is oftentimes the reset init
1978 sequence where e.g. PLLs, DRAM and the like is set up.
1979
1980 One trick that you can use when translating is to write small
1981 Tcl procedures to translate the syntax into OpenOCD syntax. This
1982 can avoid manual translation errors and make it easier to
1983 convert other scripts later on.
1984
1985 Example of transforming quirky arguments to a simple search and
1986 replace job:
1987
1988 @example
1989 # Lauterbach syntax(?)
1990 #
1991 # Data.Set c15:0x042f %long 0x40000015
1992 #
1993 # OpenOCD syntax when using procedure below.
1994 #
1995 # setc15 0x01 0x00050078
1996
1997 proc setc15 @{regs value@} @{
1998 global TARGETNAME
1999
2000 echo [format "set p15 0x%04x, 0x%08x" $regs $value]
2001
2002 arm mcr 15 [expr ($regs>>12)&0x7] \
2003 [expr ($regs>>0)&0xf] [expr ($regs>>4)&0xf] \
2004 [expr ($regs>>8)&0x7] $value
2005 @}
2006 @end example
2007
2008
2009
2010 @node Server Configuration
2011 @chapter Server Configuration
2012 @cindex initialization
2013 The commands here are commonly found in the openocd.cfg file and are
2014 used to specify what TCP/IP ports are used, and how GDB should be
2015 supported.
2016
2017 @anchor{configurationstage}
2018 @section Configuration Stage
2019 @cindex configuration stage
2020 @cindex config command
2021
2022 When the OpenOCD server process starts up, it enters a
2023 @emph{configuration stage} which is the only time that
2024 certain commands, @emph{configuration commands}, may be issued.
2025 Normally, configuration commands are only available
2026 inside startup scripts.
2027
2028 In this manual, the definition of a configuration command is
2029 presented as a @emph{Config Command}, not as a @emph{Command}
2030 which may be issued interactively.
2031 The runtime @command{help} command also highlights configuration
2032 commands, and those which may be issued at any time.
2033
2034 Those configuration commands include declaration of TAPs,
2035 flash banks,
2036 the interface used for JTAG communication,
2037 and other basic setup.
2038 The server must leave the configuration stage before it
2039 may access or activate TAPs.
2040 After it leaves this stage, configuration commands may no
2041 longer be issued.
2042
2043 @anchor{enteringtherunstage}
2044 @section Entering the Run Stage
2045
2046 The first thing OpenOCD does after leaving the configuration
2047 stage is to verify that it can talk to the scan chain
2048 (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2049 It will warn if it doesn't find TAPs it expects to find,
2050 or finds TAPs that aren't supposed to be there.
2051 You should see no errors at this point.
2052 If you see errors, resolve them by correcting the
2053 commands you used to configure the server.
2054 Common errors include using an initial JTAG speed that's too
2055 fast, and not providing the right IDCODE values for the TAPs
2056 on the scan chain.
2057
2058 Once OpenOCD has entered the run stage, a number of commands
2059 become available.
2060 A number of these relate to the debug targets you may have declared.
2061 For example, the @command{mww} command will not be available until
2062 a target has been successfully instantiated.
2063 If you want to use those commands, you may need to force
2064 entry to the run stage.
2065
2066 @deffn {Config Command} init
2067 This command terminates the configuration stage and
2068 enters the run stage. This helps when you need to have
2069 the startup scripts manage tasks such as resetting the target,
2070 programming flash, etc. To reset the CPU upon startup, add "init" and
2071 "reset" at the end of the config script or at the end of the OpenOCD
2072 command line using the @option{-c} command line switch.
2073
2074 If this command does not appear in any startup/configuration file
2075 OpenOCD executes the command for you after processing all
2076 configuration files and/or command line options.
2077
2078 @b{NOTE:} This command normally occurs at or near the end of your
2079 openocd.cfg file to force OpenOCD to ``initialize'' and make the
2080 targets ready. For example: If your openocd.cfg file needs to
2081 read/write memory on your target, @command{init} must occur before
2082 the memory read/write commands. This includes @command{nand probe}.
2083 @end deffn
2084
2085 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} jtag_init
2086 This is invoked at server startup to verify that it can talk
2087 to the scan chain (list of TAPs) which has been configured.
2088
2089 The default implementation first tries @command{jtag arp_init},
2090 which uses only a lightweight JTAG reset before examining the
2091 scan chain.
2092 If that fails, it tries again, using a harder reset
2093 from the overridable procedure @command{init_reset}.
2094
2095 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
2096 they return.
2097 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
2098 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
2099 @end deffn
2100
2101 @anchor{tcpipports}
2102 @section TCP/IP Ports
2103 @cindex TCP port
2104 @cindex server
2105 @cindex port
2106 @cindex security
2107 The OpenOCD server accepts remote commands in several syntaxes.
2108 Each syntax uses a different TCP/IP port, which you may specify
2109 only during configuration (before those ports are opened).
2110
2111 For reasons including security, you may wish to prevent remote
2112 access using one or more of these ports.
2113 In such cases, just specify the relevant port number as "disabled".
2114 If you disable all access through TCP/IP, you will need to
2115 use the command line @option{-pipe} option.
2116
2117 @anchor{gdb_port}
2118 @deffn {Command} gdb_port [number]
2119 @cindex GDB server
2120 Normally gdb listens to a TCP/IP port, but GDB can also
2121 communicate via pipes(stdin/out or named pipes). The name
2122 "gdb_port" stuck because it covers probably more than 90% of
2123 the normal use cases.
2124
2125 No arguments reports GDB port. "pipe" means listen to stdin
2126 output to stdout, an integer is base port number, "disabled"
2127 disables the gdb server.
2128
2129 When using "pipe", also use log_output to redirect the log
2130 output to a file so as not to flood the stdin/out pipes.
2131
2132 The -p/--pipe option is deprecated and a warning is printed
2133 as it is equivalent to passing in -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log".
2134
2135 Any other string is interpreted as named pipe to listen to.
2136 Output pipe is the same name as input pipe, but with 'o' appended,
2137 e.g. /var/gdb, /var/gdbo.
2138
2139 The GDB port for the first target will be the base port, the
2140 second target will listen on gdb_port + 1, and so on.
2141 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2142 the port @var{number} defaults to 3333.
2143 When @var{number} is not a numeric value, incrementing it to compute
2144 the next port number does not work. In this case, specify the proper
2145 @var{number} for each target by using the option @code{-gdb-port} of the
2146 commands @command{target create} or @command{$target_name configure}.
2147 @xref{gdbportoverride,,option -gdb-port}.
2148
2149 Note: when using "gdb_port pipe", increasing the default remote timeout in
2150 gdb (with 'set remotetimeout') is recommended. An insufficient timeout may
2151 cause initialization to fail with "Unknown remote qXfer reply: OK".
2152 @end deffn
2153
2154 @deffn {Command} tcl_port [number]
2155 Specify or query the port used for a simplified RPC
2156 connection that can be used by clients to issue TCL commands and get the
2157 output from the Tcl engine.
2158 Intended as a machine interface.
2159 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2160 the port @var{number} defaults to 6666.
2161 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2162 @end deffn
2163
2164 @deffn {Command} telnet_port [number]
2165 Specify or query the
2166 port on which to listen for incoming telnet connections.
2167 This port is intended for interaction with one human through TCL commands.
2168 When not specified during the configuration stage,
2169 the port @var{number} defaults to 4444.
2170 When specified as "disabled", this service is not activated.
2171 @end deffn
2172
2173 @anchor{gdbconfiguration}
2174 @section GDB Configuration
2175 @cindex GDB
2176 @cindex GDB configuration
2177 You can reconfigure some GDB behaviors if needed.
2178 The ones listed here are static and global.
2179 @xref{targetconfiguration,,Target Configuration}, about configuring individual targets.
2180 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, about configuring target-specific event handling.
2181
2182 @anchor{gdbbreakpointoverride}
2183 @deffn {Command} gdb_breakpoint_override [@option{hard}|@option{soft}|@option{disable}]
2184 Force breakpoint type for gdb @command{break} commands.
2185 This option supports GDB GUIs which don't
2186 distinguish hard versus soft breakpoints, if the default OpenOCD and
2187 GDB behaviour is not sufficient. GDB normally uses hardware
2188 breakpoints if the memory map has been set up for flash regions.
2189 @end deffn
2190
2191 @anchor{gdbflashprogram}
2192 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_flash_program (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2193 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to program the flash memory when a
2194 vFlash packet is received.
2195 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2196 @end deffn
2197
2198 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_memory_map (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2199 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the memory configuration to GDB when
2200 requested. GDB will then know when to set hardware breakpoints, and program flash
2201 using the GDB load command. @command{gdb_flash_program enable} must also be enabled
2202 for flash programming to work.
2203 Default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2204 @xref{gdbflashprogram,,gdb_flash_program}.
2205 @end deffn
2206
2207 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_data_abort (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2208 Specifies whether data aborts cause an error to be reported
2209 by GDB memory read packets.
2210 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2211 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2212 @end deffn
2213
2214 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_report_register_access_error (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2215 Specifies whether register accesses requested by GDB register read/write
2216 packets report errors or not.
2217 The default behaviour is @option{disable};
2218 use @option{enable} see these errors reported.
2219 @end deffn
2220
2221 @deffn {Config Command} gdb_target_description (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
2222 Set to @option{enable} to cause OpenOCD to send the target descriptions to gdb via qXfer:features:read packet.
2223 The default behaviour is @option{enable}.
2224 @end deffn
2225
2226 @deffn {Command} gdb_save_tdesc
2227 Saves the target description file to the local file system.
2228
2229 The file name is @i{target_name}.xml.
2230 @end deffn
2231
2232 @anchor{eventpolling}
2233 @section Event Polling
2234
2235 Hardware debuggers are parts of asynchronous systems,
2236 where significant events can happen at any time.
2237 The OpenOCD server needs to detect some of these events,
2238 so it can report them to through TCL command line
2239 or to GDB.
2240
2241 Examples of such events include:
2242
2243 @itemize
2244 @item One of the targets can stop running ... maybe it triggers
2245 a code breakpoint or data watchpoint, or halts itself.
2246 @item Messages may be sent over ``debug message'' channels ... many
2247 targets support such messages sent over JTAG,
2248 for receipt by the person debugging or tools.
2249 @item Loss of power ... some adapters can detect these events.
2250 @item Resets not issued through JTAG ... such reset sources
2251 can include button presses or other system hardware, sometimes
2252 including the target itself (perhaps through a watchdog).
2253 @item Debug instrumentation sometimes supports event triggering
2254 such as ``trace buffer full'' (so it can quickly be emptied)
2255 or other signals (to correlate with code behavior).
2256 @end itemize
2257
2258 None of those events are signaled through standard JTAG signals.
2259 However, most conventions for JTAG connectors include voltage
2260 level and system reset (SRST) signal detection.
2261 Some connectors also include instrumentation signals, which
2262 can imply events when those signals are inputs.
2263
2264 In general, OpenOCD needs to periodically check for those events,
2265 either by looking at the status of signals on the JTAG connector
2266 or by sending synchronous ``tell me your status'' JTAG requests
2267 to the various active targets.
2268 There is a command to manage and monitor that polling,
2269 which is normally done in the background.
2270
2271 @deffn Command poll [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2272 Poll the current target for its current state.
2273 (Also, @pxref{targetcurstate,,target curstate}.)
2274 If that target is in debug mode, architecture
2275 specific information about the current state is printed.
2276 An optional parameter
2277 allows background polling to be enabled and disabled.
2278
2279 You could use this from the TCL command shell, or
2280 from GDB using @command{monitor poll} command.
2281 Leave background polling enabled while you're using GDB.
2282 @example
2283 > poll
2284 background polling: on
2285 target state: halted
2286 target halted in ARM state due to debug-request, \
2287 current mode: Supervisor
2288 cpsr: 0x800000d3 pc: 0x11081bfc
2289 MMU: disabled, D-Cache: disabled, I-Cache: enabled
2290 >
2291 @end example
2292 @end deffn
2293
2294 @node Debug Adapter Configuration
2295 @chapter Debug Adapter Configuration
2296 @cindex config file, interface
2297 @cindex interface config file
2298
2299 Correctly installing OpenOCD includes making your operating system give
2300 OpenOCD access to debug adapters. Once that has been done, Tcl commands
2301 are used to select which one is used, and to configure how it is used.
2302
2303 @quotation Note
2304 Because OpenOCD started out with a focus purely on JTAG, you may find
2305 places where it wrongly presumes JTAG is the only transport protocol
2306 in use. Be aware that recent versions of OpenOCD are removing that
2307 limitation. JTAG remains more functional than most other transports.
2308 Other transports do not support boundary scan operations, or may be
2309 specific to a given chip vendor. Some might be usable only for
2310 programming flash memory, instead of also for debugging.
2311 @end quotation
2312
2313 Debug Adapters/Interfaces/Dongles are normally configured
2314 through commands in an interface configuration
2315 file which is sourced by your @file{openocd.cfg} file, or
2316 through a command line @option{-f interface/....cfg} option.
2317
2318 @example
2319 source [find interface/olimex-jtag-tiny.cfg]
2320 @end example
2321
2322 These commands tell
2323 OpenOCD what type of JTAG adapter you have, and how to talk to it.
2324 A few cases are so simple that you only need to say what driver to use:
2325
2326 @example
2327 # jlink interface
2328 interface jlink
2329 @end example
2330
2331 Most adapters need a bit more configuration than that.
2332
2333
2334 @section Interface Configuration
2335
2336 The interface command tells OpenOCD what type of debug adapter you are
2337 using. Depending on the type of adapter, you may need to use one or
2338 more additional commands to further identify or configure the adapter.
2339
2340 @deffn {Config Command} {interface} name
2341 Use the interface driver @var{name} to connect to the
2342 target.
2343 @end deffn
2344
2345 @deffn Command {interface_list}
2346 List the debug adapter drivers that have been built into
2347 the running copy of OpenOCD.
2348 @end deffn
2349 @deffn Command {interface transports} transport_name+
2350 Specifies the transports supported by this debug adapter.
2351 The adapter driver builds-in similar knowledge; use this only
2352 when external configuration (such as jumpering) changes what
2353 the hardware can support.
2354 @end deffn
2355
2356
2357
2358 @deffn Command {adapter_name}
2359 Returns the name of the debug adapter driver being used.
2360 @end deffn
2361
2362 @section Interface Drivers
2363
2364 Each of the interface drivers listed here must be explicitly
2365 enabled when OpenOCD is configured, in order to be made
2366 available at run time.
2367
2368 @deffn {Interface Driver} {amt_jtagaccel}
2369 Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
2370 connected to a PC's EPP mode parallel port.
2371 This defines some driver-specific commands:
2372
2373 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} number
2374 Specifies either the address of the I/O port (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or
2375 the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2376 @end deffn
2377
2378 @deffn {Config Command} rtck [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
2379 Displays status of RTCK option.
2380 Optionally sets that option first.
2381 @end deffn
2382 @end deffn
2383
2384 @deffn {Interface Driver} {arm-jtag-ew}
2385 Olimex ARM-JTAG-EW USB adapter
2386 This has one driver-specific command:
2387
2388 @deffn Command {armjtagew_info}
2389 Logs some status
2390 @end deffn
2391 @end deffn
2392
2393 @deffn {Interface Driver} {at91rm9200}
2394 Supports bitbanged JTAG from the local system,
2395 presuming that system is an Atmel AT91rm9200
2396 and a specific set of GPIOs is used.
2397 @c command: at91rm9200_device NAME
2398 @c chooses among list of bit configs ... only one option
2399 @end deffn
2400
2401 @deffn {Interface Driver} {cmsis-dap}
2402 ARM CMSIS-DAP compliant based adapter.
2403
2404 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2405 The vendor ID and product ID of the CMSIS-DAP device. If not specified
2406 the driver will attempt to auto detect the CMSIS-DAP device.
2407 Currently, up to eight [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2408 @example
2409 cmsis_dap_vid_pid 0xc251 0xf001 0x0d28 0x0204
2410 @end example
2411 @end deffn
2412
2413 @deffn {Config Command} {cmsis_dap_serial} [serial]
2414 Specifies the @var{serial} of the CMSIS-DAP device to use.
2415 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2416 @end deffn
2417
2418 @deffn {Command} {cmsis-dap info}
2419 Display various device information, like hardware version, firmware version, current bus status.
2420 @end deffn
2421 @end deffn
2422
2423 @deffn {Interface Driver} {dummy}
2424 A dummy software-only driver for debugging.
2425 @end deffn
2426
2427 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ep93xx}
2428 Cirrus Logic EP93xx based single-board computer bit-banging (in development)
2429 @end deffn
2430
2431 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ftdi}
2432 This driver is for adapters using the MPSSE (Multi-Protocol Synchronous Serial
2433 Engine) mode built into many FTDI chips, such as the FT2232, FT4232 and FT232H.
2434
2435 The driver is using libusb-1.0 in asynchronous mode to talk to the FTDI device,
2436 bypassing intermediate libraries like libftdi or D2XX.
2437
2438 Support for new FTDI based adapters can be added completely through
2439 configuration files, without the need to patch and rebuild OpenOCD.
2440
2441 The driver uses a signal abstraction to enable Tcl configuration files to
2442 define outputs for one or several FTDI GPIO. These outputs can then be
2443 controlled using the @command{ftdi_set_signal} command. Special signal names
2444 are reserved for nTRST, nSRST and LED (for blink) so that they, if defined,
2445 will be used for their customary purpose. Inputs can be read using the
2446 @command{ftdi_get_signal} command.
2447
2448 To support SWD, a signal named SWD_EN must be defined. It is set to 1 when the
2449 SWD protocol is selected. When set, the adapter should route the SWDIO pin to
2450 the data input. An SWDIO_OE signal, if defined, will be set to 1 or 0 as
2451 required by the protocol, to tell the adapter to drive the data output onto
2452 the SWDIO pin or keep the SWDIO pin Hi-Z, respectively.
2453
2454 Depending on the type of buffer attached to the FTDI GPIO, the outputs have to
2455 be controlled differently. In order to support tristateable signals such as
2456 nSRST, both a data GPIO and an output-enable GPIO can be specified for each
2457 signal. The following output buffer configurations are supported:
2458
2459 @itemize @minus
2460 @item Push-pull with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line
2461 @item Open drain with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2462 @item Tristate with one FTDI output as (non-)inverted data line and another
2463 FTDI output as (non-)inverted output-enable
2464 @item Unbuffered, using the FTDI GPIO as a tristate output directly by
2465 switching data and direction as necessary
2466 @end itemize
2467
2468 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2469 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2470
2471 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
2472 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. Up to eight
2473 [@var{vid}, @var{pid}] pairs may be given, e.g.
2474 @example
2475 ftdi_vid_pid 0x0403 0xcff8 0x15ba 0x0003
2476 @end example
2477 @end deffn
2478
2479 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_device_desc} description
2480 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2481 of the adapter. If not specified, the device description is ignored
2482 during device selection.
2483 @end deffn
2484
2485 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_serial} serial-number
2486 Specifies the @var{serial-number} of the adapter to use,
2487 in case the vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter
2488 is connected to the host.
2489 If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2490 (Note that USB serial numbers can be arbitrary Unicode strings,
2491 and are not restricted to containing only decimal digits.)
2492 @end deffn
2493
2494 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_location} <bus>:<port>[,<port>]...
2495 Specifies the physical USB port of the adapter to use. The path
2496 roots at @var{bus} and walks down the physical ports, with each
2497 @var{port} option specifying a deeper level in the bus topology, the last
2498 @var{port} denoting where the target adapter is actually plugged.
2499 The USB bus topology can be queried with the command @emph{lsusb -t}.
2500
2501 This command is only available if your libusb1 is at least version 1.0.16.
2502 @end deffn
2503
2504 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_channel} channel
2505 Selects the channel of the FTDI device to use for MPSSE operations. Most
2506 adapters use the default, channel 0, but there are exceptions.
2507 @end deffn
2508
2509 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_init} data direction
2510 Specifies the initial values of the FTDI GPIO data and direction registers.
2511 Each value is a 16-bit number corresponding to the concatenation of the high
2512 and low FTDI GPIO registers. The values should be selected based on the
2513 schematics of the adapter, such that all signals are set to safe levels with
2514 minimal impact on the target system. Avoid floating inputs, conflicting outputs
2515 and initially asserted reset signals.
2516 @end deffn
2517
2518 @deffn {Config Command} {ftdi_layout_signal} name [@option{-data}|@option{-ndata} data_mask] [@option{-input}|@option{-ninput} input_mask] [@option{-oe}|@option{-noe} oe_mask] [@option{-alias}|@option{-nalias} name]
2519 Creates a signal with the specified @var{name}, controlled by one or more FTDI
2520 GPIO pins via a range of possible buffer connections. The masks are FTDI GPIO
2521 register bitmasks to tell the driver the connection and type of the output
2522 buffer driving the respective signal. @var{data_mask} is the bitmask for the
2523 pin(s) connected to the data input of the output buffer. @option{-ndata} is
2524 used with inverting data inputs and @option{-data} with non-inverting inputs.
2525 The @option{-oe} (or @option{-noe}) option tells where the output-enable (or
2526 not-output-enable) input to the output buffer is connected. The options
2527 @option{-input} and @option{-ninput} specify the bitmask for pins to be read
2528 with the method @command{ftdi_get_signal}.
2529
2530 Both @var{data_mask} and @var{oe_mask} need not be specified. For example, a
2531 simple open-collector transistor driver would be specified with @option{-oe}
2532 only. In that case the signal can only be set to drive low or to Hi-Z and the
2533 driver will complain if the signal is set to drive high. Which means that if
2534 it's a reset signal, @command{reset_config} must be specified as
2535 @option{srst_open_drain}, not @option{srst_push_pull}.
2536
2537 A special case is provided when @option{-data} and @option{-oe} is set to the
2538 same bitmask. Then the FTDI pin is considered being connected straight to the
2539 target without any buffer. The FTDI pin is then switched between output and
2540 input as necessary to provide the full set of low, high and Hi-Z
2541 characteristics. In all other cases, the pins specified in a signal definition
2542 are always driven by the FTDI.
2543
2544 If @option{-alias} or @option{-nalias} is used, the signal is created
2545 identical (or with data inverted) to an already specified signal
2546 @var{name}.
2547 @end deffn
2548
2549 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_set_signal} name @option{0}|@option{1}|@option{z}
2550 Set a previously defined signal to the specified level.
2551 @itemize @minus
2552 @item @option{0}, drive low
2553 @item @option{1}, drive high
2554 @item @option{z}, set to high-impedance
2555 @end itemize
2556 @end deffn
2557
2558 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_get_signal} name
2559 Get the value of a previously defined signal.
2560 @end deffn
2561
2562 @deffn {Command} {ftdi_tdo_sample_edge} @option{rising}|@option{falling}
2563 Configure TCK edge at which the adapter samples the value of the TDO signal
2564
2565 Due to signal propagation delays, sampling TDO on rising TCK can become quite
2566 peculiar at high JTAG clock speeds. However, FTDI chips offer a possibility to sample
2567 TDO on falling edge of TCK. With some board/adapter configurations, this may increase
2568 stability at higher JTAG clocks.
2569 @itemize @minus
2570 @item @option{rising}, sample TDO on rising edge of TCK - this is the default
2571 @item @option{falling}, sample TDO on falling edge of TCK
2572 @end itemize
2573 @end deffn
2574
2575 For example adapter definitions, see the configuration files shipped in the
2576 @file{interface/ftdi} directory.
2577
2578 @end deffn
2579
2580 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ft232r}
2581 This driver is implementing synchronous bitbang mode of an FTDI FT232R
2582 USB UART bridge IC.
2583
2584 List of connections (pin numbers for SSOP):
2585 @itemize @minus
2586 @item RXD(5) - TDI
2587 @item TXD(1) - TCK
2588 @item RTS(3) - TDO
2589 @item CTS(11) - TMS
2590 @item DTR(2) - TRST
2591 @item DCD(10) - SRST
2592 @end itemize
2593
2594 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2595 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2596
2597 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_vid_pid} @var{vid} @var{pid}
2598 The vendor ID and product ID of the adapter. If not specified, default
2599 0x0403:0x6001 is used.
2600 @end deffn
2601
2602 @deffn {Config Command} {ft232r_serial_desc} @var{serial}
2603 Specifies the @var{serial} of the adapter to use, in case the
2604 vendor provides unique IDs and more than one adapter is connected to
2605 the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2606 @end deffn
2607
2608 @end deffn
2609
2610 @deffn {Interface Driver} {remote_bitbang}
2611 Drive JTAG from a remote process. This sets up a UNIX or TCP socket connection
2612 with a remote process and sends ASCII encoded bitbang requests to that process
2613 instead of directly driving JTAG.
2614
2615 The remote_bitbang driver is useful for debugging software running on
2616 processors which are being simulated.
2617
2618 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_port} number
2619 Specifies the TCP port of the remote process to connect to or 0 to use UNIX
2620 sockets instead of TCP.
2621 @end deffn
2622
2623 @deffn {Config Command} {remote_bitbang_host} hostname
2624 Specifies the hostname of the remote process to connect to using TCP, or the
2625 name of the UNIX socket to use if remote_bitbang_port is 0.
2626 @end deffn
2627
2628 For example, to connect remotely via TCP to the host foobar you might have
2629 something like:
2630
2631 @example
2632 interface remote_bitbang
2633 remote_bitbang_port 3335
2634 remote_bitbang_host foobar
2635 @end example
2636
2637 To connect to another process running locally via UNIX sockets with socket
2638 named mysocket:
2639
2640 @example
2641 interface remote_bitbang
2642 remote_bitbang_port 0
2643 remote_bitbang_host mysocket
2644 @end example
2645 @end deffn
2646
2647 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usb_blaster}
2648 USB JTAG/USB-Blaster compatibles over one of the userspace libraries
2649 for FTDI chips. These interfaces have several commands, used to
2650 configure the driver before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2651
2652 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_device_desc} description
2653 Provides the USB device description (the @emph{iProduct string})
2654 of the FTDI FT245 device. If not
2655 specified, the FTDI default value is used. This setting is only valid
2656 if compiled with FTD2XX support.
2657 @end deffn
2658
2659 @deffn {Config Command} {usb_blaster_vid_pid} vid pid
2660 The vendor ID and product ID of the FTDI FT245 device. If not specified,
2661 default values are used.
2662 Currently, only one @var{vid}, @var{pid} pair may be given, e.g. for
2663 Altera USB-Blaster (default):
2664 @example
2665 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x09FB 0x6001
2666 @end example
2667 The following VID/PID is for Kolja Waschk's USB JTAG:
2668 @example
2669 usb_blaster_vid_pid 0x16C0 0x06AD
2670 @end example
2671 @end deffn
2672
2673 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_pin} (@option{pin6}|@option{pin8}) (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{s}|@option{t})
2674 Sets the state or function of the unused GPIO pins on USB-Blasters
2675 (pins 6 and 8 on the female JTAG header). These pins can be used as
2676 SRST and/or TRST provided the appropriate connections are made on the
2677 target board.
2678
2679 For example, to use pin 6 as SRST:
2680 @example
2681 usb_blaster_pin pin6 s
2682 reset_config srst_only
2683 @end example
2684 @end deffn
2685
2686 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_lowlevel_driver} (@option{ftdi}|@option{ublast2})
2687 Chooses the low level access method for the adapter. If not specified,
2688 @option{ftdi} is selected unless it wasn't enabled during the
2689 configure stage. USB-Blaster II needs @option{ublast2}.
2690 @end deffn
2691
2692 @deffn {Command} {usb_blaster_firmware} @var{path}
2693 This command specifies @var{path} to access USB-Blaster II firmware
2694 image. To be used with USB-Blaster II only.
2695 @end deffn
2696
2697 @end deffn
2698
2699 @deffn {Interface Driver} {gw16012}
2700 Gateworks GW16012 JTAG programmer.
2701 This has one driver-specific command:
2702
2703 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2704 Display either the address of the I/O port
2705 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2706 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2707 This is a write-once setting.
2708 @end deffn
2709 @end deffn
2710
2711 @deffn {Interface Driver} {jlink}
2712 SEGGER J-Link family of USB adapters. It currently supports JTAG and SWD
2713 transports.
2714
2715 @quotation Compatibility Note
2716 SEGGER released many firmware versions for the many hardware versions they
2717 produced. OpenOCD was extensively tested and intended to run on all of them,
2718 but some combinations were reported as incompatible. As a general
2719 recommendation, it is advisable to use the latest firmware version
2720 available for each hardware version. However the current V8 is a moving
2721 target, and SEGGER firmware versions released after the OpenOCD was
2722 released may not be compatible. In such cases it is recommended to
2723 revert to the last known functional version. For 0.5.0, this is from
2724 "Feb 8 2012 14:30:39", packed with 4.42c. For 0.6.0, the last known
2725 version is from "May 3 2012 18:36:22", packed with 4.46f.
2726 @end quotation
2727
2728 @deffn {Command} {jlink hwstatus}
2729 Display various hardware related information, for example target voltage and pin
2730 states.
2731 @end deffn
2732 @deffn {Command} {jlink freemem}
2733 Display free device internal memory.
2734 @end deffn
2735 @deffn {Command} {jlink jtag} [@option{2}|@option{3}]
2736 Set the JTAG command version to be used. Without argument, show the actual JTAG
2737 command version.
2738 @end deffn
2739 @deffn {Command} {jlink config}
2740 Display the device configuration.
2741 @end deffn
2742 @deffn {Command} {jlink config targetpower} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
2743 Set the target power state on JTAG-pin 19. Without argument, show the target
2744 power state.
2745 @end deffn
2746 @deffn {Command} {jlink config mac} [@option{ff:ff:ff:ff:ff:ff}]
2747 Set the MAC address of the device. Without argument, show the MAC address.
2748 @end deffn
2749 @deffn {Command} {jlink config ip} [@option{A.B.C.D}(@option{/E}|@option{F.G.H.I})]
2750 Set the IP configuration of the device, where A.B.C.D is the IP address, E the
2751 bit of the subnet mask and F.G.H.I the subnet mask. Without arguments, show the
2752 IP configuration.
2753 @end deffn
2754 @deffn {Command} {jlink config usb} [@option{0} to @option{3}]
2755 Set the USB address of the device. This will also change the USB Product ID
2756 (PID) of the device. Without argument, show the USB address.
2757 @end deffn
2758 @deffn {Command} {jlink config reset}
2759 Reset the current configuration.
2760 @end deffn
2761 @deffn {Command} {jlink config write}
2762 Write the current configuration to the internal persistent storage.
2763 @end deffn
2764 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom write <channel> <data>}
2765 Write data to an EMUCOM channel. The data needs to be encoded as hexadecimal
2766 pairs.
2767
2768 The following example shows how to write the three bytes 0xaa, 0x0b and 0x23 to
2769 the EMUCOM channel 0x10:
2770 @example
2771 > jlink emucom write 0x10 aa0b23
2772 @end example
2773 @end deffn
2774 @deffn {Command} {jlink emucom read <channel> <length>}
2775 Read data from an EMUCOM channel. The read data is encoded as hexadecimal
2776 pairs.
2777
2778 The following example shows how to read 4 bytes from the EMUCOM channel 0x0:
2779 @example
2780 > jlink emucom read 0x0 4
2781 77a90000
2782 @end example
2783 @end deffn
2784 @deffn {Config} {jlink usb} <@option{0} to @option{3}>
2785 Set the USB address of the interface, in case more than one adapter is connected
2786 to the host. If not specified, USB addresses are not considered. Device
2787 selection via USB address is deprecated and the serial number should be used
2788 instead.
2789
2790 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2791 @end deffn
2792 @deffn {Config} {jlink serial} <serial number>
2793 Set the serial number of the interface, in case more than one adapter is
2794 connected to the host. If not specified, serial numbers are not considered.
2795
2796 As a configuration command, it can be used only before 'init'.
2797 @end deffn
2798 @end deffn
2799
2800 @deffn {Interface Driver} {kitprog}
2801 This driver is for Cypress Semiconductor's KitProg adapters. The KitProg is an
2802 SWD-only adapter that is designed to be used with Cypress's PSoC and PRoC device
2803 families, but it is possible to use it with some other devices. If you are using
2804 this adapter with a PSoC or a PRoC, you may need to add
2805 @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} or @command{kitprog acquire_psoc} to your
2806 configuration script.
2807
2808 Note that this driver is for the proprietary KitProg protocol, not the CMSIS-DAP
2809 mode introduced in firmware 2.14. If the KitProg is in CMSIS-DAP mode, it cannot
2810 be used with this driver, and must either be used with the cmsis-dap driver or
2811 switched back to KitProg mode. See the Cypress KitProg User Guide for
2812 instructions on how to switch KitProg modes.
2813
2814 Known limitations:
2815 @itemize @bullet
2816 @item The frequency of SWCLK cannot be configured, and varies between 1.6 MHz
2817 and 2.7 MHz.
2818 @item For firmware versions below 2.14, "JTAG to SWD" sequences are replaced by
2819 "SWD line reset" in the driver. This is for two reasons. First, the KitProg does
2820 not support sending arbitrary SWD sequences, and only firmware 2.14 and later
2821 implement both "JTAG to SWD" and "SWD line reset" in firmware. Earlier firmware
2822 versions only implement "SWD line reset". Second, due to a firmware quirk, an
2823 SWD sequence must be sent after every target reset in order to re-establish
2824 communications with the target.
2825 @item Due in part to the limitation above, KitProg devices with firmware below
2826 version 2.14 will need to use @command{kitprog_init_acquire_psoc} in order to
2827 communicate with PSoC 5LP devices. This is because, assuming debug is not
2828 disabled on the PSoC, the PSoC 5LP needs its JTAG interface switched to SWD
2829 mode before communication can begin, but prior to firmware 2.14, "JTAG to SWD"
2830 could only be sent with an acquisition sequence.
2831 @end itemize
2832
2833 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_init_acquire_psoc}
2834 Indicate that a PSoC acquisition sequence needs to be run during adapter init.
2835 Please be aware that the acquisition sequence hard-resets the target.
2836 @end deffn
2837
2838 @deffn {Config Command} {kitprog_serial} serial
2839 Select a KitProg device by its @var{serial}. If left unspecified, the first
2840 device detected by OpenOCD will be used.
2841 @end deffn
2842
2843 @deffn {Command} {kitprog acquire_psoc}
2844 Run a PSoC acquisition sequence immediately. Typically, this should not be used
2845 outside of the target-specific configuration scripts since it hard-resets the
2846 target as a side-effect.
2847 This is necessary for "reset halt" on some PSoC 4 series devices.
2848 @end deffn
2849
2850 @deffn {Command} {kitprog info}
2851 Display various adapter information, such as the hardware version, firmware
2852 version, and target voltage.
2853 @end deffn
2854 @end deffn
2855
2856 @deffn {Interface Driver} {parport}
2857 Supports PC parallel port bit-banging cables:
2858 Wigglers, PLD download cable, and more.
2859 These interfaces have several commands, used to configure the driver
2860 before initializing the JTAG scan chain:
2861
2862 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_cable} name
2863 Set the layout of the parallel port cable used to connect to the target.
2864 This is a write-once setting.
2865 Currently valid cable @var{name} values include:
2866
2867 @itemize @minus
2868 @item @b{altium} Altium Universal JTAG cable.
2869 @item @b{arm-jtag} Same as original wiggler except SRST and
2870 TRST connections reversed and TRST is also inverted.
2871 @item @b{chameleon} The Amontec Chameleon's CPLD when operated
2872 in configuration mode. This is only used to
2873 program the Chameleon itself, not a connected target.
2874 @item @b{dlc5} The Xilinx Parallel cable III.
2875 @item @b{flashlink} The ST Parallel cable.
2876 @item @b{lattice} Lattice ispDOWNLOAD Cable
2877 @item @b{old_amt_wiggler} The Wiggler configuration that comes with
2878 some versions of
2879 Amontec's Chameleon Programmer. The new version available from
2880 the website uses the original Wiggler layout ('@var{wiggler}')
2881 @item @b{triton} The parallel port adapter found on the
2882 ``Karo Triton 1 Development Board''.
2883 This is also the layout used by the HollyGates design
2884 (see @uref{http://www.lartmaker.nl/projects/jtag/}).
2885 @item @b{wiggler} The original Wiggler layout, also supported by
2886 several clones, such as the Olimex ARM-JTAG
2887 @item @b{wiggler2} Same as original wiggler except an led is fitted on D5.
2888 @item @b{wiggler_ntrst_inverted} Same as original wiggler except TRST is inverted.
2889 @end itemize
2890 @end deffn
2891
2892 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_port} [port_number]
2893 Display either the address of the I/O port
2894 (default: 0x378 for LPT1) or the number of the @file{/dev/parport} device.
2895 If a parameter is provided, first switch to use that port.
2896 This is a write-once setting.
2897
2898 When using PPDEV to access the parallel port, use the number of the parallel port:
2899 @option{parport_port 0} (the default). If @option{parport_port 0x378} is specified
2900 you may encounter a problem.
2901 @end deffn
2902
2903 @deffn Command {parport_toggling_time} [nanoseconds]
2904 Displays how many nanoseconds the hardware needs to toggle TCK;
2905 the parport driver uses this value to obey the
2906 @command{adapter_khz} configuration.
2907 When the optional @var{nanoseconds} parameter is given,
2908 that setting is changed before displaying the current value.
2909
2910 The default setting should work reasonably well on commodity PC hardware.
2911 However, you may want to calibrate for your specific hardware.
2912 @quotation Tip
2913 To measure the toggling time with a logic analyzer or a digital storage
2914 oscilloscope, follow the procedure below:
2915 @example
2916 > parport_toggling_time 1000
2917 > adapter_khz 500
2918 @end example
2919 This sets the maximum JTAG clock speed of the hardware, but
2920 the actual speed probably deviates from the requested 500 kHz.
2921 Now, measure the time between the two closest spaced TCK transitions.
2922 You can use @command{runtest 1000} or something similar to generate a
2923 large set of samples.
2924 Update the setting to match your measurement:
2925 @example
2926 > parport_toggling_time <measured nanoseconds>
2927 @end example
2928 Now the clock speed will be a better match for @command{adapter_khz rate}
2929 commands given in OpenOCD scripts and event handlers.
2930
2931 You can do something similar with many digital multimeters, but note
2932 that you'll probably need to run the clock continuously for several
2933 seconds before it decides what clock rate to show. Adjust the
2934 toggling time up or down until the measured clock rate is a good
2935 match for the adapter_khz rate you specified; be conservative.
2936 @end quotation
2937 @end deffn
2938
2939 @deffn {Config Command} {parport_write_on_exit} (@option{on}|@option{off})
2940 This will configure the parallel driver to write a known
2941 cable-specific value to the parallel interface on exiting OpenOCD.
2942 @end deffn
2943
2944 For example, the interface configuration file for a
2945 classic ``Wiggler'' cable on LPT2 might look something like this:
2946
2947 @example
2948 interface parport
2949 parport_port 0x278
2950 parport_cable wiggler
2951 @end example
2952 @end deffn
2953
2954 @deffn {Interface Driver} {presto}
2955 ASIX PRESTO USB JTAG programmer.
2956 @deffn {Config Command} {presto_serial} serial_string
2957 Configures the USB serial number of the Presto device to use.
2958 @end deffn
2959 @end deffn
2960
2961 @deffn {Interface Driver} {rlink}
2962 Raisonance RLink USB adapter
2963 @end deffn
2964
2965 @deffn {Interface Driver} {usbprog}
2966 usbprog is a freely programmable USB adapter.
2967 @end deffn
2968
2969 @deffn {Interface Driver} {vsllink}
2970 vsllink is part of Versaloon which is a versatile USB programmer.
2971
2972 @quotation Note
2973 This defines quite a few driver-specific commands,
2974 which are not currently documented here.
2975 @end quotation
2976 @end deffn
2977
2978 @anchor{hla_interface}
2979 @deffn {Interface Driver} {hla}
2980 This is a driver that supports multiple High Level Adapters.
2981 This type of adapter does not expose some of the lower level api's
2982 that OpenOCD would normally use to access the target.
2983
2984 Currently supported adapters include the ST ST-LINK and TI ICDI.
2985 ST-LINK firmware version >= V2.J21.S4 recommended due to issues with earlier
2986 versions of firmware where serial number is reset after first use. Suggest
2987 using ST firmware update utility to upgrade ST-LINK firmware even if current
2988 version reported is V2.J21.S4.
2989
2990 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_device_desc} description
2991 Currently Not Supported.
2992 @end deffn
2993
2994 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_serial} serial
2995 Specifies the serial number of the adapter.
2996 @end deffn
2997
2998 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_layout} (@option{stlink}|@option{icdi})
2999 Specifies the adapter layout to use.
3000 @end deffn
3001
3002 @deffn {Config Command} {hla_vid_pid} [vid pid]+
3003 Pairs of vendor IDs and product IDs of the device.
3004 @end deffn
3005
3006 @deffn {Command} {hla_command} command
3007 Execute a custom adapter-specific command. The @var{command} string is
3008 passed as is to the underlying adapter layout handler.
3009 @end deffn
3010 @end deffn
3011
3012 @deffn {Interface Driver} {opendous}
3013 opendous-jtag is a freely programmable USB adapter.
3014 @end deffn
3015
3016 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ulink}
3017 This is the Keil ULINK v1 JTAG debugger.
3018 @end deffn
3019
3020 @deffn {Interface Driver} {ZY1000}
3021 This is the Zylin ZY1000 JTAG debugger.
3022 @end deffn
3023
3024 @quotation Note
3025 This defines some driver-specific commands,
3026 which are not currently documented here.
3027 @end quotation
3028
3029 @deffn Command power [@option{on}|@option{off}]
3030 Turn power switch to target on/off.
3031 No arguments: print status.
3032 @end deffn
3033
3034 @deffn {Interface Driver} {bcm2835gpio}
3035 This SoC is present in Raspberry Pi which is a cheap single-board computer
3036 exposing some GPIOs on its expansion header.
3037
3038 The driver accesses memory-mapped GPIO peripheral registers directly
3039 for maximum performance, but the only possible race condition is for
3040 the pins' modes/muxing (which is highly unlikely), so it should be
3041 able to coexist nicely with both sysfs bitbanging and various
3042 peripherals' kernel drivers. The driver restores the previous
3043 configuration on exit.
3044
3045 See @file{interface/raspberrypi-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3046 pinout.
3047
3048 @end deffn
3049
3050 @deffn {Interface Driver} {imx_gpio}
3051 i.MX SoC is present in many community boards. Wandboard is an example
3052 of the one which is most popular.
3053
3054 This driver is mostly the same as bcm2835gpio.
3055
3056 See @file{interface/imx-native.cfg} for a sample config and
3057 pinout.
3058
3059 @end deffn
3060
3061
3062 @deffn {Interface Driver} {openjtag}
3063 OpenJTAG compatible USB adapter.
3064 This defines some driver-specific commands:
3065
3066 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_variant} variant
3067 Specifies the variant of the OpenJTAG adapter (see @uref{http://www.openjtag.org/}).
3068 Currently valid @var{variant} values include:
3069
3070 @itemize @minus
3071 @item @b{standard} Standard variant (default).
3072 @item @b{cy7c65215} Cypress CY7C65215 Dual Channel USB-Serial Bridge Controller
3073 (see @uref{http://www.cypress.com/?rID=82870}).
3074 @end itemize
3075 @end deffn
3076
3077 @deffn {Config Command} {openjtag_device_desc} string
3078 The USB device description string of the adapter.
3079 This value is only used with the standard variant.
3080 @end deffn
3081 @end deffn
3082
3083 @section Transport Configuration
3084 @cindex Transport
3085 As noted earlier, depending on the version of OpenOCD you use,
3086 and the debug adapter you are using,
3087 several transports may be available to
3088 communicate with debug targets (or perhaps to program flash memory).
3089 @deffn Command {transport list}
3090 displays the names of the transports supported by this
3091 version of OpenOCD.
3092 @end deffn
3093
3094 @deffn Command {transport select} @option{transport_name}
3095 Select which of the supported transports to use in this OpenOCD session.
3096
3097 When invoked with @option{transport_name}, attempts to select the named
3098 transport. The transport must be supported by the debug adapter
3099 hardware and by the version of OpenOCD you are using (including the
3100 adapter's driver).
3101
3102 If no transport has been selected and no @option{transport_name} is
3103 provided, @command{transport select} auto-selects the first transport
3104 supported by the debug adapter.
3105
3106 @command{transport select} always returns the name of the session's selected
3107 transport, if any.
3108 @end deffn
3109
3110 @subsection JTAG Transport
3111 @cindex JTAG
3112 JTAG is the original transport supported by OpenOCD, and most
3113 of the OpenOCD commands support it.
3114 JTAG transports expose a chain of one or more Test Access Points (TAPs),
3115 each of which must be explicitly declared.
3116 JTAG supports both debugging and boundary scan testing.
3117 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3118
3119 JTAG transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3120 jtag}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3121 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3122 hla_jtag}.
3123
3124 @subsection SWD Transport
3125 @cindex SWD
3126 @cindex Serial Wire Debug
3127 SWD (Serial Wire Debug) is an ARM-specific transport which exposes one
3128 Debug Access Point (DAP, which must be explicitly declared.
3129 (SWD uses fewer signal wires than JTAG.)
3130 SWD is debug-oriented, and does not support boundary scan testing.
3131 Flash programming support is built on top of debug support.
3132 (Some processors support both JTAG and SWD.)
3133
3134 SWD transport is selected with the command @command{transport select
3135 swd}. Unless your adapter uses @ref{hla_interface,the hla interface
3136 driver}, in which case the command is @command{transport select
3137 hla_swd}.
3138
3139 @deffn Command {swd newdap} ...
3140 Declares a single DAP which uses SWD transport.
3141 Parameters are currently the same as "jtag newtap" but this is
3142 expected to change.
3143 @end deffn
3144 @deffn Command {swd wcr trn prescale}
3145 Updates TRN (turnaround delay) and prescaling.fields of the
3146 Wire Control Register (WCR).
3147 No parameters: displays current settings.
3148 @end deffn
3149
3150 @subsection SPI Transport
3151 @cindex SPI
3152 @cindex Serial Peripheral Interface
3153 The Serial Peripheral Interface (SPI) is a general purpose transport
3154 which uses four wire signaling. Some processors use it as part of a
3155 solution for flash programming.
3156
3157 @anchor{jtagspeed}
3158 @section JTAG Speed
3159 JTAG clock setup is part of system setup.
3160 It @emph{does not belong with interface setup} since any interface
3161 only knows a few of the constraints for the JTAG clock speed.
3162 Sometimes the JTAG speed is
3163 changed during the target initialization process: (1) slow at
3164 reset, (2) program the CPU clocks, (3) run fast.
3165 Both the "slow" and "fast" clock rates are functions of the
3166 oscillators used, the chip, the board design, and sometimes
3167 power management software that may be active.
3168
3169 The speed used during reset, and the scan chain verification which
3170 follows reset, can be adjusted using a @code{reset-start}
3171 target event handler.
3172 It can then be reconfigured to a faster speed by a
3173 @code{reset-init} target event handler after it reprograms those
3174 CPU clocks, or manually (if something else, such as a boot loader,
3175 sets up those clocks).
3176 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
3177 When the initial low JTAG speed is a chip characteristic, perhaps
3178 because of a required oscillator speed, provide such a handler
3179 in the target config file.
3180 When that speed is a function of a board-specific characteristic
3181 such as which speed oscillator is used, it belongs in the board
3182 config file instead.
3183 In both cases it's safest to also set the initial JTAG clock rate
3184 to that same slow speed, so that OpenOCD never starts up using a
3185 clock speed that's faster than the scan chain can support.
3186
3187 @example
3188 jtag_rclk 3000
3189 $_TARGET.cpu configure -event reset-start @{ jtag_rclk 3000 @}
3190 @end example
3191
3192 If your system supports adaptive clocking (RTCK), configuring
3193 JTAG to use that is probably the most robust approach.
3194 However, it introduces delays to synchronize clocks; so it
3195 may not be the fastest solution.
3196
3197 @b{NOTE:} Script writers should consider using @command{jtag_rclk}
3198 instead of @command{adapter_khz}, but only for (ARM) cores and boards
3199 which support adaptive clocking.
3200
3201 @deffn {Command} adapter_khz max_speed_kHz
3202 A non-zero speed is in KHZ. Hence: 3000 is 3mhz.
3203 JTAG interfaces usually support a limited number of
3204 speeds. The speed actually used won't be faster
3205 than the speed specified.
3206
3207 Chip data sheets generally include a top JTAG clock rate.
3208 The actual rate is often a function of a CPU core clock,
3209 and is normally less than that peak rate.
3210 For example, most ARM cores accept at most one sixth of the CPU clock.
3211
3212 Speed 0 (khz) selects RTCK method.
3213 @xref{faqrtck,,FAQ RTCK}.
3214 If your system uses RTCK, you won't need to change the
3215 JTAG clocking after setup.
3216 Not all interfaces, boards, or targets support ``rtck''.
3217 If the interface device can not
3218 support it, an error is returned when you try to use RTCK.
3219 @end deffn
3220
3221 @defun jtag_rclk fallback_speed_kHz
3222 @cindex adaptive clocking
3223 @cindex RTCK
3224 This Tcl proc (defined in @file{startup.tcl}) attempts to enable RTCK/RCLK.
3225 If that fails (maybe the interface, board, or target doesn't
3226 support it), falls back to the specified frequency.
3227 @example
3228 # Fall back to 3mhz if RTCK is not supported
3229 jtag_rclk 3000
3230 @end example
3231 @end defun
3232
3233 @node Reset Configuration
3234 @chapter Reset Configuration
3235 @cindex Reset Configuration
3236
3237 Every system configuration may require a different reset
3238 configuration. This can also be quite confusing.
3239 Resets also interact with @var{reset-init} event handlers,
3240 which do things like setting up clocks and DRAM, and
3241 JTAG clock rates. (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}.)
3242 They can also interact with JTAG routers.
3243 Please see the various board files for examples.
3244
3245 @quotation Note
3246 To maintainers and integrators:
3247 Reset configuration touches several things at once.
3248 Normally the board configuration file
3249 should define it and assume that the JTAG adapter supports
3250 everything that's wired up to the board's JTAG connector.
3251
3252 However, the target configuration file could also make note
3253 of something the silicon vendor has done inside the chip,
3254 which will be true for most (or all) boards using that chip.
3255 And when the JTAG adapter doesn't support everything, the
3256 user configuration file will need to override parts of
3257 the reset configuration provided by other files.
3258 @end quotation
3259
3260 @section Types of Reset
3261
3262 There are many kinds of reset possible through JTAG, but
3263 they may not all work with a given board and adapter.
3264 That's part of why reset configuration can be error prone.
3265
3266 @itemize @bullet
3267 @item
3268 @emph{System Reset} ... the @emph{SRST} hardware signal
3269 resets all chips connected to the JTAG adapter, such as processors,
3270 power management chips, and I/O controllers. Normally resets triggered
3271 with this signal behave exactly like pressing a RESET button.
3272 @item
3273 @emph{JTAG TAP Reset} ... the @emph{TRST} hardware signal resets
3274 just the TAP controllers connected to the JTAG adapter.
3275 Such resets should not be visible to the rest of the system; resetting a
3276 device's TAP controller just puts that controller into a known state.
3277 @item
3278 @emph{Emulation Reset} ... many devices can be reset through JTAG
3279 commands. These resets are often distinguishable from system
3280 resets, either explicitly (a "reset reason" register says so)
3281 or implicitly (not all parts of the chip get reset).
3282 @item
3283 @emph{Other Resets} ... system-on-chip devices often support
3284 several other types of reset.
3285 You may need to arrange that a watchdog timer stops
3286 while debugging, preventing a watchdog reset.
3287 There may be individual module resets.
3288 @end itemize
3289
3290 In the best case, OpenOCD can hold SRST, then reset
3291 the TAPs via TRST and send commands through JTAG to halt the
3292 CPU at the reset vector before the 1st instruction is executed.
3293 Then when it finally releases the SRST signal, the system is
3294 halted under debugger control before any code has executed.
3295 This is the behavior required to support the @command{reset halt}
3296 and @command{reset init} commands; after @command{reset init} a
3297 board-specific script might do things like setting up DRAM.
3298 (@xref{resetcommand,,Reset Command}.)
3299
3300 @anchor{srstandtrstissues}
3301 @section SRST and TRST Issues
3302
3303 Because SRST and TRST are hardware signals, they can have a
3304 variety of system-specific constraints. Some of the most
3305 common issues are:
3306
3307 @itemize @bullet
3308
3309 @item @emph{Signal not available} ... Some boards don't wire
3310 SRST or TRST to the JTAG connector. Some JTAG adapters don't
3311 support such signals even if they are wired up.
3312 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{signals} options to say
3313 when either of those signals is not connected.
3314 When SRST is not available, your code might not be able to rely
3315 on controllers having been fully reset during code startup.
3316 Missing TRST is not a problem, since JTAG-level resets can
3317 be triggered using with TMS signaling.
3318
3319 @item @emph{Signals shorted} ... Sometimes a chip, board, or
3320 adapter will connect SRST to TRST, instead of keeping them separate.
3321 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{combination} options to say
3322 when those signals aren't properly independent.
3323
3324 @item @emph{Timing} ... Reset circuitry like a resistor/capacitor
3325 delay circuit, reset supervisor, or on-chip features can extend
3326 the effect of a JTAG adapter's reset for some time after the adapter
3327 stops issuing the reset. For example, there may be chip or board
3328 requirements that all reset pulses last for at least a
3329 certain amount of time; and reset buttons commonly have
3330 hardware debouncing.
3331 Use the @command{adapter_nsrst_delay} and @command{jtag_ntrst_delay}
3332 commands to say when extra delays are needed.
3333
3334 @item @emph{Drive type} ... Reset lines often have a pullup
3335 resistor, letting the JTAG interface treat them as open-drain
3336 signals. But that's not a requirement, so the adapter may need
3337 to use push/pull output drivers.
3338 Also, with weak pullups it may be advisable to drive
3339 signals to both levels (push/pull) to minimize rise times.
3340 Use the @command{reset_config} @var{trst_type} and
3341 @var{srst_type} parameters to say how to drive reset signals.
3342
3343 @item @emph{Special initialization} ... Targets sometimes need
3344 special JTAG initialization sequences to handle chip-specific
3345 issues (not limited to errata).
3346 For example, certain JTAG commands might need to be issued while
3347 the system as a whole is in a reset state (SRST active)
3348 but the JTAG scan chain is usable (TRST inactive).
3349 Many systems treat combined assertion of SRST and TRST as a
3350 trigger for a harder reset than SRST alone.
3351 Such custom reset handling is discussed later in this chapter.
3352 @end itemize
3353
3354 There can also be other issues.
3355 Some devices don't fully conform to the JTAG specifications.
3356 Trivial system-specific differences are common, such as
3357 SRST and TRST using slightly different names.
3358 There are also vendors who distribute key JTAG documentation for
3359 their chips only to developers who have signed a Non-Disclosure
3360 Agreement (NDA).
3361
3362 Sometimes there are chip-specific extensions like a requirement to use
3363 the normally-optional TRST signal (precluding use of JTAG adapters which
3364 don't pass TRST through), or needing extra steps to complete a TAP reset.
3365
3366 In short, SRST and especially TRST handling may be very finicky,
3367 needing to cope with both architecture and board specific constraints.
3368
3369 @section Commands for Handling Resets
3370
3371 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_assert_width milliseconds
3372 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3373 after asserting nSRST (active-low system reset) before
3374 allowing it to be deasserted.
3375 @end deffn
3376
3377 @deffn {Command} adapter_nsrst_delay milliseconds
3378 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3379 nSRST (active-low system reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3380 When a board has a reset button connected to SRST line it will
3381 probably have hardware debouncing, implying you should use this.
3382 @end deffn
3383
3384 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_assert_width milliseconds
3385 Minimum amount of time (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait
3386 after asserting nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before
3387 allowing it to be deasserted.
3388 @end deffn
3389
3390 @deffn {Command} jtag_ntrst_delay milliseconds
3391 How long (in milliseconds) OpenOCD should wait after deasserting
3392 nTRST (active-low JTAG TAP reset) before starting new JTAG operations.
3393 @end deffn
3394
3395 @deffn {Command} reset_config mode_flag ...
3396 This command displays or modifies the reset configuration
3397 of your combination of JTAG board and target in target
3398 configuration scripts.
3399
3400 Information earlier in this section describes the kind of problems
3401 the command is intended to address (@pxref{srstandtrstissues,,SRST and TRST Issues}).
3402 As a rule this command belongs only in board config files,
3403 describing issues like @emph{board doesn't connect TRST};
3404 or in user config files, addressing limitations derived
3405 from a particular combination of interface and board.
3406 (An unlikely example would be using a TRST-only adapter
3407 with a board that only wires up SRST.)
3408
3409 The @var{mode_flag} options can be specified in any order, but only one
3410 of each type -- @var{signals}, @var{combination}, @var{gates},
3411 @var{trst_type}, @var{srst_type} and @var{connect_type}
3412 -- may be specified at a time.
3413 If you don't provide a new value for a given type, its previous
3414 value (perhaps the default) is unchanged.
3415 For example, this means that you don't need to say anything at all about
3416 TRST just to declare that if the JTAG adapter should want to drive SRST,
3417 it must explicitly be driven high (@option{srst_push_pull}).
3418
3419 @itemize
3420 @item
3421 @var{signals} can specify which of the reset signals are connected.
3422 For example, If the JTAG interface provides SRST, but the board doesn't
3423 connect that signal properly, then OpenOCD can't use it.
3424 Possible values are @option{none} (the default), @option{trst_only},
3425 @option{srst_only} and @option{trst_and_srst}.
3426
3427 @quotation Tip
3428 If your board provides SRST and/or TRST through the JTAG connector,
3429 you must declare that so those signals can be used.
3430 @end quotation
3431
3432 @item
3433 The @var{combination} is an optional value specifying broken reset
3434 signal implementations.
3435 The default behaviour if no option given is @option{separate},
3436 indicating everything behaves normally.
3437 @option{srst_pulls_trst} states that the
3438 test logic is reset together with the reset of the system (e.g. NXP
3439 LPC2000, "broken" board layout), @option{trst_pulls_srst} says that
3440 the system is reset together with the test logic (only hypothetical, I
3441 haven't seen hardware with such a bug, and can be worked around).
3442 @option{combined} implies both @option{srst_pulls_trst} and
3443 @option{trst_pulls_srst}.
3444
3445 @item
3446 The @var{gates} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3447 JTAG may be unavailable during reset.
3448 @option{srst_gates_jtag} (default)
3449 indicates that asserting SRST gates the
3450 JTAG clock. This means that no communication can happen on JTAG
3451 while SRST is asserted.
3452 Its converse is @option{srst_nogate}, indicating that JTAG commands
3453 can safely be issued while SRST is active.
3454
3455 @item
3456 The @var{connect_type} tokens control flags that describe some cases where
3457 SRST is asserted while connecting to the target. @option{srst_nogate}
3458 is required to use this option.
3459 @option{connect_deassert_srst} (default)
3460 indicates that SRST will not be asserted while connecting to the target.
3461 Its converse is @option{connect_assert_srst}, indicating that SRST will
3462 be asserted before any target connection.
3463 Only some targets support this feature, STM32 and STR9 are examples.
3464 This feature is useful if you are unable to connect to your target due
3465 to incorrect options byte config or illegal program execution.
3466 @end itemize
3467
3468 The optional @var{trst_type} and @var{srst_type} parameters allow the
3469 driver mode of each reset line to be specified. These values only affect
3470 JTAG interfaces with support for different driver modes, like the Amontec
3471 JTAGkey and JTAG Accelerator. Also, they are necessarily ignored if the
3472 relevant signal (TRST or SRST) is not connected.
3473
3474 @itemize
3475 @item
3476 Possible @var{trst_type} driver modes for the test reset signal (TRST)
3477 are the default @option{trst_push_pull}, and @option{trst_open_drain}.
3478 Most boards connect this signal to a pulldown, so the JTAG TAPs
3479 never leave reset unless they are hooked up to a JTAG adapter.
3480
3481 @item
3482 Possible @var{srst_type} driver modes for the system reset signal (SRST)
3483 are the default @option{srst_open_drain}, and @option{srst_push_pull}.
3484 Most boards connect this signal to a pullup, and allow the
3485 signal to be pulled low by various events including system
3486 power-up and pressing a reset button.
3487 @end itemize
3488 @end deffn
3489
3490 @section Custom Reset Handling
3491 @cindex events
3492
3493 OpenOCD has several ways to help support the various reset
3494 mechanisms provided by chip and board vendors.
3495 The commands shown in the previous section give standard parameters.
3496 There are also @emph{event handlers} associated with TAPs or Targets.
3497 Those handlers are Tcl procedures you can provide, which are invoked
3498 at particular points in the reset sequence.
3499
3500 @emph{When SRST is not an option} you must set
3501 up a @code{reset-assert} event handler for your target.
3502 For example, some JTAG adapters don't include the SRST signal;
3503 and some boards have multiple targets, and you won't always
3504 want to reset everything at once.
3505
3506 After configuring those mechanisms, you might still
3507 find your board doesn't start up or reset correctly.
3508 For example, maybe it needs a slightly different sequence
3509 of SRST and/or TRST manipulations, because of quirks that
3510 the @command{reset_config} mechanism doesn't address;
3511 or asserting both might trigger a stronger reset, which
3512 needs special attention.
3513
3514 Experiment with lower level operations, such as @command{jtag_reset}
3515 and the @command{jtag arp_*} operations shown here,
3516 to find a sequence of operations that works.
3517 @xref{JTAG Commands}.
3518 When you find a working sequence, it can be used to override
3519 @command{jtag_init}, which fires during OpenOCD startup
3520 (@pxref{configurationstage,,Configuration Stage});
3521 or @command{init_reset}, which fires during reset processing.
3522
3523 You might also want to provide some project-specific reset
3524 schemes. For example, on a multi-target board the standard
3525 @command{reset} command would reset all targets, but you
3526 may need the ability to reset only one target at time and
3527 thus want to avoid using the board-wide SRST signal.
3528
3529 @deffn {Overridable Procedure} init_reset mode
3530 This is invoked near the beginning of the @command{reset} command,
3531 usually to provide as much of a cold (power-up) reset as practical.
3532 By default it is also invoked from @command{jtag_init} if
3533 the scan chain does not respond to pure JTAG operations.
3534 The @var{mode} parameter is the parameter given to the
3535 low level reset command (@option{halt},
3536 @option{init}, or @option{run}), @option{setup},
3537 or potentially some other value.
3538
3539 The default implementation just invokes @command{jtag arp_init-reset}.
3540 Replacements will normally build on low level JTAG
3541 operations such as @command{jtag_reset}.
3542 Operations here must not address individual TAPs
3543 (or their associated targets)
3544 until the JTAG scan chain has first been verified to work.
3545
3546 Implementations must have verified the JTAG scan chain before
3547 they return.
3548 This is done by calling @command{jtag arp_init}
3549 (or @command{jtag arp_init-reset}).
3550 @end deffn
3551
3552 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init}
3553 This validates the scan chain using just the four
3554 standard JTAG signals (TMS, TCK, TDI, TDO).
3555 It starts by issuing a JTAG-only reset.
3556 Then it performs checks to verify that the scan chain configuration
3557 matches the TAPs it can observe.
3558 Those checks include checking IDCODE values for each active TAP,
3559 and verifying the length of their instruction registers using
3560 TAP @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} values.
3561 If these tests all pass, TAP @code{setup} events are
3562 issued to all TAPs with handlers for that event.
3563 @end deffn
3564
3565 @deffn Command {jtag arp_init-reset}
3566 This uses TRST and SRST to try resetting
3567 everything on the JTAG scan chain
3568 (and anything else connected to SRST).
3569 It then invokes the logic of @command{jtag arp_init}.
3570 @end deffn
3571
3572
3573 @node TAP Declaration
3574 @chapter TAP Declaration
3575 @cindex TAP declaration
3576 @cindex TAP configuration
3577
3578 @emph{Test Access Ports} (TAPs) are the core of JTAG.
3579 TAPs serve many roles, including:
3580
3581 @itemize @bullet
3582 @item @b{Debug Target} A CPU TAP can be used as a GDB debug target.
3583 @item @b{Flash Programming} Some chips program the flash directly via JTAG.
3584 Others do it indirectly, making a CPU do it.
3585 @item @b{Program Download} Using the same CPU support GDB uses,
3586 you can initialize a DRAM controller, download code to DRAM, and then
3587 start running that code.
3588 @item @b{Boundary Scan} Most chips support boundary scan, which
3589 helps test for board assembly problems like solder bridges
3590 and missing connections.
3591 @end itemize
3592
3593 OpenOCD must know about the active TAPs on your board(s).
3594 Setting up the TAPs is the core task of your configuration files.
3595 Once those TAPs are set up, you can pass their names to code
3596 which sets up CPUs and exports them as GDB targets,
3597 probes flash memory, performs low-level JTAG operations, and more.
3598
3599 @section Scan Chains
3600 @cindex scan chain
3601
3602 TAPs are part of a hardware @dfn{scan chain},
3603 which is a daisy chain of TAPs.
3604 They also need to be added to
3605 OpenOCD's software mirror of that hardware list,
3606 giving each member a name and associating other data with it.
3607 Simple scan chains, with a single TAP, are common in
3608 systems with a single microcontroller or microprocessor.
3609 More complex chips may have several TAPs internally.
3610 Very complex scan chains might have a dozen or more TAPs:
3611 several in one chip, more in the next, and connecting
3612 to other boards with their own chips and TAPs.
3613
3614 You can display the list with the @command{scan_chain} command.
3615 (Don't confuse this with the list displayed by the @command{targets}
3616 command, presented in the next chapter.
3617 That only displays TAPs for CPUs which are configured as
3618 debugging targets.)
3619 Here's what the scan chain might look like for a chip more than one TAP:
3620
3621 @verbatim
3622 TapName Enabled IdCode Expected IrLen IrCap IrMask
3623 -- ------------------ ------- ---------- ---------- ----- ----- ------
3624 0 omap5912.dsp Y 0x03df1d81 0x03df1d81 38 0x01 0x03
3625 1 omap5912.arm Y 0x0692602f 0x0692602f 4 0x01 0x0f
3626 2 omap5912.unknown Y 0x00000000 0x00000000 8 0x01 0x03
3627 @end verbatim
3628
3629 OpenOCD can detect some of that information, but not all
3630 of it. @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3631 Unfortunately, those TAPs can't always be autoconfigured,
3632 because not all devices provide good support for that.
3633 JTAG doesn't require supporting IDCODE instructions, and
3634 chips with JTAG routers may not link TAPs into the chain
3635 until they are told to do so.
3636
3637 The configuration mechanism currently supported by OpenOCD
3638 requires explicit configuration of all TAP devices using
3639 @command{jtag newtap} commands, as detailed later in this chapter.
3640 A command like this would declare one tap and name it @code{chip1.cpu}:
3641
3642 @example
3643 jtag newtap chip1 cpu -irlen 4 -expected-id 0x3ba00477
3644 @end example
3645
3646 Each target configuration file lists the TAPs provided
3647 by a given chip.
3648 Board configuration files combine all the targets on a board,
3649 and so forth.
3650 Note that @emph{the order in which TAPs are declared is very important.}
3651 That declaration order must match the order in the JTAG scan chain,
3652 both inside a single chip and between them.
3653 @xref{faqtaporder,,FAQ TAP Order}.
3654
3655 For example, the STMicroelectronics STR912 chip has
3656 three separate TAPs@footnote{See the ST
3657 document titled: @emph{STR91xFAxxx, Section 3.15 Jtag Interface, Page:
3658 28/102, Figure 3: JTAG chaining inside the STR91xFA}.
3659 @url{http://eu.st.com/stonline/products/literature/ds/13495.pdf}}.
3660 To configure those taps, @file{target/str912.cfg}
3661 includes commands something like this:
3662
3663 @example
3664 jtag newtap str912 flash ... params ...
3665 jtag newtap str912 cpu ... params ...
3666 jtag newtap str912 bs ... params ...
3667 @end example
3668
3669 Actual config files typically use a variable such as @code{$_CHIPNAME}
3670 instead of literals like @option{str912}, to support more than one chip
3671 of each type. @xref{Config File Guidelines}.
3672
3673 @deffn Command {jtag names}
3674 Returns the names of all current TAPs in the scan chain.
3675 Use @command{jtag cget} or @command{jtag tapisenabled}
3676 to examine attributes and state of each TAP.
3677 @example
3678 foreach t [jtag names] @{
3679 puts [format "TAP: %s\n" $t]
3680 @}
3681 @end example
3682 @end deffn
3683
3684 @deffn Command {scan_chain}
3685 Displays the TAPs in the scan chain configuration,
3686 and their status.
3687 The set of TAPs listed by this command is fixed by
3688 exiting the OpenOCD configuration stage,
3689 but systems with a JTAG router can
3690 enable or disable TAPs dynamically.
3691 @end deffn
3692
3693 @c FIXME! "jtag cget" should be able to return all TAP
3694 @c attributes, like "$target_name cget" does for targets.
3695
3696 @c Probably want "jtag eventlist", and a "tap-reset" event
3697 @c (on entry to RESET state).
3698
3699 @section TAP Names
3700 @cindex dotted name
3701
3702 When TAP objects are declared with @command{jtag newtap},
3703 a @dfn{dotted.name} is created for the TAP, combining the
3704 name of a module (usually a chip) and a label for the TAP.
3705 For example: @code{xilinx.tap}, @code{str912.flash},
3706 @code{omap3530.jrc}, @code{dm6446.dsp}, or @code{stm32.cpu}.
3707 Many other commands use that dotted.name to manipulate or
3708 refer to the TAP. For example, CPU configuration uses the
3709 name, as does declaration of NAND or NOR flash banks.
3710
3711 The components of a dotted name should follow ``C'' symbol
3712 name rules: start with an alphabetic character, then numbers
3713 and underscores are OK; while others (including dots!) are not.
3714
3715 @section TAP Declaration Commands
3716
3717 @c shouldn't this be(come) a {Config Command}?
3718 @deffn Command {jtag newtap} chipname tapname configparams...
3719 Declares a new TAP with the dotted name @var{chipname}.@var{tapname},
3720 and configured according to the various @var{configparams}.
3721
3722 The @var{chipname} is a symbolic name for the chip.
3723 Conventionally target config files use @code{$_CHIPNAME},
3724 defaulting to the model name given by the chip vendor but
3725 overridable.
3726
3727 @cindex TAP naming convention
3728 The @var{tapname} reflects the role of that TAP,
3729 and should follow this convention:
3730
3731 @itemize @bullet
3732 @item @code{bs} -- For boundary scan if this is a separate TAP;
3733 @item @code{cpu} -- The main CPU of the chip, alternatively
3734 @code{arm} and @code{dsp} on chips with both ARM and DSP CPUs,
3735 @code{arm1} and @code{arm2} on chips with two ARMs, and so forth;
3736 @item @code{etb} -- For an embedded trace buffer (example: an ARM ETB11);
3737 @item @code{flash} -- If the chip has a flash TAP, like the str912;
3738 @item @code{jrc} -- For JTAG route controller (example: the ICEPick modules
3739 on many Texas Instruments chips, like the OMAP3530 on Beagleboards);
3740 @item @code{tap} -- Should be used only for FPGA- or CPLD-like devices
3741 with a single TAP;
3742 @item @code{unknownN} -- If you have no idea what the TAP is for (N is a number);
3743 @item @emph{when in doubt} -- Use the chip maker's name in their data sheet.
3744 For example, the Freescale i.MX31 has a SDMA (Smart DMA) with
3745 a JTAG TAP; that TAP should be named @code{sdma}.
3746 @end itemize
3747
3748 Every TAP requires at least the following @var{configparams}:
3749
3750 @itemize @bullet
3751 @item @code{-irlen} @var{NUMBER}
3752 @*The length in bits of the
3753 instruction register, such as 4 or 5 bits.
3754 @end itemize
3755
3756 A TAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
3757
3758 @itemize @bullet
3759 @item @code{-disable} (or @code{-enable})
3760 @*Use the @code{-disable} parameter to flag a TAP which is not
3761 linked into the scan chain after a reset using either TRST
3762 or the JTAG state machine's @sc{reset} state.
3763 You may use @code{-enable} to highlight the default state
3764 (the TAP is linked in).
3765 @xref{enablinganddisablingtaps,,Enabling and Disabling TAPs}.
3766 @item @code{-expected-id} @var{NUMBER}
3767 @*A non-zero @var{number} represents a 32-bit IDCODE
3768 which you expect to find when the scan chain is examined.
3769 These codes are not required by all JTAG devices.
3770 @emph{Repeat the option} as many times as required if more than one
3771 ID code could appear (for example, multiple versions).
3772 Specify @var{number} as zero to suppress warnings about IDCODE
3773 values that were found but not included in the list.
3774
3775 Provide this value if at all possible, since it lets OpenOCD
3776 tell when the scan chain it sees isn't right. These values
3777 are provided in vendors' chip documentation, usually a technical
3778 reference manual. Sometimes you may need to probe the JTAG
3779 hardware to find these values.
3780 @xref{autoprobing,,Autoprobing}.
3781 @item @code{-ignore-version}
3782 @*Specify this to ignore the JTAG version field in the @code{-expected-id}
3783 option. When vendors put out multiple versions of a chip, or use the same
3784 JTAG-level ID for several largely-compatible chips, it may be more practical
3785 to ignore the version field than to update config files to handle all of
3786 the various chip IDs. The version field is defined as bit 28-31 of the IDCODE.
3787 @item @code{-ircapture} @var{NUMBER}
3788 @*The bit pattern loaded by the TAP into the JTAG shift register
3789 on entry to the @sc{ircapture} state, such as 0x01.
3790 JTAG requires the two LSBs of this value to be 01.
3791 By default, @code{-ircapture} and @code{-irmask} are set
3792 up to verify that two-bit value. You may provide
3793 additional bits if you know them, or indicate that
3794 a TAP doesn't conform to the JTAG specification.
3795 @item @code{-irmask} @var{NUMBER}
3796 @*A mask used with @code{-ircapture}
3797 to verify that instruction scans work correctly.
3798 Such scans are not used by OpenOCD except to verify that
3799 there seems to be no problems with JTAG scan chain operations.
3800 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
3801 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
3802 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
3803 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
3804 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
3805 @end itemize
3806 @end deffn
3807
3808 @section Other TAP commands
3809
3810 @deffn Command {jtag cget} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name
3811 @deffnx Command {jtag configure} dotted.name @option{-event} event_name handler
3812 At this writing this TAP attribute
3813 mechanism is used only for event handling.
3814 (It is not a direct analogue of the @code{cget}/@code{configure}
3815 mechanism for debugger targets.)
3816 See the next section for information about the available events.
3817
3818 The @code{configure} subcommand assigns an event handler,
3819 a TCL string which is evaluated when the event is triggered.
3820 The @code{cget} subcommand returns that handler.
3821 @end deffn
3822
3823 @section TAP Events
3824 @cindex events
3825 @cindex TAP events
3826
3827 OpenOCD includes two event mechanisms.
3828 The one presented here applies to all JTAG TAPs.
3829 The other applies to debugger targets,
3830 which are associated with certain TAPs.
3831
3832 The TAP events currently defined are:
3833
3834 @itemize @bullet
3835 @item @b{post-reset}
3836 @* The TAP has just completed a JTAG reset.
3837 The tap may still be in the JTAG @sc{reset} state.
3838 Handlers for these events might perform initialization sequences
3839 such as issuing TCK cycles, TMS sequences to ensure
3840 exit from the ARM SWD mode, and more.
3841
3842 Because the scan chain has not yet been verified, handlers for these events
3843 @emph{should not issue commands which scan the JTAG IR or DR registers}
3844 of any particular target.
3845 @b{NOTE:} As this is written (September 2009), nothing prevents such access.
3846 @item @b{setup}
3847 @* The scan chain has been reset and verified.
3848 This handler may enable TAPs as needed.
3849 @item @b{tap-disable}
3850 @* The TAP needs to be disabled. This handler should
3851 implement @command{jtag tapdisable}
3852 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3853 @item @b{tap-enable}
3854 @* The TAP needs to be enabled. This handler should
3855 implement @command{jtag tapenable}
3856 by issuing the relevant JTAG commands.
3857 @end itemize
3858
3859 If you need some action after each JTAG reset which isn't actually
3860 specific to any TAP (since you can't yet trust the scan chain's
3861 contents to be accurate), you might:
3862
3863 @example
3864 jtag configure CHIP.jrc -event post-reset @{
3865 echo "JTAG Reset done"
3866 ... non-scan jtag operations to be done after reset
3867 @}
3868 @end example
3869
3870
3871 @anchor{enablinganddisablingtaps}
3872 @section Enabling and Disabling TAPs
3873 @cindex JTAG Route Controller
3874 @cindex jrc
3875
3876 In some systems, a @dfn{JTAG Route Controller} (JRC)
3877 is used to enable and/or disable specific JTAG TAPs.
3878 Many ARM-based chips from Texas Instruments include
3879 an ``ICEPick'' module, which is a JRC.
3880 Such chips include DaVinci and OMAP3 processors.
3881
3882 A given TAP may not be visible until the JRC has been
3883 told to link it into the scan chain; and if the JRC
3884 has been told to unlink that TAP, it will no longer
3885 be visible.
3886 Such routers address problems that JTAG ``bypass mode''
3887 ignores, such as:
3888
3889 @itemize
3890 @item The scan chain can only go as fast as its slowest TAP.
3891 @item Having many TAPs slows instruction scans, since all
3892 TAPs receive new instructions.
3893 @item TAPs in the scan chain must be powered up, which wastes
3894 power and prevents debugging some power management mechanisms.
3895 @end itemize
3896
3897 The IEEE 1149.1 JTAG standard has no concept of a ``disabled'' tap,
3898 as implied by the existence of JTAG routers.
3899 However, the upcoming IEEE 1149.7 framework (layered on top of JTAG)
3900 does include a kind of JTAG router functionality.
3901
3902 @c (a) currently the event handlers don't seem to be able to
3903 @c fail in a way that could lead to no-change-of-state.
3904
3905 In OpenOCD, tap enabling/disabling is invoked by the Tcl commands
3906 shown below, and is implemented using TAP event handlers.
3907 So for example, when defining a TAP for a CPU connected to
3908 a JTAG router, your @file{target.cfg} file
3909 should define TAP event handlers using
3910 code that looks something like this:
3911
3912 @example
3913 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-enable @{
3914 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3915 @}
3916 jtag configure CHIP.cpu -event tap-disable @{
3917 ... jtag operations using CHIP.jrc
3918 @}
3919 @end example
3920
3921 Then you might want that CPU's TAP enabled almost all the time:
3922
3923 @example
3924 jtag configure $CHIP.jrc -event setup "jtag tapenable $CHIP.cpu"
3925 @end example
3926
3927 Note how that particular setup event handler declaration
3928 uses quotes to evaluate @code{$CHIP} when the event is configured.
3929 Using brackets @{ @} would cause it to be evaluated later,
3930 at runtime, when it might have a different value.
3931
3932 @deffn Command {jtag tapdisable} dotted.name
3933 If necessary, disables the tap
3934 by sending it a @option{tap-disable} event.
3935 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3936 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3937 and "0" if it is disabled.
3938 @end deffn
3939
3940 @deffn Command {jtag tapenable} dotted.name
3941 If necessary, enables the tap
3942 by sending it a @option{tap-enable} event.
3943 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3944 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3945 and "0" if it is disabled.
3946 @end deffn
3947
3948 @deffn Command {jtag tapisenabled} dotted.name
3949 Returns the string "1" if the tap
3950 specified by @var{dotted.name} is enabled,
3951 and "0" if it is disabled.
3952
3953 @quotation Note
3954 Humans will find the @command{scan_chain} command more helpful
3955 for querying the state of the JTAG taps.
3956 @end quotation
3957 @end deffn
3958
3959 @anchor{autoprobing}
3960 @section Autoprobing
3961 @cindex autoprobe
3962 @cindex JTAG autoprobe
3963
3964 TAP configuration is the first thing that needs to be done
3965 after interface and reset configuration. Sometimes it's
3966 hard finding out what TAPs exist, or how they are identified.
3967 Vendor documentation is not always easy to find and use.
3968
3969 To help you get past such problems, OpenOCD has a limited
3970 @emph{autoprobing} ability to look at the scan chain, doing
3971 a @dfn{blind interrogation} and then reporting the TAPs it finds.
3972 To use this mechanism, start the OpenOCD server with only data
3973 that configures your JTAG interface, and arranges to come up
3974 with a slow clock (many devices don't support fast JTAG clocks
3975 right when they come out of reset).
3976
3977 For example, your @file{openocd.cfg} file might have:
3978
3979 @example
3980 source [find interface/olimex-arm-usb-tiny-h.cfg]
3981 reset_config trst_and_srst
3982 jtag_rclk 8
3983 @end example
3984
3985 When you start the server without any TAPs configured, it will
3986 attempt to autoconfigure the TAPs. There are two parts to this:
3987
3988 @enumerate
3989 @item @emph{TAP discovery} ...
3990 After a JTAG reset (sometimes a system reset may be needed too),
3991 each TAP's data registers will hold the contents of either the
3992 IDCODE or BYPASS register.
3993 If JTAG communication is working, OpenOCD will see each TAP,
3994 and report what @option{-expected-id} to use with it.
3995 @item @emph{IR Length discovery} ...
3996 Unfortunately JTAG does not provide a reliable way to find out
3997 the value of the @option{-irlen} parameter to use with a TAP
3998 that is discovered.
3999 If OpenOCD can discover the length of a TAP's instruction
4000 register, it will report it.
4001 Otherwise you may need to consult vendor documentation, such
4002 as chip data sheets or BSDL files.
4003 @end enumerate
4004
4005 In many cases your board will have a simple scan chain with just
4006 a single device. Here's what OpenOCD reported with one board
4007 that's a bit more complex:
4008
4009 @example
4010 clock speed 8 kHz
4011 There are no enabled taps. AUTO PROBING MIGHT NOT WORK!!
4012 AUTO auto0.tap - use "jtag newtap auto0 tap -expected-id 0x2b900f0f ..."
4013 AUTO auto1.tap - use "jtag newtap auto1 tap -expected-id 0x07926001 ..."
4014 AUTO auto2.tap - use "jtag newtap auto2 tap -expected-id 0x0b73b02f ..."
4015 AUTO auto0.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4016 AUTO auto1.tap - use "... -irlen 4"
4017 AUTO auto2.tap - use "... -irlen 6"
4018 no gdb ports allocated as no target has been specified
4019 @end example
4020
4021 Given that information, you should be able to either find some existing
4022 config files to use, or create your own. If you create your own, you
4023 would configure from the bottom up: first a @file{target.cfg} file
4024 with these TAPs, any targets associated with them, and any on-chip
4025 resources; then a @file{board.cfg} with off-chip resources, clocking,
4026 and so forth.
4027
4028 @anchor{dapdeclaration}
4029 @section DAP declaration (ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets)
4030 @cindex DAP declaration
4031
4032 Since OpenOCD version 0.11.0, the Debug Access Port (DAP) is
4033 no longer implicitly created together with the target. It must be
4034 explicitly declared using the @command{dap create} command. For all
4035 ARMv7 and ARMv8 targets, the option "@option{-dap} @var{dap_name}" has to be used
4036 instead of "@option{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name}" when the target is created.
4037
4038 The @command{dap} command group supports the following sub-commands:
4039
4040 @deffn Command {dap create} dap_name @option{-chain-position} dotted.name configparams...
4041 Declare a DAP instance named @var{dap_name} linked to the JTAG tap
4042 @var{dotted.name}. This also creates a new command (@command{dap_name})
4043 which is used for various purposes including additional configuration.
4044 There can only be one DAP for each JTAG tap in the system.
4045
4046 A DAP may also provide optional @var{configparams}:
4047
4048 @itemize @bullet
4049 @item @code{-ignore-syspwrupack}
4050 @*Specify this to ignore the CSYSPWRUPACK bit in the ARM DAP DP CTRL/STAT
4051 register during initial examination and when checking the sticky error bit.
4052 This bit is normally checked after setting the CSYSPWRUPREQ bit, but some
4053 devices do not set the ack bit until sometime later.
4054 @end itemize
4055 @end deffn
4056
4057 @deffn Command {dap names}
4058 This command returns a list of all registered DAP objects. It it useful mainly
4059 for TCL scripting.
4060 @end deffn
4061
4062 @deffn Command {dap info} [num]
4063 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4064 defaulting to the currently selected AP of the currently selected target.
4065 @end deffn
4066
4067 @deffn Command {dap init}
4068 Initialize all registered DAPs. This command is used internally
4069 during initialization. It can be issued at any time after the
4070 initialization, too.
4071 @end deffn
4072
4073 The following commands exist as subcommands of DAP instances:
4074
4075 @deffn Command {$dap_name info} [num]
4076 Displays the ROM table for MEM-AP @var{num},
4077 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4078 @end deffn
4079
4080 @deffn Command {$dap_name apid} [num]
4081 Displays ID register from AP @var{num}, defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4082 @end deffn
4083
4084 @anchor{DAP subcommand apreg}
4085 @deffn Command {$dap_name apreg} ap_num reg [value]
4086 Displays content of a register @var{reg} from AP @var{ap_num}
4087 or set a new value @var{value}.
4088 @var{reg} is byte address of a word register, 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4089 @end deffn
4090
4091 @deffn Command {$dap_name apsel} [num]
4092 Select AP @var{num}, defaulting to 0.
4093 @end deffn
4094
4095 @deffn Command {$dap_name dpreg} reg [value]
4096 Displays the content of DP register at address @var{reg}, or set it to a new
4097 value @var{value}.
4098
4099 In case of SWD, @var{reg} is a value in packed format
4100 @math{dpbanksel << 4 | addr} and assumes values 0, 4, 8 ... 0xfc.
4101 In case of JTAG it only assumes values 0, 4, 8 and 0xc.
4102
4103 @emph{Note:} Consider using @command{poll off} to avoid any disturbing
4104 background activity by OpenOCD while you are operating at such low-level.
4105 @end deffn
4106
4107 @deffn Command {$dap_name baseaddr} [num]
4108 Displays debug base address from MEM-AP @var{num},
4109 defaulting to the currently selected AP.
4110 @end deffn
4111
4112 @deffn Command {$dap_name memaccess} [value]
4113 Displays the number of extra tck cycles in the JTAG idle to use for MEM-AP
4114 memory bus access [0-255], giving additional time to respond to reads.
4115 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
4116 @end deffn
4117
4118 @deffn Command {$dap_name apcsw} [value [mask]]
4119 Displays or changes CSW bit pattern for MEM-AP transfers.
4120
4121 At the begin of each memory access the CSW pattern is extended (bitwise or-ed)
4122 by @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} bit-fields according to transfer requirements
4123 and the result is written to the real CSW register. All bits except dynamically
4124 updated fields @dfn{Size} and @dfn{AddrInc} can be changed by changing
4125 the CSW pattern. Refer to ARM ADI v5 manual chapter 7.6.4 and appendix A
4126 for details.
4127
4128 Use @var{value} only syntax if you want to set the new CSW pattern as a whole.
4129 The example sets HPROT1 bit (required by Cortex-M) and clears the rest of
4130 the pattern:
4131 @example
4132 kx.dap apcsw 0x2000000
4133 @end example
4134
4135 If @var{mask} is also used, the CSW pattern is changed only on bit positions
4136 where the mask bit is 1. The following example sets HPROT3 (cacheable)
4137 and leaves the rest of the pattern intact. It configures memory access through
4138 DCache on Cortex-M7.
4139 @example
4140 set CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE [expr 1 << 27]
4141 samv.dap apcsw $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE $CSW_HPROT3_CACHEABLE
4142 @end example
4143
4144 Another example clears SPROT bit and leaves the rest of pattern intact:
4145 @example
4146 set CSW_SPROT [expr 1 << 30]
4147 samv.dap apcsw 0 $CSW_SPROT
4148 @end example
4149
4150 @emph{Note:} If you want to check the real value of CSW, not CSW pattern, use
4151 @code{xxx.dap apreg 0}. @xref{DAP subcommand apreg,,}.
4152
4153 @emph{Warning:} Some of the CSW bits are vital for working memory transfer.
4154 If you set a wrong CSW pattern and MEM-AP stopped working, use the following
4155 example with a proper dap name:
4156 @example
4157 xxx.dap apcsw default
4158 @end example
4159 @end deffn
4160
4161 @deffn Command {$dap_name ti_be_32_quirks} [@option{enable}]
4162 Set/get quirks mode for TI TMS450/TMS570 processors
4163 Disabled by default
4164 @end deffn
4165
4166
4167 @node CPU Configuration
4168 @chapter CPU Configuration
4169 @cindex GDB target
4170
4171 This chapter discusses how to set up GDB debug targets for CPUs.
4172 You can also access these targets without GDB
4173 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands},
4174 and @ref{targetstatehandling,,Target State handling}) and
4175 through various kinds of NAND and NOR flash commands.
4176 If you have multiple CPUs you can have multiple such targets.
4177
4178 We'll start by looking at how to examine the targets you have,
4179 then look at how to add one more target and how to configure it.
4180
4181 @section Target List
4182 @cindex target, current
4183 @cindex target, list
4184
4185 All targets that have been set up are part of a list,
4186 where each member has a name.
4187 That name should normally be the same as the TAP name.
4188 You can display the list with the @command{targets}
4189 (plural!) command.
4190 This display often has only one CPU; here's what it might
4191 look like with more than one:
4192 @verbatim
4193 TargetName Type Endian TapName State
4194 -- ------------------ ---------- ------ ------------------ ------------
4195 0* at91rm9200.cpu arm920t little at91rm9200.cpu running
4196 1 MyTarget cortex_m little mychip.foo tap-disabled
4197 @end verbatim
4198
4199 One member of that list is the @dfn{current target}, which
4200 is implicitly referenced by many commands.
4201 It's the one marked with a @code{*} near the target name.
4202 In particular, memory addresses often refer to the address
4203 space seen by that current target.
4204 Commands like @command{mdw} (memory display words)
4205 and @command{flash erase_address} (erase NOR flash blocks)
4206 are examples; and there are many more.
4207
4208 Several commands let you examine the list of targets:
4209
4210 @deffn Command {target current}
4211 Returns the name of the current target.
4212 @end deffn
4213
4214 @deffn Command {target names}
4215 Lists the names of all current targets in the list.
4216 @example
4217 foreach t [target names] @{
4218 puts [format "Target: %s\n" $t]
4219 @}
4220 @end example
4221 @end deffn
4222
4223 @c yep, "target list" would have been better.
4224 @c plus maybe "target setdefault".
4225
4226 @deffn Command targets [name]
4227 @emph{Note: the name of this command is plural. Other target
4228 command names are singular.}
4229
4230 With no parameter, this command displays a table of all known
4231 targets in a user friendly form.
4232
4233 With a parameter, this command sets the current target to
4234 the given target with the given @var{name}; this is
4235 only relevant on boards which have more than one target.
4236 @end deffn
4237
4238 @section Target CPU Types
4239 @cindex target type
4240 @cindex CPU type
4241
4242 Each target has a @dfn{CPU type}, as shown in the output of
4243 the @command{targets} command. You need to specify that type
4244 when calling @command{target create}.
4245 The CPU type indicates more than just the instruction set.
4246 It also indicates how that instruction set is implemented,
4247 what kind of debug support it integrates,
4248 whether it has an MMU (and if so, what kind),
4249 what core-specific commands may be available
4250 (@pxref{Architecture and Core Commands}),
4251 and more.
4252
4253 It's easy to see what target types are supported,
4254 since there's a command to list them.
4255
4256 @anchor{targettypes}
4257 @deffn Command {target types}
4258 Lists all supported target types.
4259 At this writing, the supported CPU types are:
4260
4261 @itemize @bullet
4262 @item @code{arm11} -- this is a generation of ARMv6 cores
4263 @item @code{arm720t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4264 @item @code{arm7tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4265 @item @code{arm920t} -- this is an ARMv4 core with an MMU
4266 @item @code{arm926ejs} -- this is an ARMv5 core with an MMU
4267 @item @code{arm966e} -- this is an ARMv5 core
4268 @item @code{arm9tdmi} -- this is an ARMv4 core
4269 @item @code{avr} -- implements Atmel's 8-bit AVR instruction set.
4270 (Support for this is preliminary and incomplete.)
4271 @item @code{cortex_a} -- this is an ARMv7 core with an MMU
4272 @item @code{cortex_m} -- this is an ARMv7 core, supporting only the
4273 compact Thumb2 instruction set.
4274 @item @code{aarch64} -- this is an ARMv8-A core with an MMU
4275 @item @code{dragonite} -- resembles arm966e
4276 @item @code{dsp563xx} -- implements Freescale's 24-bit DSP.
4277 (Support for this is still incomplete.)
4278 @item @code{esirisc} -- this is an EnSilica eSi-RISC core.
4279 The current implementation supports eSi-32xx cores.
4280 @item @code{fa526} -- resembles arm920 (w/o Thumb)
4281 @item @code{feroceon} -- resembles arm926
4282 @item @code{mips_m4k} -- a MIPS core
4283 @item @code{xscale} -- this is actually an architecture,
4284 not a CPU type. It is based on the ARMv5 architecture.
4285 @item @code{openrisc} -- this is an OpenRISC 1000 core.
4286 The current implementation supports three JTAG TAP cores:
4287 @item @code{ls1_sap} -- this is the SAP on NXP LS102x CPUs,
4288 allowing access to physical memory addresses independently of CPU cores.
4289 @itemize @minus
4290 @item @code{OpenCores TAP} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,jtag})
4291 @item @code{Altera Virtual JTAG TAP} (See: @url{http://www.altera.com/literature/ug/ug_virtualjtag.pdf})
4292 @item @code{Xilinx BSCAN_* virtual JTAG interface} (See: @url{http://www.xilinx.com/support/documentation/sw_manuals/xilinx14_2/spartan6_hdl.pdf})
4293 @end itemize
4294 And two debug interfaces cores:
4295 @itemize @minus
4296 @item @code{Advanced debug interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,adv_debug_sys})
4297 @item @code{SoC Debug Interface} (See: @url{http://opencores.org/project,dbg_interface})
4298 @end itemize
4299 @end itemize
4300 @end deffn
4301
4302 To avoid being confused by the variety of ARM based cores, remember
4303 this key point: @emph{ARM is a technology licencing company}.
4304 (See: @url{http://www.arm.com}.)
4305 The CPU name used by OpenOCD will reflect the CPU design that was
4306 licensed, not a vendor brand which incorporates that design.
4307 Name prefixes like arm7, arm9, arm11, and cortex
4308 reflect design generations;
4309 while names like ARMv4, ARMv5, ARMv6, ARMv7 and ARMv8
4310 reflect an architecture version implemented by a CPU design.
4311
4312 @anchor{targetconfiguration}
4313 @section Target Configuration
4314
4315 Before creating a ``target'', you must have added its TAP to the scan chain.
4316 When you've added that TAP, you will have a @code{dotted.name}
4317 which is used to set up the CPU support.
4318 The chip-specific configuration file will normally configure its CPU(s)
4319 right after it adds all of the chip's TAPs to the scan chain.
4320
4321 Although you can set up a target in one step, it's often clearer if you
4322 use shorter commands and do it in two steps: create it, then configure
4323 optional parts.
4324 All operations on the target after it's created will use a new
4325 command, created as part of target creation.
4326
4327 The two main things to configure after target creation are
4328 a work area, which usually has target-specific defaults even
4329 if the board setup code overrides them later;
4330 and event handlers (@pxref{targetevents,,Target Events}), which tend
4331 to be much more board-specific.
4332 The key steps you use might look something like this
4333
4334 @example
4335 dap create mychip.dap -chain-position mychip.cpu
4336 target create MyTarget cortex_m -dap mychip.dap
4337 MyTarget configure -work-area-phys 0x08000 -work-area-size 8096
4338 MyTarget configure -event reset-deassert-pre @{ jtag_rclk 5 @}
4339 MyTarget configure -event reset-init @{ myboard_reinit @}
4340 @end example
4341
4342 You should specify a working area if you can; typically it uses some
4343 on-chip SRAM.
4344 Such a working area can speed up many things, including bulk
4345 writes to target memory;
4346 flash operations like checking to see if memory needs to be erased;
4347 GDB memory checksumming;
4348 and more.
4349
4350 @quotation Warning
4351 On more complex chips, the work area can become
4352 inaccessible when application code
4353 (such as an operating system)
4354 enables or disables the MMU.
4355 For example, the particular MMU context used to access the virtual
4356 address will probably matter ... and that context might not have
4357 easy access to other addresses needed.
4358 At this writing, OpenOCD doesn't have much MMU intelligence.
4359 @end quotation
4360
4361 It's often very useful to define a @code{reset-init} event handler.
4362 For systems that are normally used with a boot loader,
4363 common tasks include updating clocks and initializing memory
4364 controllers.
4365 That may be needed to let you write the boot loader into flash,
4366 in order to ``de-brick'' your board; or to load programs into
4367 external DDR memory without having run the boot loader.
4368
4369 @deffn Command {target create} target_name type configparams...
4370 This command creates a GDB debug target that refers to a specific JTAG tap.
4371 It enters that target into a list, and creates a new
4372 command (@command{@var{target_name}}) which is used for various
4373 purposes including additional configuration.
4374
4375 @itemize @bullet
4376 @item @var{target_name} ... is the name of the debug target.
4377 By convention this should be the same as the @emph{dotted.name}
4378 of the TAP associated with this target, which must be specified here
4379 using the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} configparam.
4380
4381 This name is also used to create the target object command,
4382 referred to here as @command{$target_name},
4383 and in other places the target needs to be identified.
4384 @item @var{type} ... specifies the target type. @xref{targettypes,,target types}.
4385 @item @var{configparams} ... all parameters accepted by
4386 @command{$target_name configure} are permitted.
4387 If the target is big-endian, set it here with @code{-endian big}.
4388
4389 You @emph{must} set the @code{-chain-position @var{dotted.name}} or
4390 @code{-dap @var{dap_name}} here.
4391 @end itemize
4392 @end deffn
4393
4394 @deffn Command {$target_name configure} configparams...
4395 The options accepted by this command may also be
4396 specified as parameters to @command{target create}.
4397 Their values can later be queried one at a time by
4398 using the @command{$target_name cget} command.
4399
4400 @emph{Warning:} changing some of these after setup is dangerous.
4401 For example, moving a target from one TAP to another;
4402 and changing its endianness.
4403
4404 @itemize @bullet
4405
4406 @item @code{-chain-position} @var{dotted.name} -- names the TAP
4407 used to access this target.
4408
4409 @item @code{-dap} @var{dap_name} -- names the DAP used to access
4410 this target. @xref{dapdeclaration,,DAP declaration}, on how to
4411 create and manage DAP instances.
4412
4413 @item @code{-endian} (@option{big}|@option{little}) -- specifies
4414 whether the CPU uses big or little endian conventions
4415
4416 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} @var{event_body} --
4417 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4418 Note that this updates a list of named event handlers.
4419 Calling this twice with two different event names assigns
4420 two different handlers, but calling it twice with the
4421 same event name assigns only one handler.
4422
4423 Current target is temporarily overridden to the event issuing target
4424 before handler code starts and switched back after handler is done.
4425
4426 @item @code{-work-area-backup} (@option{0}|@option{1}) -- says
4427 whether the work area gets backed up; by default,
4428 @emph{it is not backed up.}
4429 When possible, use a working_area that doesn't need to be backed up,
4430 since performing a backup slows down operations.
4431 For example, the beginning of an SRAM block is likely to
4432 be used by most build systems, but the end is often unused.
4433
4434 @item @code{-work-area-size} @var{size} -- specify work are size,
4435 in bytes. The same size applies regardless of whether its physical
4436 or virtual address is being used.
4437
4438 @item @code{-work-area-phys} @var{address} -- set the work area
4439 base @var{address} to be used when no MMU is active.
4440
4441 @item @code{-work-area-virt} @var{address} -- set the work area
4442 base @var{address} to be used when an MMU is active.
4443 @emph{Do not specify a value for this except on targets with an MMU.}
4444 The value should normally correspond to a static mapping for the
4445 @code{-work-area-phys} address, set up by the current operating system.
4446
4447 @anchor{rtostype}
4448 @item @code{-rtos} @var{rtos_type} -- enable rtos support for target,
4449 @var{rtos_type} can be one of @option{auto}, @option{eCos},
4450 @option{ThreadX}, @option{FreeRTOS}, @option{linux}, @option{ChibiOS},
4451 @option{embKernel}, @option{mqx}, @option{uCOS-III}, @option{nuttx}
4452 @xref{gdbrtossupport,,RTOS Support}.
4453
4454 @item @code{-defer-examine} -- skip target examination at initial JTAG chain
4455 scan and after a reset. A manual call to arp_examine is required to
4456 access the target for debugging.
4457
4458 @item @code{-ap-num} @var{ap_number} -- set DAP access port for target,
4459 @var{ap_number} is the numeric index of the DAP AP the target is connected to.
4460 Use this option with systems where multiple, independent cores are connected
4461 to separate access ports of the same DAP.
4462
4463 @item @code{-cti} @var{cti_name} -- set Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) connected
4464 to the target. Currently, only the @code{aarch64} target makes use of this option,
4465 where it is a mandatory configuration for the target run control.
4466 @xref{armcrosstrigger,,ARM Cross-Trigger Interface},
4467 for instruction on how to declare and control a CTI instance.
4468
4469 @anchor{gdbportoverride}
4470 @item @code{-gdb-port} @var{number} -- see command @command{gdb_port} for the
4471 possible values of the parameter @var{number}, which are not only numeric values.
4472 Use this option to override, for this target only, the global parameter set with
4473 command @command{gdb_port}.
4474 @xref{gdb_port,,command gdb_port}.
4475 @end itemize
4476 @end deffn
4477
4478 @section Other $target_name Commands
4479 @cindex object command
4480
4481 The Tcl/Tk language has the concept of object commands,
4482 and OpenOCD adopts that same model for targets.
4483
4484 A good Tk example is a on screen button.
4485 Once a button is created a button
4486 has a name (a path in Tk terms) and that name is useable as a first
4487 class command. For example in Tk, one can create a button and later
4488 configure it like this:
4489
4490 @example
4491 # Create
4492 button .foobar -background red -command @{ foo @}
4493 # Modify
4494 .foobar configure -foreground blue
4495 # Query
4496 set x [.foobar cget -background]
4497 # Report
4498 puts [format "The button is %s" $x]
4499 @end example
4500
4501 In OpenOCD's terms, the ``target'' is an object just like a Tcl/Tk
4502 button, and its object commands are invoked the same way.
4503
4504 @example
4505 str912.cpu mww 0x1234 0x42
4506 omap3530.cpu mww 0x5555 123
4507 @end example
4508
4509 The commands supported by OpenOCD target objects are:
4510
4511 @deffn Command {$target_name arp_examine} @option{allow-defer}
4512 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_halt}
4513 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_poll}
4514 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_reset}
4515 @deffnx Command {$target_name arp_waitstate}
4516 Internal OpenOCD scripts (most notably @file{startup.tcl})
4517 use these to deal with specific reset cases.
4518 They are not otherwise documented here.
4519 @end deffn
4520
4521 @deffn Command {$target_name array2mem} arrayname width address count
4522 @deffnx Command {$target_name mem2array} arrayname width address count
4523 These provide an efficient script-oriented interface to memory.
4524 The @code{array2mem} primitive writes bytes, halfwords, or words;
4525 while @code{mem2array} reads them.
4526 In both cases, the TCL side uses an array, and
4527 the target side uses raw memory.
4528
4529 The efficiency comes from enabling the use of
4530 bulk JTAG data transfer operations.
4531 The script orientation comes from working with data
4532 values that are packaged for use by TCL scripts;
4533 @command{mdw} type primitives only print data they retrieve,
4534 and neither store nor return those values.
4535
4536 @itemize
4537 @item @var{arrayname} ... is the name of an array variable
4538 @item @var{width} ... is 8/16/32 - indicating the memory access size
4539 @item @var{address} ... is the target memory address
4540 @item @var{count} ... is the number of elements to process
4541 @end itemize
4542 @end deffn
4543
4544 @deffn Command {$target_name cget} queryparm
4545 Each configuration parameter accepted by
4546 @command{$target_name configure}
4547 can be individually queried, to return its current value.
4548 The @var{queryparm} is a parameter name
4549 accepted by that command, such as @code{-work-area-phys}.
4550 There are a few special cases:
4551
4552 @itemize @bullet
4553 @item @code{-event} @var{event_name} -- returns the handler for the
4554 event named @var{event_name}.
4555 This is a special case because setting a handler requires
4556 two parameters.
4557 @item @code{-type} -- returns the target type.
4558 This is a special case because this is set using
4559 @command{target create} and can't be changed
4560 using @command{$target_name configure}.
4561 @end itemize
4562
4563 For example, if you wanted to summarize information about
4564 all the targets you might use something like this:
4565
4566 @example
4567 foreach name [target names] @{
4568 set y [$name cget -endian]
4569 set z [$name cget -type]
4570 puts [format "Chip %d is %s, Endian: %s, type: %s" \
4571 $x $name $y $z]
4572 @}
4573 @end example
4574 @end deffn
4575
4576 @anchor{targetcurstate}
4577 @deffn Command {$target_name curstate}
4578 Displays the current target state:
4579 @code{debug-running},
4580 @code{halted},
4581 @code{reset},
4582 @code{running}, or @code{unknown}.
4583 (Also, @pxref{eventpolling,,Event Polling}.)
4584 @end deffn
4585
4586 @deffn Command {$target_name eventlist}
4587 Displays a table listing all event handlers
4588 currently associated with this target.
4589 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
4590 @end deffn
4591
4592 @deffn Command {$target_name invoke-event} event_name
4593 Invokes the handler for the event named @var{event_name}.
4594 (This is primarily intended for use by OpenOCD framework
4595 code, for example by the reset code in @file{startup.tcl}.)
4596 @end deffn
4597
4598 @deffn Command {$target_name mdw} addr [count]
4599 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdh} addr [count]
4600 @deffnx Command {$target_name mdb} addr [count]
4601 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
4602 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
4603 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
4604 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
4605 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
4606 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
4607 @end deffn
4608
4609 @deffn Command {$target_name mww} addr word
4610 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwh} addr halfword
4611 @deffnx Command {$target_name mwb} addr byte
4612 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4613 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4614 at the specified address @var{addr}.
4615 @end deffn
4616
4617 @anchor{targetevents}
4618 @section Target Events
4619 @cindex target events
4620 @cindex events
4621 At various times, certain things can happen, or you want them to happen.
4622 For example:
4623 @itemize @bullet
4624 @item What should happen when GDB connects? Should your target reset?
4625 @item When GDB tries to flash the target, do you need to enable the flash via a special command?
4626 @item Is using SRST appropriate (and possible) on your system?
4627 Or instead of that, do you need to issue JTAG commands to trigger reset?
4628 SRST usually resets everything on the scan chain, which can be inappropriate.
4629 @item During reset, do you need to write to certain memory locations
4630 to set up system clocks or
4631 to reconfigure the SDRAM?
4632 How about configuring the watchdog timer, or other peripherals,
4633 to stop running while you hold the core stopped for debugging?
4634 @end itemize
4635
4636 All of the above items can be addressed by target event handlers.
4637 These are set up by @command{$target_name configure -event} or
4638 @command{target create ... -event}.
4639
4640 The programmer's model matches the @code{-command} option used in Tcl/Tk
4641 buttons and events. The two examples below act the same, but one creates
4642 and invokes a small procedure while the other inlines it.
4643
4644 @example
4645 proc my_init_proc @{ @} @{
4646 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4647 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4648 @}
4649 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init my_init_proc
4650 mychip.cpu configure -event reset-init @{
4651 echo "Disabling watchdog..."
4652 mww 0xfffffd44 0x00008000
4653 @}
4654 @end example
4655
4656 The following target events are defined:
4657
4658 @itemize @bullet
4659 @item @b{debug-halted}
4660 @* The target has halted for debug reasons (i.e.: breakpoint)
4661 @item @b{debug-resumed}
4662 @* The target has resumed (i.e.: GDB said run)
4663 @item @b{early-halted}
4664 @* Occurs early in the halt process
4665 @item @b{examine-start}
4666 @* Before target examine is called.
4667 @item @b{examine-end}
4668 @* After target examine is called with no errors.
4669 @item @b{gdb-attach}
4670 @* When GDB connects. Issued before any GDB communication with the target
4671 starts. GDB expects the target is halted during attachment.
4672 @xref{gdbmeminspect,,GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector}, how to
4673 connect GDB to running target.
4674 The event can be also used to set up the target so it is possible to probe flash.
4675 Probing flash is necessary during GDB connect if you want to use
4676 @pxref{programmingusinggdb,,programming using GDB}.
4677 Another use of the flash memory map is for GDB to automatically choose
4678 hardware or software breakpoints depending on whether the breakpoint
4679 is in RAM or read only memory.
4680 Default is @code{halt}
4681 @item @b{gdb-detach}
4682 @* When GDB disconnects
4683 @item @b{gdb-end}
4684 @* When the target has halted and GDB is not doing anything (see early halt)
4685 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-start}
4686 @* Before the GDB flash process tries to erase the flash (default is
4687 @code{reset init})
4688 @item @b{gdb-flash-erase-end}
4689 @* After the GDB flash process has finished erasing the flash
4690 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-start}
4691 @* Before GDB writes to the flash
4692 @item @b{gdb-flash-write-end}
4693 @* After GDB writes to the flash (default is @code{reset halt})
4694 @item @b{gdb-start}
4695 @* Before the target steps, GDB is trying to start/resume the target
4696 @item @b{halted}
4697 @* The target has halted
4698 @item @b{reset-assert-pre}
4699 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4700 after @command{reset-start} was triggered
4701 but before either SRST alone is asserted on the scan chain,
4702 or @code{reset-assert} is triggered.
4703 @item @b{reset-assert}
4704 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4705 after @command{reset-assert-pre} was triggered.
4706 When such a handler is present, cores which support this event will use
4707 it instead of asserting SRST.
4708 This support is essential for debugging with JTAG interfaces which
4709 don't include an SRST line (JTAG doesn't require SRST), and for
4710 selective reset on scan chains that have multiple targets.
4711 @item @b{reset-assert-post}
4712 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4713 after @code{reset-assert} has been triggered.
4714 or the target asserted SRST on the entire scan chain.
4715 @item @b{reset-deassert-pre}
4716 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4717 after @code{reset-assert-post} has been triggered.
4718 @item @b{reset-deassert-post}
4719 @* Issued as part of @command{reset} processing
4720 after @code{reset-deassert-pre} has been triggered
4721 and (if the target is using it) after SRST has been
4722 released on the scan chain.
4723 @item @b{reset-end}
4724 @* Issued as the final step in @command{reset} processing.
4725 @item @b{reset-init}
4726 @* Used by @b{reset init} command for board-specific initialization.
4727 This event fires after @emph{reset-deassert-post}.
4728
4729 This is where you would configure PLLs and clocking, set up DRAM so
4730 you can download programs that don't fit in on-chip SRAM, set up pin
4731 multiplexing, and so on.
4732 (You may be able to switch to a fast JTAG clock rate here, after
4733 the target clocks are fully set up.)
4734 @item @b{reset-start}
4735 @* Issued as the first step in @command{reset} processing
4736 before @command{reset-assert-pre} is called.
4737
4738 This is the most robust place to use @command{jtag_rclk}
4739 or @command{adapter_khz} to switch to a low JTAG clock rate,
4740 when reset disables PLLs needed to use a fast clock.
4741 @item @b{resume-start}
4742 @* Before any target is resumed
4743 @item @b{resume-end}
4744 @* After all targets have resumed
4745 @item @b{resumed}
4746 @* Target has resumed
4747 @item @b{trace-config}
4748 @* After target hardware trace configuration was changed
4749 @end itemize
4750
4751 @node Flash Commands
4752 @chapter Flash Commands
4753
4754 OpenOCD has different commands for NOR and NAND flash;
4755 the ``flash'' command works with NOR flash, while
4756 the ``nand'' command works with NAND flash.
4757 This partially reflects different hardware technologies:
4758 NOR flash usually supports direct CPU instruction and data bus access,
4759 while data from a NAND flash must be copied to memory before it can be
4760 used. (SPI flash must also be copied to memory before use.)
4761 However, the documentation also uses ``flash'' as a generic term;
4762 for example, ``Put flash configuration in board-specific files''.
4763
4764 Flash Steps:
4765 @enumerate
4766 @item Configure via the command @command{flash bank}
4767 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
4768 passing parameters as needed by the driver.
4769 @item Operate on the flash via @command{flash subcommand}
4770 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
4771 via a script in some automated way. Common tasks include writing a
4772 boot loader, operating system, or other data.
4773 @item GDB Flashing
4774 @* Flashing via GDB requires the flash be configured via ``flash
4775 bank'', and the GDB flash features be enabled.
4776 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
4777 @end enumerate
4778
4779 Many CPUs have the ability to ``boot'' from the first flash bank.
4780 This means that misprogramming that bank can ``brick'' a system,
4781 so that it can't boot.
4782 JTAG tools, like OpenOCD, are often then used to ``de-brick'' the
4783 board by (re)installing working boot firmware.
4784
4785 @anchor{norconfiguration}
4786 @section Flash Configuration Commands
4787 @cindex flash configuration
4788
4789 @deffn {Config Command} {flash bank} name driver base size chip_width bus_width target [driver_options]
4790 Configures a flash bank which provides persistent storage
4791 for addresses from @math{base} to @math{base + size - 1}.
4792 These banks will often be visible to GDB through the target's memory map.
4793 In some cases, configuring a flash bank will activate extra commands;
4794 see the driver-specific documentation.
4795
4796 @itemize @bullet
4797 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the flash bank
4798 in other flash commands. A number is also available.
4799 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the controller driver
4800 associated with the flash bank being declared.
4801 This is usually @code{cfi} for external flash, or else
4802 the name of a microcontroller with embedded flash memory.
4803 @xref{flashdriverlist,,Flash Driver List}.
4804 @item @var{base} ... Base address of the flash chip.
4805 @item @var{size} ... Size of the chip, in bytes.
4806 For some drivers, this value is detected from the hardware.
4807 @item @var{chip_width} ... Width of the flash chip, in bytes;
4808 ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4809 @item @var{bus_width} ... Width of the data bus used to access the
4810 chip, in bytes; ignored for most microcontroller drivers.
4811 @item @var{target} ... Names the target used to issue
4812 commands to the flash controller.
4813 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
4814 @item @var{driver_options} ... drivers may support, or require,
4815 additional parameters. See the driver-specific documentation
4816 for more information.
4817 @end itemize
4818 @quotation Note
4819 This command is not available after OpenOCD initialization has completed.
4820 Use it in board specific configuration files, not interactively.
4821 @end quotation
4822 @end deffn
4823
4824 @comment the REAL name for this command is "ocd_flash_banks"
4825 @comment less confusing would be: "flash list" (like "nand list")
4826 @deffn Command {flash banks}
4827 Prints a one-line summary of each device that was
4828 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4829 Note that this is the @emph{plural} form;
4830 the @emph{singular} form is a very different command.
4831 @end deffn
4832
4833 @deffn Command {flash list}
4834 Retrieves a list of associative arrays for each device that was
4835 declared using @command{flash bank}, numbered from zero.
4836 This returned list can be manipulated easily from within scripts.
4837 @end deffn
4838
4839 @deffn Command {flash probe} num
4840 Identify the flash, or validate the parameters of the configured flash. Operation
4841 depends on the flash type.
4842 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4843 Most flash commands will implicitly @emph{autoprobe} the bank;
4844 flash drivers can distinguish between probing and autoprobing,
4845 but most don't bother.
4846 @end deffn
4847
4848 @section Erasing, Reading, Writing to Flash
4849 @cindex flash erasing
4850 @cindex flash reading
4851 @cindex flash writing
4852 @cindex flash programming
4853 @anchor{flashprogrammingcommands}
4854
4855 One feature distinguishing NOR flash from NAND or serial flash technologies
4856 is that for read access, it acts exactly like any other addressable memory.
4857 This means you can use normal memory read commands like @command{mdw} or
4858 @command{dump_image} with it, with no special @command{flash} subcommands.
4859 @xref{memoryaccess,,Memory access}, and @ref{imageaccess,,Image access}.
4860
4861 Write access works differently. Flash memory normally needs to be erased
4862 before it's written. Erasing a sector turns all of its bits to ones, and
4863 writing can turn ones into zeroes. This is why there are special commands
4864 for interactive erasing and writing, and why GDB needs to know which parts
4865 of the address space hold NOR flash memory.
4866
4867 @quotation Note
4868 Most of these erase and write commands leverage the fact that NOR flash
4869 chips consume target address space. They implicitly refer to the current
4870 JTAG target, and map from an address in that target's address space
4871 back to a flash bank.
4872 @comment In May 2009, those mappings may fail if any bank associated
4873 @comment with that target doesn't successfully autoprobe ... bug worth fixing?
4874 A few commands use abstract addressing based on bank and sector numbers,
4875 and don't depend on searching the current target and its address space.
4876 Avoid confusing the two command models.
4877 @end quotation
4878
4879 Some flash chips implement software protection against accidental writes,
4880 since such buggy writes could in some cases ``brick'' a system.
4881 For such systems, erasing and writing may require sector protection to be
4882 disabled first.
4883 Examples include CFI flash such as ``Intel Advanced Bootblock flash'',
4884 and AT91SAM7 on-chip flash.
4885 @xref{flashprotect,,flash protect}.
4886
4887 @deffn Command {flash erase_sector} num first last
4888 Erase sectors in bank @var{num}, starting at sector @var{first}
4889 up to and including @var{last}.
4890 Sector numbering starts at 0.
4891 Providing a @var{last} sector of @option{last}
4892 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
4893 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4894 @end deffn
4895
4896 @deffn Command {flash erase_address} [@option{pad}] [@option{unlock}] address length
4897 Erase sectors starting at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
4898 Unless @option{pad} is specified, @math{address} must begin a
4899 flash sector, and @math{address + length - 1} must end a sector.
4900 Specifying @option{pad} erases extra data at the beginning and/or
4901 end of the specified region, as needed to erase only full sectors.
4902 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address}, and
4903 the specified length must stay within that bank.
4904 As a special case, when @var{length} is zero and @var{address} is
4905 the start of the bank, the whole flash is erased.
4906 If @option{unlock} is specified, then the flash is unprotected
4907 before erase starts.
4908 @end deffn
4909
4910 @deffn Command {flash fillw} address word length
4911 @deffnx Command {flash fillh} address halfword length
4912 @deffnx Command {flash fillb} address byte length
4913 Fills flash memory with the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
4914 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) pattern,
4915 starting at @var{address} and continuing
4916 for @var{length} units (word/halfword/byte).
4917 No erasure is done before writing; when needed, that must be done
4918 before issuing this command.
4919 Writes are done in blocks of up to 1024 bytes, and each write is
4920 verified by reading back the data and comparing it to what was written.
4921 The flash bank to use is inferred from the @var{address} of
4922 each block, and the specified length must stay within that bank.
4923 @end deffn
4924 @comment no current checks for errors if fill blocks touch multiple banks!
4925
4926 @deffn Command {flash write_bank} num filename [offset]
4927 Write the binary @file{filename} to flash bank @var{num},
4928 starting at @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank. If @var{offset}
4929 is omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank.
4930 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4931 @end deffn
4932
4933 @deffn Command {flash read_bank} num filename [offset [length]]
4934 Read @var{length} bytes from the flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}
4935 and write the contents to the binary @file{filename}. If @var{offset} is
4936 omitted, start at the beginning of the flash bank. If @var{length} is omitted,
4937 read the remaining bytes from the flash bank.
4938 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4939 @end deffn
4940
4941 @deffn Command {flash verify_bank} num filename [offset]
4942 Compare the contents of the binary file @var{filename} with the contents of the
4943 flash bank @var{num} starting at @var{offset}. If @var{offset} is omitted,
4944 start at the beginning of the flash bank. Fail if the contents do not match.
4945 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4946 @end deffn
4947
4948 @deffn Command {flash write_image} [erase] [unlock] filename [offset] [type]
4949 Write the image @file{filename} to the current target's flash bank(s).
4950 Only loadable sections from the image are written.
4951 A relocation @var{offset} may be specified, in which case it is added
4952 to the base address for each section in the image.
4953 The file [@var{type}] can be specified
4954 explicitly as @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
4955 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19).
4956 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
4957 The relevant flash sectors will be erased prior to programming
4958 if the @option{erase} parameter is given. If @option{unlock} is
4959 provided, then the flash banks are unlocked before erase and
4960 program. The flash bank to use is inferred from the address of
4961 each image section.
4962
4963 @quotation Warning
4964 Be careful using the @option{erase} flag when the flash is holding
4965 data you want to preserve.
4966 Portions of the flash outside those described in the image's
4967 sections might be erased with no notice.
4968 @itemize
4969 @item
4970 When a section of the image being written does not fill out all the
4971 sectors it uses, the unwritten parts of those sectors are necessarily
4972 also erased, because sectors can't be partially erased.
4973 @item
4974 Data stored in sector "holes" between image sections are also affected.
4975 For example, "@command{flash write_image erase ...}" of an image with
4976 one byte at the beginning of a flash bank and one byte at the end
4977 erases the entire bank -- not just the two sectors being written.
4978 @end itemize
4979 Also, when flash protection is important, you must re-apply it after
4980 it has been removed by the @option{unlock} flag.
4981 @end quotation
4982
4983 @end deffn
4984
4985 @section Other Flash commands
4986 @cindex flash protection
4987
4988 @deffn Command {flash erase_check} num
4989 Check erase state of sectors in flash bank @var{num},
4990 and display that status.
4991 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4992 @end deffn
4993
4994 @deffn Command {flash info} num [sectors]
4995 Print info about flash bank @var{num}, a list of protection blocks
4996 and their status. Use @option{sectors} to show a list of sectors instead.
4997
4998 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
4999 This command will first query the hardware, it does not print cached
5000 and possibly stale information.
5001 @end deffn
5002
5003 @anchor{flashprotect}
5004 @deffn Command {flash protect} num first last (@option{on}|@option{off})
5005 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) protection of flash blocks
5006 in flash bank @var{num}, starting at protection block @var{first}
5007 and continuing up to and including @var{last}.
5008 Providing a @var{last} block of @option{last}
5009 specifies "to the end of the flash bank".
5010 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5011 The protection block is usually identical to a flash sector.
5012 Some devices may utilize a protection block distinct from flash sector.
5013 See @command{flash info} for a list of protection blocks.
5014 @end deffn
5015
5016 @deffn Command {flash padded_value} num value
5017 Sets the default value used for padding any image sections, This should
5018 normally match the flash bank erased value. If not specified by this
5019 command or the flash driver then it defaults to 0xff.
5020 @end deffn
5021
5022 @anchor{program}
5023 @deffn Command {program} filename [verify] [reset] [exit] [offset]
5024 This is a helper script that simplifies using OpenOCD as a standalone
5025 programmer. The only required parameter is @option{filename}, the others are optional.
5026 @xref{Flash Programming}.
5027 @end deffn
5028
5029 @anchor{flashdriverlist}
5030 @section Flash Driver List
5031 As noted above, the @command{flash bank} command requires a driver name,
5032 and allows driver-specific options and behaviors.
5033 Some drivers also activate driver-specific commands.
5034
5035 @deffn {Flash Driver} virtual
5036 This is a special driver that maps a previously defined bank to another
5037 address. All bank settings will be copied from the master physical bank.
5038
5039 The @var{virtual} driver defines one mandatory parameters,
5040
5041 @itemize
5042 @item @var{master_bank} The bank that this virtual address refers to.
5043 @end itemize
5044
5045 So in the following example addresses 0xbfc00000 and 0x9fc00000 refer to
5046 the flash bank defined at address 0x1fc00000. Any command executed on
5047 the virtual banks is actually performed on the physical banks.
5048 @example
5049 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pic32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5050 flash bank vbank0 virtual 0xbfc00000 0 0 0 \
5051 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5052 flash bank vbank1 virtual 0x9fc00000 0 0 0 \
5053 $_TARGETNAME $_FLASHNAME
5054 @end example
5055 @end deffn
5056
5057 @subsection External Flash
5058
5059 @deffn {Flash Driver} cfi
5060 @cindex Common Flash Interface
5061 @cindex CFI
5062 The ``Common Flash Interface'' (CFI) is the main standard for
5063 external NOR flash chips, each of which connects to a
5064 specific external chip select on the CPU.
5065 Frequently the first such chip is used to boot the system.
5066 Your board's @code{reset-init} handler might need to
5067 configure additional chip selects using other commands (like: @command{mww} to
5068 configure a bus and its timings), or
5069 perhaps configure a GPIO pin that controls the ``write protect'' pin
5070 on the flash chip.
5071 The CFI driver can use a target-specific working area to significantly
5072 speed up operation.
5073
5074 The CFI driver can accept the following optional parameters, in any order:
5075
5076 @itemize
5077 @item @var{jedec_probe} ... is used to detect certain non-CFI flash ROMs,
5078 like AM29LV010 and similar types.
5079 @item @var{x16_as_x8} ... when a 16-bit flash is hooked up to an 8-bit bus.
5080 @item @var{bus_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be swapped.
5081 @item @var{data_swap} ... when data bytes in a 16-bit flash needs to be
5082 swapped when writing data values (i.e. not CFI commands).
5083 @end itemize
5084
5085 To configure two adjacent banks of 16 MBytes each, both sixteen bits (two bytes)
5086 wide on a sixteen bit bus:
5087
5088 @example
5089 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5090 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x01000000 0x01000000 2 2 $_TARGETNAME
5091 @end example
5092
5093 To configure one bank of 32 MBytes
5094 built from two sixteen bit (two byte) wide parts wired in parallel
5095 to create a thirty-two bit (four byte) bus with doubled throughput:
5096
5097 @example
5098 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cfi 0x00000000 0x02000000 2 4 $_TARGETNAME
5099 @end example
5100
5101 @c "cfi part_id" disabled
5102 @end deffn
5103
5104 @deffn {Flash Driver} jtagspi
5105 @cindex Generic JTAG2SPI driver
5106 @cindex SPI
5107 @cindex jtagspi
5108 @cindex bscan_spi
5109 Several FPGAs and CPLDs can retrieve their configuration (bitstream) from a
5110 SPI flash connected to them. To access this flash from the host, the device
5111 is first programmed with a special proxy bitstream that
5112 exposes the SPI flash on the device's JTAG interface. The flash can then be
5113 accessed through JTAG.
5114
5115 Since signaling between JTAG and SPI is compatible, all that is required for
5116 a proxy bitstream is to connect TDI-MOSI, TDO-MISO, TCK-CLK and activate
5117 the flash chip select when the JTAG state machine is in SHIFT-DR. Such
5118 a bitstream for several Xilinx FPGAs can be found in
5119 @file{contrib/loaders/flash/fpga/xilinx_bscan_spi.py}. It requires
5120 @uref{https://github.com/m-labs/migen, migen} and a Xilinx toolchain to build.
5121
5122 This flash bank driver requires a target on a JTAG tap and will access that
5123 tap directly. Since no support from the target is needed, the target can be a
5124 "testee" dummy. Since the target does not expose the flash memory
5125 mapping, target commands that would otherwise be expected to access the flash
5126 will not work. These include all @command{*_image} and
5127 @command{$target_name m*} commands as well as @command{program}. Equivalent
5128 functionality is available through the @command{flash write_bank},
5129 @command{flash read_bank}, and @command{flash verify_bank} commands.
5130
5131 @itemize
5132 @item @var{ir} ... is loaded into the JTAG IR to map the flash as the JTAG DR.
5133 For the bitstreams generated from @file{xilinx_bscan_spi.py} this is the
5134 @var{USER1} instruction.
5135 @end itemize
5136
5137 @example
5138 target create $_TARGETNAME testee -chain-position $_CHIPNAME.fpga
5139 set _XILINX_USER1 0x02
5140 flash bank $_FLASHNAME spi 0x0 0 0 0 \
5141 $_TARGETNAME $_XILINX_USER1
5142 @end example
5143 @end deffn
5144
5145 @deffn {Flash Driver} xcf
5146 @cindex Xilinx Platform flash driver
5147 @cindex xcf
5148 Xilinx FPGAs can be configured from specialized flash ICs named Platform Flash.
5149 It is (almost) regular NOR flash with erase sectors, program pages, etc. The
5150 only difference is special registers controlling its FPGA specific behavior.
5151 They must be properly configured for successful FPGA loading using
5152 additional @var{xcf} driver command:
5153
5154 @deffn Command {xcf ccb} <bank_id>
5155 command accepts additional parameters:
5156 @itemize
5157 @item @var{external|internal} ... selects clock source.
5158 @item @var{serial|parallel} ... selects serial or parallel data bus mode.
5159 @item @var{slave|master} ... selects slave of master mode for flash device.
5160 @item @var{40|20} ... selects clock frequency in MHz for internal clock
5161 in master mode.
5162 @end itemize
5163 @example
5164 xcf ccb 0 external parallel slave 40
5165 @end example
5166 All of them must be specified even if clock frequency is pointless
5167 in slave mode. If only bank id specified than command prints current
5168 CCB register value. Note: there is no need to write this register
5169 every time you erase/program data sectors because it stores in
5170 dedicated sector.
5171 @end deffn
5172
5173 @deffn Command {xcf configure} <bank_id>
5174 Initiates FPGA loading procedure. Useful if your board has no "configure"
5175 button.
5176 @example
5177 xcf configure 0
5178 @end example
5179 @end deffn
5180
5181 Additional driver notes:
5182 @itemize
5183 @item Only single revision supported.
5184 @item Driver automatically detects need of bit reverse, but
5185 only "bin" (raw binary, do not confuse it with "bit") and "mcs"
5186 (Intel hex) file types supported.
5187 @item For additional info check xapp972.pdf and ug380.pdf.
5188 @end itemize
5189 @end deffn
5190
5191 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpcspifi
5192 @cindex NXP SPI Flash Interface
5193 @cindex SPIFI
5194 @cindex lpcspifi
5195 NXP's LPC43xx and LPC18xx families include a proprietary SPI
5196 Flash Interface (SPIFI) peripheral that can drive and provide
5197 memory mapped access to external SPI flash devices.
5198
5199 The lpcspifi driver initializes this interface and provides
5200 program and erase functionality for these serial flash devices.
5201 Use of this driver @b{requires} a working area of at least 1kB
5202 to be configured on the target device; more than this will
5203 significantly reduce flash programming times.
5204
5205 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter. All
5206 other parameters are ignored, and the flash size and layout
5207 are configured by the driver.
5208
5209 @example
5210 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpcspifi 0x14000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5211 @end example
5212
5213 @end deffn
5214
5215 @deffn {Flash Driver} stmsmi
5216 @cindex STMicroelectronics Serial Memory Interface
5217 @cindex SMI
5218 @cindex stmsmi
5219 Some devices from STMicroelectronics (e.g. STR75x MCU family,
5220 SPEAr MPU family) include a proprietary
5221 ``Serial Memory Interface'' (SMI) controller able to drive external
5222 SPI flash devices.
5223 Depending on specific device and board configuration, up to 4 external
5224 flash devices can be connected.
5225
5226 SMI makes the flash content directly accessible in the CPU address
5227 space; each external device is mapped in a memory bank.
5228 CPU can directly read data, execute code and boot from SMI banks.
5229 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5230 the flash content.
5231
5232 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5233 to identify the memory bank.
5234 All other parameters are ignored. Additional information, like
5235 flash size, are detected automatically.
5236
5237 @example
5238 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stmsmi 0xf8000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5239 @end example
5240
5241 @end deffn
5242
5243 @deffn {Flash Driver} mrvlqspi
5244 This driver supports QSPI flash controller of Marvell's Wireless
5245 Microcontroller platform.
5246
5247 The flash size is autodetected based on the table of known JEDEC IDs
5248 hardcoded in the OpenOCD sources.
5249
5250 @example
5251 flash bank $_FLASHNAME mrvlqspi 0x0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0x46010000
5252 @end example
5253
5254 @end deffn
5255
5256 @deffn {Flash Driver} ath79
5257 @cindex Atheros ath79 SPI driver
5258 @cindex ath79
5259 Members of ATH79 SoC family from Atheros include a SPI interface with 3
5260 chip selects.
5261 On reset a SPI flash connected to the first chip select (CS0) is made
5262 directly read-accessible in the CPU address space (up to 16MBytes)
5263 and is usually used to store the bootloader and operating system.
5264 Normal OpenOCD commands like @command{mdw} can be used to display
5265 the flash content while it is in memory-mapped mode (only the first
5266 4MBytes are accessible without additional configuration on reset).
5267
5268 The setup command only requires the @var{base} parameter in order
5269 to identify the memory bank. The actual value for the base address
5270 is not otherwise used by the driver. However the mapping is passed
5271 to gdb. Thus for the memory mapped flash (chipselect CS0) the base
5272 address should be the actual memory mapped base address. For unmapped
5273 chipselects (CS1 and CS2) care should be taken to use a base address
5274 that does not overlap with real memory regions.
5275 Additional information, like flash size, are detected automatically.
5276 An optional additional parameter sets the chipselect for the bank,
5277 with the default CS0.
5278 CS1 and CS2 require additional GPIO setup before they can be used
5279 since the alternate function must be enabled on the GPIO pin
5280 CS1/CS2 is routed to on the given SoC.
5281
5282 @example
5283 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ath79 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5284
5285 # When using multiple chipselects the base should be different for each,
5286 # otherwise the write_image command is not able to distinguish the
5287 # banks.
5288 flash bank flash0 ath79 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs0
5289 flash bank flash1 ath79 0x10000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs1
5290 flash bank flash2 ath79 0x20000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cs2
5291 @end example
5292
5293 @end deffn
5294
5295 @subsection Internal Flash (Microcontrollers)
5296
5297 @deffn {Flash Driver} aduc702x
5298 The ADUC702x analog microcontrollers from Analog Devices
5299 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
5300 The aduc702x flash driver works with models ADUC7019 through ADUC7028.
5301 The setup command only requires the @var{target} argument
5302 since all devices in this family have the same memory layout.
5303
5304 @example
5305 flash bank $_FLASHNAME aduc702x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5306 @end example
5307 @end deffn
5308
5309 @deffn {Flash Driver} ambiqmicro
5310 @cindex ambiqmicro
5311 @cindex apollo
5312 All members of the Apollo microcontroller family from
5313 Ambiq Micro include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5314 The host connects over USB to an FTDI interface that communicates
5315 with the target using SWD.
5316
5317 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver reads the Chip Information Register detect
5318 the device class of the MCU.
5319 The Flash and SRAM sizes directly follow device class, and are used
5320 to set up the flash banks.
5321 If this fails, the driver will use default values set to the minimum
5322 sizes of an Apollo chip.
5323
5324 All Apollo chips have two flash banks of the same size.
5325 In all cases the first flash bank starts at location 0,
5326 and the second bank starts after the first.
5327
5328 @example
5329 # Flash bank 0
5330 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5331 # Flash bank 1 - same size as bank0, starts after bank 0.
5332 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ambiqmicro 0x00040000 0x00040000 0 0 \
5333 $_TARGETNAME
5334 @end example
5335
5336 Flash is programmed using custom entry points into the bootloader.
5337 This is the only way to program the flash as no flash control registers
5338 are available to the user.
5339
5340 The @var{ambiqmicro} driver adds some additional commands:
5341
5342 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro mass_erase} <bank>
5343 Erase entire bank.
5344 @end deffn
5345 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro page_erase} <bank> <first> <last>
5346 Erase device pages.
5347 @end deffn
5348 @deffn Command {ambiqmicro program_otp} <bank> <offset> <count>
5349 Program OTP is a one time operation to create write protected flash.
5350 The user writes sectors to SRAM starting at 0x10000010.
5351 Program OTP will write these sectors from SRAM to flash, and write protect
5352 the flash.
5353 @end deffn
5354 @end deffn
5355
5356 @anchor{at91samd}
5357 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91samd
5358 @cindex at91samd
5359 All members of the ATSAMD, ATSAMR, ATSAML and ATSAMC microcontroller
5360 families from Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M0+ core.
5361 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5362
5363 @deffn Command {at91samd chip-erase}
5364 Issues a complete Flash erase via the Device Service Unit (DSU). This can be
5365 used to erase a chip back to its factory state and does not require the
5366 processor to be halted.
5367 @end deffn
5368
5369 @deffn Command {at91samd set-security}
5370 Secures the Flash via the Set Security Bit (SSB) command. This prevents access
5371 to the Flash and can only be undone by using the chip-erase command which
5372 erases the Flash contents and turns off the security bit. Warning: at this
5373 time, openocd will not be able to communicate with a secured chip and it is
5374 therefore not possible to chip-erase it without using another tool.
5375
5376 @example
5377 at91samd set-security enable
5378 @end example
5379 @end deffn
5380
5381 @deffn Command {at91samd eeprom}
5382 Shows or sets the EEPROM emulation size configuration, stored in the User Row
5383 of the Flash. When setting, the EEPROM size must be specified in bytes and it
5384 must be one of the permitted sizes according to the datasheet. Settings are
5385 written immediately but only take effect on MCU reset. EEPROM emulation
5386 requires additional firmware support and the minimum EEPROM size may not be
5387 the same as the minimum that the hardware supports. Set the EEPROM size to 0
5388 in order to disable this feature.
5389
5390 @example
5391 at91samd eeprom
5392 at91samd eeprom 1024
5393 @end example
5394 @end deffn
5395
5396 @deffn Command {at91samd bootloader}
5397 Shows or sets the bootloader size configuration, stored in the User Row of the
5398 Flash. This is called the BOOTPROT region. When setting, the bootloader size
5399 must be specified in bytes and it must be one of the permitted sizes according
5400 to the datasheet. Settings are written immediately but only take effect on
5401 MCU reset. Setting the bootloader size to 0 disables bootloader protection.
5402
5403 @example
5404 at91samd bootloader
5405 at91samd bootloader 16384
5406 @end example
5407 @end deffn
5408
5409 @deffn Command {at91samd dsu_reset_deassert}
5410 This command releases internal reset held by DSU
5411 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5412 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5413 @end deffn
5414
5415 @deffn Command {at91samd nvmuserrow}
5416 Writes or reads the entire 64 bit wide NVM user row register which is located at
5417 0x804000. This register includes various fuses lock-bits and factory calibration
5418 data. Reading the register is done by invoking this command without any
5419 arguments. Writing is possible by giving 1 or 2 hex values. The first argument
5420 is the register value to be written and the second one is an optional changemask.
5421 Every bit which value in changemask is 0 will stay unchanged. The lock- and
5422 reserved-bits are masked out and cannot be changed.
5423
5424 @example
5425 # Read user row
5426 >at91samd nvmuserrow
5427 NVMUSERROW: 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5428 # Write 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788 to user row
5429 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0xFFFFFC5DD8E0C788
5430 # Write 0x12300 to user row but leave other bits and low byte unchanged
5431 >at91samd nvmuserrow 0x12345 0xFFF00
5432 @end example
5433 @end deffn
5434
5435 @end deffn
5436
5437 @anchor{at91sam3}
5438 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam3
5439 @cindex at91sam3
5440 All members of the AT91SAM3 microcontroller family from
5441 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M3 core. The driver
5442 currently (6/22/09) recognizes the AT91SAM3U[1/2/4][C/E] chips. Note
5443 that the driver was orginaly developed and tested using the
5444 AT91SAM3U4E, using a SAM3U-EK eval board. Support for other chips in
5445 the family was cribbed from the data sheet. @emph{Note to future
5446 readers/updaters: Please remove this worrisome comment after other
5447 chips are confirmed.}
5448
5449 The AT91SAM3U4[E/C] (256K) chips have two flash banks; most other chips
5450 have one flash bank. In all cases the flash banks are at
5451 the following fixed locations:
5452
5453 @example
5454 # Flash bank 0 - all chips
5455 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00080000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5456 # Flash bank 1 - only 256K chips
5457 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam3 0x00100000 0 1 1 $_TARGETNAME
5458 @end example
5459
5460 Internally, the AT91SAM3 flash memory is organized as follows.
5461 Unlike the AT91SAM7 chips, these are not used as parameters
5462 to the @command{flash bank} command:
5463
5464 @itemize
5465 @item @emph{N-Banks:} 256K chips have 2 banks, others have 1 bank.
5466 @item @emph{Bank Size:} 128K/64K Per flash bank
5467 @item @emph{Sectors:} 16 or 8 per bank
5468 @item @emph{SectorSize:} 8K Per Sector
5469 @item @emph{PageSize:} 256 bytes per page. Note that OpenOCD operates on 'sector' sizes, not page sizes.
5470 @end itemize
5471
5472 The AT91SAM3 driver adds some additional commands:
5473
5474 @deffn Command {at91sam3 gpnvm}
5475 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm clear} number
5476 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm set} number
5477 @deffnx Command {at91sam3 gpnvm show} [@option{all}|number]
5478 With no parameters, @command{show} or @command{show all},
5479 shows the status of all GPNVM bits.
5480 With @command{show} @var{number}, displays that bit.
5481
5482 With @command{set} @var{number} or @command{clear} @var{number},
5483 modifies that GPNVM bit.
5484 @end deffn
5485
5486 @deffn Command {at91sam3 info}
5487 This command attempts to display information about the AT91SAM3
5488 chip. @emph{First} it read the @code{CHIPID_CIDR} [address 0x400e0740, see
5489 Section 28.2.1, page 505 of the AT91SAM3U 29/may/2009 datasheet,
5490 document id: doc6430A] and decodes the values. @emph{Second} it reads the
5491 various clock configuration registers and attempts to display how it
5492 believes the chip is configured. By default, the SLOWCLK is assumed to
5493 be 32768 Hz, see the command @command{at91sam3 slowclk}.
5494 @end deffn
5495
5496 @deffn Command {at91sam3 slowclk} [value]
5497 This command shows/sets the slow clock frequency used in the
5498 @command{at91sam3 info} command calculations above.
5499 @end deffn
5500 @end deffn
5501
5502 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4
5503 @cindex at91sam4
5504 All members of the AT91SAM4 microcontroller family from
5505 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5506 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5507 @end deffn
5508
5509 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam4l
5510 @cindex at91sam4l
5511 All members of the AT91SAM4L microcontroller family from
5512 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M4 core.
5513 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5514
5515 The AT91SAM4L driver adds some additional commands:
5516 @deffn Command {at91sam4l smap_reset_deassert}
5517 This command releases internal reset held by SMAP
5518 and prepares reset vector catch in case of reset halt.
5519 Command is used internally in event event reset-deassert-post.
5520 @end deffn
5521 @end deffn
5522
5523 @deffn {Flash Driver} atsamv
5524 @cindex atsamv
5525 All members of the ATSAMV, ATSAMS, and ATSAME families from
5526 Atmel include internal flash and use ARM's Cortex-M7 core.
5527 This driver uses the same command names/syntax as @xref{at91sam3}.
5528 @end deffn
5529
5530 @deffn {Flash Driver} at91sam7
5531 All members of the AT91SAM7 microcontroller family from Atmel include
5532 internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores. The driver automatically
5533 recognizes a number of these chips using the chip identification
5534 register, and autoconfigures itself.
5535
5536 @example
5537 flash bank $_FLASHNAME at91sam7 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5538 @end example
5539
5540 For chips which are not recognized by the controller driver, you must
5541 provide additional parameters in the following order:
5542
5543 @itemize
5544 @item @var{chip_model} ... label used with @command{flash info}
5545 @item @var{banks}
5546 @item @var{sectors_per_bank}
5547 @item @var{pages_per_sector}
5548 @item @var{pages_size}
5549 @item @var{num_nvm_bits}
5550 @item @var{freq_khz} ... required if an external clock is provided,
5551 optional (but recommended) when the oscillator frequency is known
5552 @end itemize
5553
5554 It is recommended that you provide zeroes for all of those values
5555 except the clock frequency, so that everything except that frequency
5556 will be autoconfigured.
5557 Knowing the frequency helps ensure correct timings for flash access.
5558
5559 The flash controller handles erases automatically on a page (128/256 byte)
5560 basis, so explicit erase commands are not necessary for flash programming.
5561 However, there is an ``EraseAll`` command that can erase an entire flash
5562 plane (of up to 256KB), and it will be used automatically when you issue
5563 @command{flash erase_sector} or @command{flash erase_address} commands.
5564
5565 @deffn Command {at91sam7 gpnvm} bitnum (@option{set}|@option{clear})
5566 Set or clear a ``General Purpose Non-Volatile Memory'' (GPNVM)
5567 bit for the processor. Each processor has a number of such bits,
5568 used for controlling features such as brownout detection (so they
5569 are not truly general purpose).
5570 @quotation Note
5571 This assumes that the first flash bank (number 0) is associated with
5572 the appropriate at91sam7 target.
5573 @end quotation
5574 @end deffn
5575 @end deffn
5576
5577 @deffn {Flash Driver} avr
5578 The AVR 8-bit microcontrollers from Atmel integrate flash memory.
5579 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete.}
5580 @comment - defines mass_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
5581 @end deffn
5582
5583 @deffn {Flash Driver} bluenrg-x
5584 STMicroelectronics BlueNRG-1 and BlueNRG-2 Bluetooth low energy wireless system-on-chip. They include ARM Cortex-M0 core and internal flash memory.
5585 The driver automatically recognizes these chips using
5586 the chip identification registers, and autoconfigures itself.
5587
5588 @example
5589 flash bank $_FLASHNAME bluenrg-x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5590 @end example
5591
5592 Note that when users ask to erase all the sectors of the flash, a mass erase command is used which is faster than erasing
5593 each single sector one by one.
5594
5595 @example
5596 flash erase_sector 0 0 79 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-1
5597 @end example
5598
5599 @example
5600 flash erase_sector 0 0 127 # It will perform a mass erase on BlueNRG-2
5601 @end example
5602
5603 Triggering a mass erase is also useful when users want to disable readout protection.
5604 @end deffn
5605
5606 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc26xx
5607 All versions of the SimpleLink CC13xx and CC26xx microcontrollers from Texas
5608 Instruments include internal flash. The cc26xx flash driver supports both the
5609 CC13xx and CC26xx family of devices. The driver automatically recognizes the
5610 specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself. Flash bank 0
5611 starts at address 0.
5612
5613 @example
5614 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc26xx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5615 @end example
5616 @end deffn
5617
5618 @deffn {Flash Driver} cc3220sf
5619 The CC3220SF version of the SimpleLink CC32xx microcontrollers from Texas
5620 Instruments includes 1MB of internal flash. The cc3220sf flash driver only
5621 supports the internal flash. The serial flash on SimpleLink boards is
5622 programmed via the bootloader over a UART connection. Security features of
5623 the CC3220SF may erase the internal flash during power on reset. Refer to
5624 documentation at @url{www.ti.com/cc3220sf} for details on security features
5625 and programming the serial flash.
5626
5627 @example
5628 flash bank $_FLASHNAME cc3220sf 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5629 @end example
5630 @end deffn
5631
5632 @deffn {Flash Driver} efm32
5633 All members of the EFM32 microcontroller family from Energy Micro include
5634 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. The driver automatically recognizes
5635 a number of these chips using the chip identification register, and
5636 autoconfigures itself.
5637 @example
5638 flash bank $_FLASHNAME efm32 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5639 @end example
5640 A special feature of efm32 controllers is that it is possible to completely disable the
5641 debug interface by writing the correct values to the 'Debug Lock Word'. OpenOCD supports
5642 this via the following command:
5643 @example
5644 efm32 debuglock num
5645 @end example
5646 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
5647 Note that in order for this command to take effect, the target needs to be reset.
5648 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Unprotecting flash pages is not
5649 supported.}
5650 @end deffn
5651
5652 @deffn {Flash Driver} esirisc
5653 Members of the eSi-RISC family may optionally include internal flash programmed
5654 via the eSi-TSMC Flash interface. Additional parameters are required to
5655 configure the driver: @option{cfg_address} is the base address of the
5656 configuration register interface, @option{clock_hz} is the expected clock
5657 frequency, and @option{wait_states} is the number of configured read wait states.
5658
5659 @example
5660 flash bank $_FLASHNAME esirisc base_address size_bytes 0 0 $_TARGETNAME cfg_address clock_hz wait_states
5661 @end example
5662
5663 @deffn Command {esirisc_flash mass_erase} (bank_id)
5664 Erases all pages in data memory for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}.
5665 @end deffn
5666
5667 @deffn Command {esirisc_flash ref_erase} (bank_id)
5668 Erases the reference cell for the bank identified by @option{bank_id}. This is
5669 an uncommon operation.
5670 @end deffn
5671 @end deffn
5672
5673 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm3
5674 All members of the FM3 microcontroller family from Fujitsu
5675 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
5676 The @var{fm3} driver uses the @var{target} parameter to select the
5677 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5678 @code{mb9bfxx1.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx2.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx3.cpu},
5679 @code{mb9bfxx4.cpu}, @code{mb9bfxx5.cpu} or @code{mb9bfxx6.cpu}.
5680
5681 @example
5682 flash bank $_FLASHNAME fm3 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5683 @end example
5684 @end deffn
5685
5686 @deffn {Flash Driver} fm4
5687 All members of the FM4 microcontroller family from Spansion (formerly Fujitsu)
5688 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
5689 The @var{fm4} driver uses a @var{family} parameter to select the
5690 correct bank config, it can currently be one of the following:
5691 @code{MB9BFx64}, @code{MB9BFx65}, @code{MB9BFx66}, @code{MB9BFx67}, @code{MB9BFx68},
5692 @code{S6E2Cx8}, @code{S6E2Cx9}, @code{S6E2CxA} or @code{S6E2Dx},
5693 with @code{x} treated as wildcard and otherwise case (and any trailing
5694 characters) ignored.
5695
5696 @example
5697 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}0 fm4 0x00000000 0 0 0 \
5698 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5699 flash bank $@{_FLASHNAME@}1 fm4 0x00100000 0 0 0 \
5700 $_TARGETNAME S6E2CCAJ0A
5701 @end example
5702 @emph{The current implementation is incomplete. Protection is not supported,
5703 nor is Chip Erase (only Sector Erase is implemented).}
5704 @end deffn
5705
5706 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis
5707 @cindex kinetis
5708 Kx, KLx, KVx and KE1x members of the Kinetis microcontroller family
5709 from NXP (former Freescale) include
5710 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+ or M4 cores. The driver automatically
5711 recognizes flash size and a number of flash banks (1-4) using the chip
5712 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
5713 Use kinetis_ke driver for KE0x and KEAx devices.
5714
5715 The @var{kinetis} driver defines option:
5716 @itemize
5717 @item -sim-base @var{addr} ... base of System Integration Module where chip identification resides. Driver tries two known locations if option is omitted.
5718 @end itemize
5719
5720 @example
5721 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5722 @end example
5723
5724 @deffn Command {kinetis create_banks}
5725 Configuration command enables automatic creation of additional flash banks
5726 based on real flash layout of device. Banks are created during device probe.
5727 Use 'flash probe 0' to force probe.
5728 @end deffn
5729
5730 @deffn Command {kinetis fcf_source} [protection|write]
5731 Select what source is used when writing to a Flash Configuration Field.
5732 @option{protection} mode builds FCF content from protection bits previously
5733 set by 'flash protect' command.
5734 This mode is default. MCU is protected from unwanted locking by immediate
5735 writing FCF after erase of relevant sector.
5736 @option{write} mode enables direct write to FCF.
5737 Protection cannot be set by 'flash protect' command. FCF is written along
5738 with the rest of a flash image.
5739 @emph{BEWARE: Incorrect flash configuration may permanently lock the device!}
5740 @end deffn
5741
5742 @deffn Command {kinetis fopt} [num]
5743 Set value to write to FOPT byte of Flash Configuration Field.
5744 Used in kinetis 'fcf_source protection' mode only.
5745 @end deffn
5746
5747 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm check_security}
5748 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5749 @end deffn
5750
5751 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm halt}
5752 Issues a halt via the MDM-AP. This command can be used to break a watchdog reset
5753 loop when connecting to an unsecured target.
5754 @end deffn
5755
5756 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm mass_erase}
5757 Issues a complete flash erase via the MDM-AP. This can be used to erase a chip
5758 back to its factory state, removing security. It does not require the processor
5759 to be halted, however the target will remain in a halted state after this
5760 command completes.
5761 @end deffn
5762
5763 @deffn Command {kinetis nvm_partition}
5764 For FlexNVM devices only (KxxDX and KxxFX).
5765 Command shows or sets data flash or EEPROM backup size in kilobytes,
5766 sets two EEPROM blocks sizes in bytes and enables/disables loading
5767 of EEPROM contents to FlexRAM during reset.
5768
5769 For details see device reference manual, Flash Memory Module,
5770 Program Partition command.
5771
5772 Setting is possible only once after mass_erase.
5773 Reset the device after partition setting.
5774
5775 Show partition size:
5776 @example
5777 kinetis nvm_partition info
5778 @end example
5779
5780 Set 32 KB data flash, rest of FlexNVM is EEPROM backup. EEPROM has two blocks
5781 of 512 and 1536 bytes and its contents is loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5782 @example
5783 kinetis nvm_partition dataflash 32 512 1536 on
5784 @end example
5785
5786 Set 16 KB EEPROM backup, rest of FlexNVM is a data flash. EEPROM has two blocks
5787 of 1024 bytes and its contents is not loaded to FlexRAM during reset:
5788 @example
5789 kinetis nvm_partition eebkp 16 1024 1024 off
5790 @end example
5791 @end deffn
5792
5793 @deffn Command {kinetis mdm reset}
5794 Issues a reset via the MDM-AP. This causes the MCU to output a low pulse on the
5795 RESET pin, which can be used to reset other hardware on board.
5796 @end deffn
5797
5798 @deffn Command {kinetis disable_wdog}
5799 For Kx devices only (KLx has different COP watchdog, it is not supported).
5800 Command disables watchdog timer.
5801 @end deffn
5802 @end deffn
5803
5804 @deffn {Flash Driver} kinetis_ke
5805 @cindex kinetis_ke
5806 KE0x and KEAx members of the Kinetis microcontroller family from NXP include
5807 internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0+. The driver automatically recognizes
5808 the KE0x sub-family using the chip identification register, and
5809 autoconfigures itself.
5810 Use kinetis (not kinetis_ke) driver for KE1x devices.
5811
5812 @example
5813 flash bank $_FLASHNAME kinetis_ke 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
5814 @end example
5815
5816 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm check_security}
5817 Checks status of device security lock. Used internally in examine-end event.
5818 @end deffn
5819
5820 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke mdm mass_erase}
5821 Issues a complete Flash erase via the MDM-AP.
5822 This can be used to erase a chip back to its factory state.
5823 Command removes security lock from a device (use of SRST highly recommended).
5824 It does not require the processor to be halted.
5825 @end deffn
5826
5827 @deffn Command {kinetis_ke disable_wdog}
5828 Command disables watchdog timer.
5829 @end deffn
5830 @end deffn
5831
5832 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2000
5833 This is the driver to support internal flash of all members of the
5834 LPC11(x)00 and LPC1300 microcontroller families and most members of
5835 the LPC800, LPC1500, LPC1700, LPC1800, LPC2000, LPC4000 and LPC54100
5836 microcontroller families from NXP.
5837
5838 @quotation Note
5839 There are LPC2000 devices which are not supported by the @var{lpc2000}
5840 driver:
5841 The LPC2888 is supported by the @var{lpc288x} driver.
5842 The LPC29xx family is supported by the @var{lpc2900} driver.
5843 @end quotation
5844
5845 The @var{lpc2000} driver defines two mandatory and one optional parameters,
5846 which must appear in the following order:
5847
5848 @itemize
5849 @item @var{variant} ... required, may be
5850 @option{lpc2000_v1} (older LPC21xx and LPC22xx)
5851 @option{lpc2000_v2} (LPC213x, LPC214x, LPC210[123], LPC23xx and LPC24xx)
5852 @option{lpc1700} (LPC175x and LPC176x and LPC177x/8x)
5853 @option{lpc4300} - available also as @option{lpc1800} alias (LPC18x[2357] and
5854 LPC43x[2357])
5855 @option{lpc800} (LPC8xx)
5856 @option{lpc1100} (LPC11(x)xx and LPC13xx)
5857 @option{lpc1500} (LPC15xx)
5858 @option{lpc54100} (LPC541xx)
5859 @option{lpc4000} (LPC40xx)
5860 or @option{auto} - automatically detects flash variant and size for LPC11(x)00,
5861 LPC8xx, LPC13xx, LPC17xx and LPC40xx
5862 @item @var{clock_kHz} ... the frequency, in kiloHertz,
5863 at which the core is running
5864 @item @option{calc_checksum} ... optional (but you probably want to provide this!),
5865 telling the driver to calculate a valid checksum for the exception vector table.
5866 @quotation Note
5867 If you don't provide @option{calc_checksum} when you're writing the vector
5868 table, the boot ROM will almost certainly ignore your flash image.
5869 However, if you do provide it,
5870 with most tool chains @command{verify_image} will fail.
5871 @end quotation
5872 @end itemize
5873
5874 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5875
5876 @example
5877 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000 0x0 0x7d000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME \
5878 lpc2000_v2 14765 calc_checksum
5879 @end example
5880
5881 @deffn {Command} {lpc2000 part_id} bank
5882 Displays the four byte part identifier associated with
5883 the specified flash @var{bank}.
5884 @end deffn
5885 @end deffn
5886
5887 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc288x
5888 The LPC2888 microcontroller from NXP needs slightly different flash
5889 support from its lpc2000 siblings.
5890 The @var{lpc288x} driver defines one mandatory parameter,
5891 the programming clock rate in Hz.
5892 LPC flashes don't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
5893
5894 @example
5895 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc288x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 12000000
5896 @end example
5897 @end deffn
5898
5899 @deffn {Flash Driver} lpc2900
5900 This driver supports the LPC29xx ARM968E based microcontroller family
5901 from NXP.
5902
5903 The predefined parameters @var{base}, @var{size}, @var{chip_width} and
5904 @var{bus_width} of the @code{flash bank} command are ignored. Flash size and
5905 sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
5906 The driver has one additional mandatory parameter: The CPU clock rate
5907 (in kHz) at the time the flash operations will take place. Most of the time this
5908 will not be the crystal frequency, but a higher PLL frequency. The
5909 @code{reset-init} event handler in the board script is usually the place where
5910 you start the PLL.
5911
5912 The driver rejects flashless devices (currently the LPC2930).
5913
5914 The EEPROM in LPC2900 devices is not mapped directly into the address space.
5915 It must be handled much more like NAND flash memory, and will therefore be
5916 handled by a separate @code{lpc2900_eeprom} driver (not yet available).
5917
5918 Sector protection in terms of the LPC2900 is handled transparently. Every time a
5919 sector needs to be erased or programmed, it is automatically unprotected.
5920 What is shown as protection status in the @code{flash info} command, is
5921 actually the LPC2900 @emph{sector security}. This is a mechanism to prevent a
5922 sector from ever being erased or programmed again. As this is an irreversible
5923 mechanism, it is handled by a special command (@code{lpc2900 secure_sector}),
5924 and not by the standard @code{flash protect} command.
5925
5926 Example for a 125 MHz clock frequency:
5927 @example
5928 flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2900 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 125000
5929 @end example
5930
5931 Some @code{lpc2900}-specific commands are defined. In the following command list,
5932 the @var{bank} parameter is the bank number as obtained by the
5933 @code{flash banks} command.
5934
5935 @deffn Command {lpc2900 signature} bank
5936 Calculates a 128-bit hash value, the @emph{signature}, from the whole flash
5937 content. This is a hardware feature of the flash block, hence the calculation is
5938 very fast. You may use this to verify the content of a programmed device against
5939 a known signature.
5940 Example:
5941 @example
5942 lpc2900 signature 0
5943 signature: 0x5f40cdc8:0xc64e592e:0x10490f89:0x32a0f317
5944 @end example
5945 @end deffn
5946
5947 @deffn Command {lpc2900 read_custom} bank filename
5948 Reads the 912 bytes of customer information from the flash index sector, and
5949 saves it to a file in binary format.
5950 Example:
5951 @example
5952 lpc2900 read_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin
5953 @end example
5954 @end deffn
5955
5956 The index sector of the flash is a @emph{write-only} sector. It cannot be
5957 erased! In order to guard against unintentional write access, all following
5958 commands need to be preceded by a successful call to the @code{password}
5959 command:
5960
5961 @deffn Command {lpc2900 password} bank password
5962 You need to use this command right before each of the following commands:
5963 @code{lpc2900 write_custom}, @code{lpc2900 secure_sector},
5964 @code{lpc2900 secure_jtag}.
5965
5966 The password string is fixed to "I_know_what_I_am_doing".
5967 Example:
5968 @example
5969 lpc2900 password 0 I_know_what_I_am_doing
5970 Potentially dangerous operation allowed in next command!
5971 @end example
5972 @end deffn
5973
5974 @deffn Command {lpc2900 write_custom} bank filename type
5975 Writes the content of the file into the customer info space of the flash index
5976 sector. The filetype can be specified with the @var{type} field. Possible values
5977 for @var{type} are: @var{bin} (binary), @var{ihex} (Intel hex format),
5978 @var{elf} (ELF binary) or @var{s19} (Motorola S-records). The file must
5979 contain a single section, and the contained data length must be exactly
5980 912 bytes.
5981 @quotation Attention
5982 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5983 @end quotation
5984 Example:
5985 @example
5986 lpc2900 write_custom 0 /path_to/customer_info.bin bin
5987 @end example
5988 @end deffn
5989
5990 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_sector} bank first last
5991 Secures the sector range from @var{first} to @var{last} (including) against
5992 further program and erase operations. The sector security will be effective
5993 after the next power cycle.
5994 @quotation Attention
5995 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
5996 @end quotation
5997 Secured sectors appear as @emph{protected} in the @code{flash info} command.
5998 Example:
5999 @example
6000 lpc2900 secure_sector 0 1 1
6001 flash info 0
6002 #0 : lpc2900 at 0x20000000, size 0x000c0000, (...)
6003 # 0: 0x00000000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6004 # 1: 0x00002000 (0x2000 8kB) protected
6005 # 2: 0x00004000 (0x2000 8kB) not protected
6006 @end example
6007 @end deffn
6008
6009 @deffn Command {lpc2900 secure_jtag} bank
6010 Irreversibly disable the JTAG port. The new JTAG security setting will be
6011 effective after the next power cycle.
6012 @quotation Attention
6013 This cannot be reverted! Be careful!
6014 @end quotation
6015 Examples:
6016 @example
6017 lpc2900 secure_jtag 0
6018 @end example
6019 @end deffn
6020 @end deffn
6021
6022 @deffn {Flash Driver} mdr
6023 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on Milandr Cortex-M
6024 based controllers. A known limitation is that the Info memory can't be
6025 read or verified as it's not memory mapped.
6026
6027 @example
6028 flash bank <name> mdr <base> <size> \
6029 0 0 <target#> @var{type} @var{page_count} @var{sec_count}
6030 @end example
6031
6032 @itemize @bullet
6033 @item @var{type} - 0 for main memory, 1 for info memory
6034 @item @var{page_count} - total number of pages
6035 @item @var{sec_count} - number of sector per page count
6036 @end itemize
6037
6038 Example usage:
6039 @example
6040 if @{ [info exists IMEMORY] && [string equal $IMEMORY true] @} @{
6041 flash bank $@{_CHIPNAME@}_info.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x01000 \
6042 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 1 1 4
6043 @} else @{
6044 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.flash mdr 0x00000000 0x20000 \
6045 0 0 $_TARGETNAME 0 32 4
6046 @}
6047 @end example
6048 @end deffn
6049
6050 @deffn {Flash Driver} msp432
6051 All versions of the SimpleLink MSP432 microcontrollers from Texas
6052 Instruments include internal flash. The msp432 flash driver automatically
6053 recognizes the specific version's flash parameters and autoconfigures itself.
6054 Main program flash (starting at address 0) is flash bank 0. Information flash
6055 region on MSP432P4 versions (starting at address 0x200000) is flash bank 1.
6056
6057 @example
6058 flash bank $_FLASHNAME msp432 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6059 @end example
6060
6061 @deffn Command {msp432 mass_erase} [main|all]
6062 Performs a complete erase of flash. By default, @command{mass_erase} will erase
6063 only the main program flash.
6064
6065 On MSP432P4 versions, using @command{mass_erase all} will erase both the
6066 main program and information flash regions. To also erase the BSL in information
6067 flash, the user must first use the @command{bsl} command.
6068 @end deffn
6069
6070 @deffn Command {msp432 bsl} [unlock|lock]
6071 On MSP432P4 versions, @command{bsl} unlocks and locks the bootstrap loader (BSL)
6072 region in information flash so that flash commands can erase or write the BSL.
6073 Leave the BSL locked to prevent accidentally corrupting the bootstrap loader.
6074
6075 To erase and program the BSL:
6076 @example
6077 msp432 bsl unlock
6078 flash erase_address 0x202000 0x2000
6079 flash write_image bsl.bin 0x202000
6080 msp432 bsl lock
6081 @end example
6082 @end deffn
6083 @end deffn
6084
6085 @deffn {Flash Driver} niietcm4
6086 This drivers handles the integrated NOR flash on NIIET Cortex-M4
6087 based controllers. Flash size and sector layout are auto-configured by the driver.
6088 Main flash memory is called "Bootflash" and has main region and info region.
6089 Info region is NOT memory mapped by default,
6090 but it can replace first part of main region if needed.
6091 Full erase, single and block writes are supported for both main and info regions.
6092 There is additional not memory mapped flash called "Userflash", which
6093 also have division into regions: main and info.
6094 Purpose of userflash - to store system and user settings.
6095 Driver has special commands to perform operations with this memory.
6096
6097 @example
6098 flash bank $_FLASHNAME niietcm4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6099 @end example
6100
6101 Some niietcm4-specific commands are defined:
6102
6103 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_read_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address
6104 Read byte from main or info userflash region.
6105 @end deffn
6106
6107 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_write_byte} bank ('main'|'info') address value
6108 Write byte to main or info userflash region.
6109 @end deffn
6110
6111 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_full_erase} bank
6112 Erase all userflash including info region.
6113 @end deffn
6114
6115 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_erase} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector
6116 Erase sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6117 @end deffn
6118
6119 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect_check} bank ('main'|'info')
6120 Check sectors protect.
6121 @end deffn
6122
6123 @deffn Command {niietcm4 uflash_protect} bank ('main'|'info') first_sector last_sector ('on'|'off')
6124 Protect sectors of main or info userflash region, starting at sector first up to and including last.
6125 @end deffn
6126
6127 @deffn Command {niietcm4 bflash_info_remap} bank ('on'|'off')
6128 Enable remapping bootflash info region to 0x00000000 (or 0x40000000 if external memory boot used).
6129 @end deffn
6130
6131 @deffn Command {niietcm4 extmem_cfg} bank ('gpioa'|'gpiob'|'gpioc'|'gpiod'|'gpioe'|'gpiof'|'gpiog'|'gpioh') pin_num ('func1'|'func3')
6132 Configure external memory interface for boot.
6133 @end deffn
6134
6135 @deffn Command {niietcm4 service_mode_erase} bank
6136 Perform emergency erase of all flash (bootflash and userflash).
6137 @end deffn
6138
6139 @deffn Command {niietcm4 driver_info} bank
6140 Show information about flash driver.
6141 @end deffn
6142
6143 @end deffn
6144
6145 @deffn {Flash Driver} nrf5
6146 All members of the nRF51 microcontroller families from Nordic Semiconductor
6147 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 core.
6148 Also, the nRF52832 microcontroller from Nordic Semiconductor, which include
6149 internal flash and use an ARM Cortex-M4F core.
6150
6151 @example
6152 flash bank $_FLASHNAME nrf5 0 0x00000000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6153 @end example
6154
6155 Some nrf5-specific commands are defined:
6156
6157 @deffn Command {nrf5 mass_erase}
6158 Erases the contents of the code memory and user information
6159 configuration registers as well. It must be noted that this command
6160 works only for chips that do not have factory pre-programmed region 0
6161 code.
6162 @end deffn
6163
6164 @end deffn
6165
6166 @deffn {Flash Driver} ocl
6167 This driver is an implementation of the ``on chip flash loader''
6168 protocol proposed by Pavel Chromy.
6169
6170 It is a minimalistic command-response protocol intended to be used
6171 over a DCC when communicating with an internal or external flash
6172 loader running from RAM. An example implementation for AT91SAM7x is
6173 available in @file{contrib/loaders/flash/at91sam7x/}.
6174
6175 @example
6176 flash bank $_FLASHNAME ocl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6177 @end example
6178 @end deffn
6179
6180 @deffn {Flash Driver} pic32mx
6181 The PIC32MX microcontrollers are based on the MIPS 4K cores,
6182 and integrate flash memory.
6183
6184 @example
6185 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1fc00000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6186 flash bank $_FLASHNAME pix32mx 0x1d000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6187 @end example
6188
6189 @comment numerous *disabled* commands are defined:
6190 @comment - chip_erase ... pointless given flash_erase_address
6191 @comment - lock, unlock ... pointless given protect on/off (yes?)
6192 @comment - pgm_word ... shouldn't bank be deduced from address??
6193 Some pic32mx-specific commands are defined:
6194 @deffn Command {pic32mx pgm_word} address value bank
6195 Programs the specified 32-bit @var{value} at the given @var{address}
6196 in the specified chip @var{bank}.
6197 @end deffn
6198 @deffn Command {pic32mx unlock} bank
6199 Unlock and erase specified chip @var{bank}.
6200 This will remove any Code Protection.
6201 @end deffn
6202 @end deffn
6203
6204 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc4
6205 All members of the PSoC 41xx/42xx microcontroller family from Cypress
6206 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0 cores.
6207 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6208 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6209
6210 Note: Erased internal flash reads as 00.
6211 System ROM of PSoC 4 does not implement erase of a flash sector.
6212
6213 @example
6214 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc4 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6215 @end example
6216
6217 psoc4-specific commands
6218 @deffn Command {psoc4 flash_autoerase} num (on|off)
6219 Enables or disables autoerase mode for a flash bank.
6220
6221 If flash_autoerase is off, use mass_erase before flash programming.
6222 Flash erase command fails if region to erase is not whole flash memory.
6223
6224 If flash_autoerase is on, a sector is both erased and programmed in one
6225 system ROM call. Flash erase command is ignored.
6226 This mode is suitable for gdb load.
6227
6228 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6229 @end deffn
6230
6231 @deffn Command {psoc4 mass_erase} num
6232 Erases the contents of the flash memory, protection and security lock.
6233
6234 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6235 @end deffn
6236 @end deffn
6237
6238 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp
6239 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6240 include internal program flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6241 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6242 apart from the base address.
6243
6244 @example
6245 flash bank $_FLASHNAME psoc5lp 0x00000000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6246 @end example
6247
6248 @b{Note:} PSoC 5LP chips can be configured to have ECC enabled or disabled.
6249 @quotation Attention
6250 If flash operations are performed in ECC-disabled mode, they will also affect
6251 the ECC flash region. Erasing a 16k flash sector in the 0x00000000 area will
6252 then also erase the corresponding 2k data bytes in the 0x48000000 area.
6253 Writing to the ECC data bytes in ECC-disabled mode is not implemented.
6254 @end quotation
6255
6256 Commands defined in the @var{psoc5lp} driver:
6257
6258 @deffn Command {psoc5lp mass_erase}
6259 Erases all flash data and ECC/configuration bytes, all flash protection rows,
6260 and all row latches in all flash arrays on the device.
6261 @end deffn
6262 @end deffn
6263
6264 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_eeprom
6265 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6266 include internal EEPROM and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6267 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself,
6268 apart from the base address.
6269
6270 @example
6271 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.eeprom psoc5lp_eeprom 0x40008000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6272 @end example
6273 @end deffn
6274
6275 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc5lp_nvl
6276 All members of the PSoC 5LP microcontroller family from Cypress
6277 include internal Nonvolatile Latches and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores.
6278 The driver probes for a number of these chips and autoconfigures itself.
6279
6280 @example
6281 flash bank $_CHIPNAME.nvl psoc5lp_nvl 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6282 @end example
6283
6284 PSoC 5LP chips have multiple NV Latches:
6285
6286 @itemize
6287 @item Device Configuration NV Latch - 4 bytes
6288 @item Write Once (WO) NV Latch - 4 bytes
6289 @end itemize
6290
6291 @b{Note:} This driver only implements the Device Configuration NVL.
6292
6293 The @var{psoc5lp} driver reads the ECC mode from Device Configuration NVL.
6294 @quotation Attention
6295 Switching ECC mode via write to Device Configuration NVL will require a reset
6296 after successful write.
6297 @end quotation
6298 @end deffn
6299
6300 @deffn {Flash Driver} psoc6
6301 Supports PSoC6 (CY8C6xxx) family of Cypress microcontrollers.
6302 PSoC6 is a dual-core device with CM0+ and CM4 cores. Both cores share
6303 the same Flash/RAM/MMIO address space.
6304
6305 Flash in PSoC6 is split into three regions:
6306 @itemize @bullet
6307 @item Main Flash - this is the main storage for user application.
6308 Total size varies among devices, sector size: 256 kBytes, row size:
6309 512 bytes. Supports erase operation on individual rows.
6310 @item Work Flash - intended to be used as storage for user data
6311 (e.g. EEPROM emulation). Total size: 32 KBytes, sector size: 32 KBytes,
6312 row size: 512 bytes.
6313 @item Supervisory Flash - special region which contains device-specific
6314 service data. This region does not support erase operation. Only few rows can
6315 be programmed by the user, most of the rows are read only. Programming
6316 operation will erase row automatically.
6317 @end itemize
6318
6319 All three flash regions are supported by the driver. Flash geometry is detected
6320 automatically by parsing data in SPCIF_GEOMETRY register.
6321
6322 PSoC6 is equipped with NOR Flash so erased Flash reads as 0x00.
6323
6324 @example
6325 flash bank main_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6326 flash bank work_flash_cm0 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6327 flash bank super_flash_user_cm0 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6328 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm0 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6329 flash bank super_flash_key_cm0 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6330 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm0 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm0
6331
6332 flash bank main_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x10000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6333 flash bank work_flash_cm4 psoc6 0x14000000 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6334 flash bank super_flash_user_cm4 psoc6 0x16000800 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6335 flash bank super_flash_nar_cm4 psoc6 0x16001A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6336 flash bank super_flash_key_cm4 psoc6 0x16005A00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6337 flash bank super_flash_toc2_cm4 psoc6 0x16007C00 0 0 0 $@{TARGET@}.cm4
6338 @end example
6339
6340 psoc6-specific commands
6341 @deffn Command {psoc6 reset_halt}
6342 Command can be used to simulate broken Vector Catch from gdbinit or tcl scripts.
6343 When invoked for CM0+ target, it will set break point at application entry point
6344 and issue SYSRESETREQ. This will reset both cores and all peripherals. CM0+ will
6345 reset CM4 during boot anyway so this is safe. On CM4 target, VECTRESET is used
6346 instead of SYSRESETREQ to avoid unwanted reset of CM0+;
6347 @end deffn
6348
6349 @deffn Command {psoc6 mass_erase} num
6350 Erases the contents given flash bank. The @var{num} parameter is a value shown
6351 by @command{flash banks}.
6352 Note: only Main and Work flash regions support Erase operation.
6353 @end deffn
6354 @end deffn
6355
6356 @deffn {Flash Driver} sim3x
6357 All members of the SiM3 microcontroller family from Silicon Laboratories
6358 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 cores. It supports both JTAG
6359 and SWD interface.
6360 The @var{sim3x} driver tries to probe the device to auto detect the MCU.
6361 If this fails, it will use the @var{size} parameter as the size of flash bank.
6362
6363 @example
6364 flash bank $_FLASHNAME sim3x 0 $_CPUROMSIZE 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6365 @end example
6366
6367 There are 2 commands defined in the @var{sim3x} driver:
6368
6369 @deffn Command {sim3x mass_erase}
6370 Erases the complete flash. This is used to unlock the flash.
6371 And this command is only possible when using the SWD interface.
6372 @end deffn
6373
6374 @deffn Command {sim3x lock}
6375 Lock the flash. To unlock use the @command{sim3x mass_erase} command.
6376 @end deffn
6377 @end deffn
6378
6379 @deffn {Flash Driver} stellaris
6380 All members of the Stellaris LM3Sxxx, LM4x and Tiva C microcontroller
6381 families from Texas Instruments include internal flash. The driver
6382 automatically recognizes a number of these chips using the chip
6383 identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6384
6385 @example
6386 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stellaris 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6387 @end example
6388
6389 @deffn Command {stellaris recover}
6390 Performs the @emph{Recovering a "Locked" Device} procedure to restore
6391 the flash and its associated nonvolatile registers to their factory
6392 default values (erased). This is the only way to remove flash
6393 protection or re-enable debugging if that capability has been
6394 disabled.
6395
6396 Note that the final "power cycle the chip" step in this procedure
6397 must be performed by hand, since OpenOCD can't do it.
6398 @quotation Warning
6399 if more than one Stellaris chip is connected, the procedure is
6400 applied to all of them.
6401 @end quotation
6402 @end deffn
6403 @end deffn
6404
6405 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f1x
6406 All members of the STM32F0, STM32F1 and STM32F3 microcontroller families
6407 from ST Microelectronics include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M0/M3/M4 cores.
6408 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6409 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6410
6411 @example
6412 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6413 @end example
6414
6415 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6416 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6417 the flash driver.
6418
6419 @example
6420 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6421 @end example
6422
6423 If you have a target with dual flash banks then define the second bank
6424 as per the following example.
6425 @example
6426 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f1x 0x08080000 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6427 @end example
6428
6429 Some stm32f1x-specific commands are defined:
6430
6431 @deffn Command {stm32f1x lock} num
6432 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6433 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6434 @end deffn
6435
6436 @deffn Command {stm32f1x unlock} num
6437 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6438 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6439 @end deffn
6440
6441 @deffn Command {stm32f1x mass_erase} num
6442 Mass erases the entire stm32f1x device.
6443 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6444 @end deffn
6445
6446 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_read} num
6447 Read and display the stm32 option bytes written by
6448 the @command{stm32f1x options_write} command.
6449 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6450 @end deffn
6451
6452 @deffn Command {stm32f1x options_write} num (@option{SWWDG}|@option{HWWDG}) (@option{RSTSTNDBY}|@option{NORSTSTNDBY}) (@option{RSTSTOP}|@option{NORSTSTOP})
6453 Writes the stm32 option byte with the specified values.
6454 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6455 @end deffn
6456 @end deffn
6457
6458 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32f2x
6459 All members of the STM32F2, STM32F4 and STM32F7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6460 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3/M4/M7 cores.
6461 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6462 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6463
6464 @example
6465 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6466 @end example
6467
6468 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6469 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6470 the flash driver.
6471
6472 @example
6473 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32f2x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6474 @end example
6475
6476 Some stm32f2x-specific commands are defined:
6477
6478 @deffn Command {stm32f2x lock} num
6479 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6480 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6481 @end deffn
6482
6483 @deffn Command {stm32f2x unlock} num
6484 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6485 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6486 @end deffn
6487
6488 @deffn Command {stm32f2x mass_erase} num
6489 Mass erases the entire stm32f2x device.
6490 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6491 @end deffn
6492
6493 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_read} num
6494 Reads and displays user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0, boot_addr1, optcr2.
6495 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6496 @end deffn
6497
6498 @deffn Command {stm32f2x options_write} num user_options boot_addr0 boot_addr1
6499 Writes user options and (where implemented) boot_addr0 and boot_addr1 in raw format.
6500 Warning: The meaning of the various bits depends on the device, always check datasheet!
6501 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{user_options} a
6502 12 bit value, consisting of bits 31-28 and 7-0 of FLASH_OPTCR, @var{boot_addr0} and
6503 @var{boot_addr1} two halfwords (of FLASH_OPTCR1).
6504 @end deffn
6505
6506 @deffn Command {stm32f2x optcr2_write} num optcr2
6507 Writes FLASH_OPTCR2 options. Warning: Clearing PCROPi bits requires a full mass erase!
6508 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{optcr2} a 32-bit word.
6509 @end deffn
6510 @end deffn
6511
6512 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32h7x
6513 All members of the STM32H7 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6514 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M7 core.
6515 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6516 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6517
6518 @example
6519 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6520 @end example
6521
6522 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6523 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6524 the flash driver.
6525
6526 @example
6527 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32h7x 0 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6528 @end example
6529
6530 Some stm32h7x-specific commands are defined:
6531
6532 @deffn Command {stm32h7x lock} num
6533 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6534 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6535 @end deffn
6536
6537 @deffn Command {stm32h7x unlock} num
6538 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6539 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6540 @end deffn
6541
6542 @deffn Command {stm32h7x mass_erase} num
6543 Mass erases the entire stm32h7x device.
6544 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6545 @end deffn
6546 @end deffn
6547
6548 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32lx
6549 All members of the STM32L microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6550 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M3 and Cortex-M0+ cores.
6551 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6552 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6553
6554 @example
6555 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6556 @end example
6557
6558 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6559 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6560 the flash driver. If you use 0 as the bank base address, it tells the
6561 driver to autodetect the bank location assuming you're configuring the
6562 second bank.
6563
6564 @example
6565 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32lx 0x08000000 0x20000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6566 @end example
6567
6568 Some stm32lx-specific commands are defined:
6569
6570 @deffn Command {stm32lx lock} num
6571 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6572 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6573 @end deffn
6574
6575 @deffn Command {stm32lx unlock} num
6576 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6577 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6578 @end deffn
6579
6580 @deffn Command {stm32lx mass_erase} num
6581 Mass erases the entire stm32lx device (all flash banks and EEPROM
6582 data). This is the only way to unlock a protected flash (unless RDP
6583 Level is 2 which can't be unlocked at all).
6584 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6585 @end deffn
6586 @end deffn
6587
6588 @deffn {Flash Driver} stm32l4x
6589 All members of the STM32L4 microcontroller families from ST Microelectronics
6590 include internal flash and use ARM Cortex-M4 cores.
6591 The driver automatically recognizes a number of these chips using
6592 the chip identification register, and autoconfigures itself.
6593
6594 @example
6595 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0 0 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6596 @end example
6597
6598 Note that some devices have been found that have a flash size register that contains
6599 an invalid value, to workaround this issue you can override the probed value used by
6600 the flash driver.
6601
6602 @example
6603 flash bank $_FLASHNAME stm32l4x 0x08000000 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6604 @end example
6605
6606 Some stm32l4x-specific commands are defined:
6607
6608 @deffn Command {stm32l4x lock} num
6609 Locks the entire stm32 device.
6610 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6611 @end deffn
6612
6613 @deffn Command {stm32l4x unlock} num
6614 Unlocks the entire stm32 device.
6615 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6616 @end deffn
6617
6618 @deffn Command {stm32l4x mass_erase} num
6619 Mass erases the entire stm32l4x device.
6620 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6621 @end deffn
6622
6623 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_read} num reg_offset
6624 Reads an option byte register from the stm32l4x device.
6625 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6626 is the register offset of the Option byte to read.
6627
6628 For example to read the FLASH_OPTR register:
6629 @example
6630 stm32l4x option_read 0 0x20
6631 # Option Register: <0x40022020> = 0xffeff8aa
6632 @end example
6633
6634 The above example will read out the FLASH_OPTR register which contains the RDP
6635 option byte, Watchdog configuration, BOR level etc.
6636 @end deffn
6637
6638 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_write} num reg_offset reg_mask
6639 Write an option byte register of the stm32l4x device.
6640 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}, @var{reg_offset}
6641 is the register offset of the Option byte to write, and @var{reg_mask} is the mask
6642 to apply when writing the register (only bits with a '1' will be touched).
6643
6644 For example to write the WRP1AR option bytes:
6645 @example
6646 stm32l4x option_write 0 0x28 0x00FF0000 0x00FF00FF
6647 @end example
6648
6649 The above example will write the WRP1AR option register configuring the Write protection
6650 Area A for bank 1. The above example set WRP1AR_END=255, WRP1AR_START=0.
6651 This will effectively write protect all sectors in flash bank 1.
6652 @end deffn
6653
6654 @deffn Command {stm32l4x option_load} num
6655 Forces a re-load of the option byte registers. Will cause a reset of the device.
6656 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6657 @end deffn
6658 @end deffn
6659
6660 @deffn {Flash Driver} str7x
6661 All members of the STR7 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
6662 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6663 The @var{str7x} driver defines one mandatory parameter, @var{variant},
6664 which is either @code{STR71x}, @code{STR73x} or @code{STR75x}.
6665
6666 @example
6667 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str7x \
6668 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME STR71x
6669 @end example
6670
6671 @deffn Command {str7x disable_jtag} bank
6672 Activate the Debug/Readout protection mechanism
6673 for the specified flash bank.
6674 @end deffn
6675 @end deffn
6676
6677 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9x
6678 Most members of the STR9 microcontroller family from ST Microelectronics
6679 include internal flash and use ARM966E cores.
6680 The str9 needs the flash controller to be configured using
6681 the @command{str9x flash_config} command prior to Flash programming.
6682
6683 @example
6684 flash bank $_FLASHNAME str9x 0x40000000 0x00040000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME
6685 str9x flash_config 0 4 2 0 0x80000
6686 @end example
6687
6688 @deffn Command {str9x flash_config} num bbsr nbbsr bbadr nbbadr
6689 Configures the str9 flash controller.
6690 The @var{num} parameter is a value shown by @command{flash banks}.
6691
6692 @itemize @bullet
6693 @item @var{bbsr} - Boot Bank Size register
6694 @item @var{nbbsr} - Non Boot Bank Size register
6695 @item @var{bbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6696 @item @var{nbbadr} - Boot Bank Start Address register
6697 @end itemize
6698 @end deffn
6699
6700 @end deffn
6701
6702 @deffn {Flash Driver} str9xpec
6703 @cindex str9xpec
6704
6705 Only use this driver for locking/unlocking the device or configuring the option bytes.
6706 Use the standard str9 driver for programming.
6707 Before using the flash commands the turbo mode must be enabled using the
6708 @command{str9xpec enable_turbo} command.
6709
6710 Here is some background info to help
6711 you better understand how this driver works. OpenOCD has two flash drivers for
6712 the str9:
6713 @enumerate
6714 @item
6715 Standard driver @option{str9x} programmed via the str9 core. Normally used for
6716 flash programming as it is faster than the @option{str9xpec} driver.
6717 @item
6718 Direct programming @option{str9xpec} using the flash controller. This is an
6719 ISC compliant (IEEE 1532) tap connected in series with the str9 core. The str9
6720 core does not need to be running to program using this flash driver. Typical use
6721 for this driver is locking/unlocking the target and programming the option bytes.
6722 @end enumerate
6723
6724 Before we run any commands using the @option{str9xpec} driver we must first disable
6725 the str9 core. This example assumes the @option{str9xpec} driver has been
6726 configured for flash bank 0.
6727 @example
6728 # assert srst, we do not want core running
6729 # while accessing str9xpec flash driver
6730 jtag_reset 0 1
6731 # turn off target polling
6732 poll off
6733 # disable str9 core
6734 str9xpec enable_turbo 0
6735 # read option bytes
6736 str9xpec options_read 0
6737 # re-enable str9 core
6738 str9xpec disable_turbo 0
6739 poll on
6740 reset halt
6741 @end example
6742 The above example will read the str9 option bytes.
6743 When performing a unlock remember that you will not be able to halt the str9 - it
6744 has been locked. Halting the core is not required for the @option{str9xpec} driver
6745 as mentioned above, just issue the commands above manually or from a telnet prompt.
6746
6747 Several str9xpec-specific commands are defined:
6748
6749 @deffn Command {str9xpec disable_turbo} num
6750 Restore the str9 into JTAG chain.
6751 @end deffn
6752
6753 @deffn Command {str9xpec enable_turbo} num
6754 Enable turbo mode, will simply remove the str9 from the chain and talk
6755 directly to the embedded flash controller.
6756 @end deffn
6757
6758 @deffn Command {str9xpec lock} num
6759 Lock str9 device. The str9 will only respond to an unlock command that will
6760 erase the device.
6761 @end deffn
6762
6763 @deffn Command {str9xpec part_id} num
6764 Prints the part identifier for bank @var{num}.
6765 @end deffn
6766
6767 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_cmap} num (@option{bank0}|@option{bank1})
6768 Configure str9 boot bank.
6769 @end deffn
6770
6771 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdsel} num (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6772 Configure str9 lvd source.
6773 @end deffn
6774
6775 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdthd} num (@option{2.4v}|@option{2.7v})
6776 Configure str9 lvd threshold.
6777 @end deffn
6778
6779 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_lvdwarn} bank (@option{vdd}|@option{vdd_vddq})
6780 Configure str9 lvd reset warning source.
6781 @end deffn
6782
6783 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_read} num
6784 Read str9 option bytes.
6785 @end deffn
6786
6787 @deffn Command {str9xpec options_write} num
6788 Write str9 option bytes.
6789 @end deffn
6790
6791 @deffn Command {str9xpec unlock} num
6792 unlock str9 device.
6793 @end deffn
6794
6795 @end deffn
6796
6797 @deffn {Flash Driver} tms470
6798 Most members of the TMS470 microcontroller family from Texas Instruments
6799 include internal flash and use ARM7TDMI cores.
6800 This driver doesn't require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6801
6802 Some tms470-specific commands are defined:
6803
6804 @deffn Command {tms470 flash_keyset} key0 key1 key2 key3
6805 Saves programming keys in a register, to enable flash erase and write commands.
6806 @end deffn
6807
6808 @deffn Command {tms470 osc_mhz} clock_mhz
6809 Reports the clock speed, which is used to calculate timings.
6810 @end deffn
6811
6812 @deffn Command {tms470 plldis} (0|1)
6813 Disables (@var{1}) or enables (@var{0}) use of the PLL to speed up
6814 the flash clock.
6815 @end deffn
6816 @end deffn
6817
6818 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc1xxx
6819 All members of the XMC1xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6820 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6821 @end deffn
6822
6823 @deffn {Flash Driver} xmc4xxx
6824 All members of the XMC4xxx microcontroller family from Infineon.
6825 This driver does not require the chip and bus width to be specified.
6826
6827 Some xmc4xxx-specific commands are defined:
6828
6829 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_password} bank_id passwd1 passwd2
6830 Saves flash protection passwords which are used to lock the user flash
6831 @end deffn
6832
6833 @deffn Command {xmc4xxx flash_unprotect} bank_id user_level[0-1]
6834 Removes Flash write protection from the selected user bank
6835 @end deffn
6836
6837 @end deffn
6838
6839 @section NAND Flash Commands
6840 @cindex NAND
6841
6842 Compared to NOR or SPI flash, NAND devices are inexpensive
6843 and high density. Today's NAND chips, and multi-chip modules,
6844 commonly hold multiple GigaBytes of data.
6845
6846 NAND chips consist of a number of ``erase blocks'' of a given
6847 size (such as 128 KBytes), each of which is divided into a
6848 number of pages (of perhaps 512 or 2048 bytes each). Each
6849 page of a NAND flash has an ``out of band'' (OOB) area to hold
6850 Error Correcting Code (ECC) and other metadata, usually 16 bytes
6851 of OOB for every 512 bytes of page data.
6852
6853 One key characteristic of NAND flash is that its error rate
6854 is higher than that of NOR flash. In normal operation, that
6855 ECC is used to correct and detect errors. However, NAND
6856 blocks can also wear out and become unusable; those blocks
6857 are then marked "bad". NAND chips are even shipped from the
6858 manufacturer with a few bad blocks. The highest density chips
6859 use a technology (MLC) that wears out more quickly, so ECC
6860 support is increasingly important as a way to detect blocks
6861 that have begun to fail, and help to preserve data integrity
6862 with techniques such as wear leveling.
6863
6864 Software is used to manage the ECC. Some controllers don't
6865 support ECC directly; in those cases, software ECC is used.
6866 Other controllers speed up the ECC calculations with hardware.
6867 Single-bit error correction hardware is routine. Controllers
6868 geared for newer MLC chips may correct 4 or more errors for
6869 every 512 bytes of data.
6870
6871 You will need to make sure that any data you write using
6872 OpenOCD includes the appropriate kind of ECC. For example,
6873 that may mean passing the @code{oob_softecc} flag when
6874 writing NAND data, or ensuring that the correct hardware
6875 ECC mode is used.
6876
6877 The basic steps for using NAND devices include:
6878 @enumerate
6879 @item Declare via the command @command{nand device}
6880 @* Do this in a board-specific configuration file,
6881 passing parameters as needed by the controller.
6882 @item Configure each device using @command{nand probe}.
6883 @* Do this only after the associated target is set up,
6884 such as in its reset-init script or in procures defined
6885 to access that device.
6886 @item Operate on the flash via @command{nand subcommand}
6887 @* Often commands to manipulate the flash are typed by a human, or run
6888 via a script in some automated way. Common task include writing a
6889 boot loader, operating system, or other data needed to initialize or
6890 de-brick a board.
6891 @end enumerate
6892
6893 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, the largest NAND
6894 flash fully supported by OpenOCD is 2 GiBytes (16 GiBits).
6895 This is because the variables used to hold offsets and lengths
6896 are only 32 bits wide.
6897 (Larger chips may work in some cases, unless an offset or length
6898 is larger than 0xffffffff, the largest 32-bit unsigned integer.)
6899 Some larger devices will work, since they are actually multi-chip
6900 modules with two smaller chips and individual chipselect lines.
6901
6902 @anchor{nandconfiguration}
6903 @subsection NAND Configuration Commands
6904 @cindex NAND configuration
6905
6906 NAND chips must be declared in configuration scripts,
6907 plus some additional configuration that's done after
6908 OpenOCD has initialized.
6909
6910 @deffn {Config Command} {nand device} name driver target [configparams...]
6911 Declares a NAND device, which can be read and written to
6912 after it has been configured through @command{nand probe}.
6913 In OpenOCD, devices are single chips; this is unlike some
6914 operating systems, which may manage multiple chips as if
6915 they were a single (larger) device.
6916 In some cases, configuring a device will activate extra
6917 commands; see the controller-specific documentation.
6918
6919 @b{NOTE:} This command is not available after OpenOCD
6920 initialization has completed. Use it in board specific
6921 configuration files, not interactively.
6922
6923 @itemize @bullet
6924 @item @var{name} ... may be used to reference the NAND bank
6925 in most other NAND commands. A number is also available.
6926 @item @var{driver} ... identifies the NAND controller driver
6927 associated with the NAND device being declared.
6928 @xref{nanddriverlist,,NAND Driver List}.
6929 @item @var{target} ... names the target used when issuing
6930 commands to the NAND controller.
6931 @comment Actually, it's currently a controller-specific parameter...
6932 @item @var{configparams} ... controllers may support, or require,
6933 additional parameters. See the controller-specific documentation
6934 for more information.
6935 @end itemize
6936 @end deffn
6937
6938 @deffn Command {nand list}
6939 Prints a summary of each device declared
6940 using @command{nand device}, numbered from zero.
6941 Note that un-probed devices show no details.
6942 @example
6943 > nand list
6944 #0: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6945 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6946 #1: NAND 1GiB 3,3V 8-bit (Micron) pagesize: 2048, buswidth: 8,
6947 blocksize: 131072, blocks: 8192
6948 >
6949 @end example
6950 @end deffn
6951
6952 @deffn Command {nand probe} num
6953 Probes the specified device to determine key characteristics
6954 like its page and block sizes, and how many blocks it has.
6955 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6956 You must (successfully) probe a device before you can use
6957 it with most other NAND commands.
6958 @end deffn
6959
6960 @subsection Erasing, Reading, Writing to NAND Flash
6961
6962 @deffn Command {nand dump} num filename offset length [oob_option]
6963 @cindex NAND reading
6964 Reads binary data from the NAND device and writes it to the file,
6965 starting at the specified offset.
6966 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
6967
6968 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
6969 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
6970
6971 The @var{offset} and @var{length} must be exact multiples of the
6972 device's page size. They describe a data region; the OOB data
6973 associated with each such page may also be accessed.
6974
6975 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, no error correction
6976 was done on the data that's read, unless raw access was disabled
6977 and the underlying NAND controller driver had a @code{read_page}
6978 method which handled that error correction.
6979
6980 By default, only page data is saved to the specified file.
6981 Use an @var{oob_option} parameter to save OOB data:
6982 @itemize @bullet
6983 @item no oob_* parameter
6984 @*Output file holds only page data; OOB is discarded.
6985 @item @code{oob_raw}
6986 @*Output file interleaves page data and OOB data;
6987 the file will be longer than "length" by the size of the
6988 spare areas associated with each data page.
6989 Note that this kind of "raw" access is different from
6990 what's implied by @command{nand raw_access}, which just
6991 controls whether a hardware-aware access method is used.
6992 @item @code{oob_only}
6993 @*Output file has only raw OOB data, and will
6994 be smaller than "length" since it will contain only the
6995 spare areas associated with each data page.
6996 @end itemize
6997 @end deffn
6998
6999 @deffn Command {nand erase} num [offset length]
7000 @cindex NAND erasing
7001 @cindex NAND programming
7002 Erases blocks on the specified NAND device, starting at the
7003 specified @var{offset} and continuing for @var{length} bytes.
7004 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7005 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7006 If those parameters are not specified,
7007 the whole NAND chip will be erased.
7008 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7009
7010 @b{NOTE:} This command will try to erase bad blocks, when told
7011 to do so, which will probably invalidate the manufacturer's bad
7012 block marker.
7013 For the remainder of the current server session, @command{nand info}
7014 will still report that the block ``is'' bad.
7015 @end deffn
7016
7017 @deffn Command {nand write} num filename offset [option...]
7018 @cindex NAND writing
7019 @cindex NAND programming
7020 Writes binary data from the file into the specified NAND device,
7021 starting at the specified offset. Those pages should already
7022 have been erased; you can't change zero bits to one bits.
7023 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7024
7025 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7026 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7027
7028 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7029 All data in the file will be written, assuming it doesn't run
7030 past the end of the device.
7031 Only full pages are written, and any extra space in the last
7032 page will be filled with 0xff bytes. (That includes OOB data,
7033 if that's being written.)
7034
7035 @b{NOTE:} At the time this text was written, bad blocks are
7036 ignored. That is, this routine will not skip bad blocks,
7037 but will instead try to write them. This can cause problems.
7038
7039 Provide at most one @var{option} parameter. With some
7040 NAND drivers, the meanings of these parameters may change
7041 if @command{nand raw_access} was used to disable hardware ECC.
7042 @itemize @bullet
7043 @item no oob_* parameter
7044 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7045 If raw access is in use, the OOB area will not be written.
7046 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7047 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may write the OOB
7048 with hardware-computed ECC data.
7049 @item @code{oob_only}
7050 @*File has only raw OOB data, which is written to the OOB area.
7051 Each page's data area stays untouched. @i{This can be a dangerous
7052 option}, since it can invalidate the ECC data.
7053 You may need to force raw access to use this mode.
7054 @item @code{oob_raw}
7055 @*File interleaves data and OOB data, both of which are written
7056 If raw access is enabled, the data is written first, then the
7057 un-altered OOB.
7058 Otherwise, if the underlying NAND controller driver has
7059 a @code{write_page} routine, that routine may modify the OOB
7060 before it's written, to include hardware-computed ECC data.
7061 @item @code{oob_softecc}
7062 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7063 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a standard 1-bit
7064 software ECC code stored in conventional locations.
7065 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7066 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7067 @item @code{oob_softecc_kw}
7068 @*File has only page data, which is written.
7069 The OOB area is filled with 0xff, except for a 4-bit software ECC
7070 specific to the boot ROM in Marvell Kirkwood SoCs.
7071 You might need to force raw access to use this mode, to prevent
7072 the underlying driver from applying hardware ECC.
7073 @end itemize
7074 @end deffn
7075
7076 @deffn Command {nand verify} num filename offset [option...]
7077 @cindex NAND verification
7078 @cindex NAND programming
7079 Verify the binary data in the file has been programmed to the
7080 specified NAND device, starting at the specified offset.
7081 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7082
7083 Use a complete path name for @var{filename}, so you don't depend
7084 on the directory used to start the OpenOCD server.
7085
7086 The @var{offset} must be an exact multiple of the device's page size.
7087 All data in the file will be read and compared to the contents of the
7088 flash, assuming it doesn't run past the end of the device.
7089 As with @command{nand write}, only full pages are verified, so any extra
7090 space in the last page will be filled with 0xff bytes.
7091
7092 The same @var{options} accepted by @command{nand write},
7093 and the file will be processed similarly to produce the buffers that
7094 can be compared against the contents produced from @command{nand dump}.
7095
7096 @b{NOTE:} This will not work when the underlying NAND controller
7097 driver's @code{write_page} routine must update the OOB with a
7098 hardware-computed ECC before the data is written. This limitation may
7099 be removed in a future release.
7100 @end deffn
7101
7102 @subsection Other NAND commands
7103 @cindex NAND other commands
7104
7105 @deffn Command {nand check_bad_blocks} num [offset length]
7106 Checks for manufacturer bad block markers on the specified NAND
7107 device. If no parameters are provided, checks the whole
7108 device; otherwise, starts at the specified @var{offset} and
7109 continues for @var{length} bytes.
7110 Both of those values must be exact multiples of the device's
7111 block size, and the region they specify must fit entirely in the chip.
7112 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7113
7114 @b{NOTE:} Before using this command you should force raw access
7115 with @command{nand raw_access enable} to ensure that the underlying
7116 driver will not try to apply hardware ECC.
7117 @end deffn
7118
7119 @deffn Command {nand info} num
7120 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7121 This prints the one-line summary from "nand list", plus for
7122 devices which have been probed this also prints any known
7123 status for each block.
7124 @end deffn
7125
7126 @deffn Command {nand raw_access} num (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
7127 Sets or clears an flag affecting how page I/O is done.
7128 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7129
7130 This flag is cleared (disabled) by default, but changing that
7131 value won't affect all NAND devices. The key factor is whether
7132 the underlying driver provides @code{read_page} or @code{write_page}
7133 methods. If it doesn't provide those methods, the setting of
7134 this flag is irrelevant; all access is effectively ``raw''.
7135
7136 When those methods exist, they are normally used when reading
7137 data (@command{nand dump} or reading bad block markers) or
7138 writing it (@command{nand write}). However, enabling
7139 raw access (setting the flag) prevents use of those methods,
7140 bypassing hardware ECC logic.
7141 @i{This can be a dangerous option}, since writing blocks
7142 with the wrong ECC data can cause them to be marked as bad.
7143 @end deffn
7144
7145 @anchor{nanddriverlist}
7146 @subsection NAND Driver List
7147 As noted above, the @command{nand device} command allows
7148 driver-specific options and behaviors.
7149 Some controllers also activate controller-specific commands.
7150
7151 @deffn {NAND Driver} at91sam9
7152 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on AT91SAM9 family chips from
7153 Atmel. It takes two extra parameters: address of the NAND chip;
7154 address of the ECC controller.
7155 @example
7156 nand device $NANDFLASH at91sam9 $CHIPNAME 0x40000000 0xfffffe800
7157 @end example
7158 AT91SAM9 chips support single-bit ECC hardware. The @code{write_page} and
7159 @code{read_page} methods are used to utilize the ECC hardware unless they are
7160 disabled by using the @command{nand raw_access} command. There are four
7161 additional commands that are needed to fully configure the AT91SAM9 NAND
7162 controller. Two are optional; most boards use the same wiring for ALE/CLE:
7163 @deffn Command {at91sam9 cle} num addr_line
7164 Configure the address line used for latching commands. The @var{num}
7165 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7166 @end deffn
7167 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ale} num addr_line
7168 Configure the address line used for latching addresses. The @var{num}
7169 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7170 @end deffn
7171
7172 For the next two commands, it is assumed that the pins have already been
7173 properly configured for input or output.
7174 @deffn Command {at91sam9 rdy_busy} num pio_base_addr pin
7175 Configure the RDY/nBUSY input from the NAND device. The @var{num}
7176 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7177 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7178 @end deffn
7179 @deffn Command {at91sam9 ce} num pio_base_addr pin
7180 Configure the chip enable input to the NAND device. The @var{num}
7181 parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}. @var{pio_base_addr}
7182 is the base address of the PIO controller and @var{pin} is the pin number.
7183 @end deffn
7184 @end deffn
7185
7186 @deffn {NAND Driver} davinci
7187 This driver handles the NAND controllers found on DaVinci family
7188 chips from Texas Instruments.
7189 It takes three extra parameters:
7190 address of the NAND chip;
7191 hardware ECC mode to use (@option{hwecc1},
7192 @option{hwecc4}, @option{hwecc4_infix});
7193 address of the AEMIF controller on this processor.
7194 @example
7195 nand device davinci dm355.arm 0x02000000 hwecc4 0x01e10000
7196 @end example
7197 All DaVinci processors support the single-bit ECC hardware,
7198 and newer ones also support the four-bit ECC hardware.
7199 The @code{write_page} and @code{read_page} methods are used
7200 to implement those ECC modes, unless they are disabled using
7201 the @command{nand raw_access} command.
7202 @end deffn
7203
7204 @deffn {NAND Driver} lpc3180
7205 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7206 parameter: the clock rate used by the controller.
7207 @deffn Command {lpc3180 select} num [mlc|slc]
7208 Configures use of the MLC or SLC controller mode.
7209 MLC implies use of hardware ECC.
7210 The @var{num} parameter is the value shown by @command{nand list}.
7211 @end deffn
7212
7213 At this writing, this driver includes @code{write_page}
7214 and @code{read_page} methods. Using @command{nand raw_access}
7215 to disable those methods will prevent use of hardware ECC
7216 in the MLC controller mode, but won't change SLC behavior.
7217 @end deffn
7218 @comment current lpc3180 code won't issue 5-byte address cycles
7219
7220 @deffn {NAND Driver} mx3
7221 This driver handles the NAND controller in i.MX31. The mxc driver
7222 should work for this chip as well.
7223 @end deffn
7224
7225 @deffn {NAND Driver} mxc
7226 This driver handles the NAND controller found in Freescale i.MX
7227 chips. It has support for v1 (i.MX27 and i.MX31) and v2 (i.MX35).
7228 The driver takes 3 extra arguments, chip (@option{mx27},
7229 @option{mx31}, @option{mx35}), ecc (@option{noecc}, @option{hwecc})
7230 and optionally if bad block information should be swapped between
7231 main area and spare area (@option{biswap}), defaults to off.
7232 @example
7233 nand device mx35.nand mxc imx35.cpu mx35 hwecc biswap
7234 @end example
7235 @deffn Command {mxc biswap} bank_num [enable|disable]
7236 Turns on/off bad block information swapping from main area,
7237 without parameter query status.
7238 @end deffn
7239 @end deffn
7240
7241 @deffn {NAND Driver} orion
7242 These controllers require an extra @command{nand device}
7243 parameter: the address of the controller.
7244 @example
7245 nand device orion 0xd8000000
7246 @end example
7247 These controllers don't define any specialized commands.
7248 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7249 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7250 change any behavior.
7251 @end deffn
7252
7253 @deffn {NAND Driver} s3c2410
7254 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2412
7255 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2440
7256 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c2443
7257 @deffnx {NAND Driver} s3c6400
7258 These S3C family controllers don't have any special
7259 @command{nand device} options, and don't define any
7260 specialized commands.
7261 At this writing, their drivers don't include @code{write_page}
7262 or @code{read_page} methods, so @command{nand raw_access} won't
7263 change any behavior.
7264 @end deffn
7265
7266 @section mFlash
7267
7268 @subsection mFlash Configuration
7269 @cindex mFlash Configuration
7270
7271 @deffn {Config Command} {mflash bank} soc base RST_pin target
7272 Configures a mflash for @var{soc} host bank at
7273 address @var{base}.
7274 The pin number format depends on the host GPIO naming convention.
7275 Currently, the mflash driver supports s3c2440 and pxa270.
7276
7277 Example for s3c2440 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO B1:
7278
7279 @example
7280 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME s3c2440 0x10000000 1b 0
7281 @end example
7282
7283 Example for pxa270 mflash where @var{RST pin} is GPIO 43:
7284
7285 @example
7286 mflash bank $_FLASHNAME pxa270 0x08000000 43 0
7287 @end example
7288 @end deffn
7289
7290 @subsection mFlash commands
7291 @cindex mFlash commands
7292
7293 @deffn Command {mflash config pll} frequency
7294 Configure mflash PLL.
7295 The @var{frequency} is the mflash input frequency, in Hz.
7296 Issuing this command will erase mflash's whole internal nand and write new pll.
7297 After this command, mflash needs power-on-reset for normal operation.
7298 If pll was newly configured, storage and boot(optional) info also need to be update.
7299 @end deffn
7300
7301 @deffn Command {mflash config boot}
7302 Configure bootable option.
7303 If bootable option is set, mflash offer the first 8 sectors
7304 (4kB) for boot.
7305 @end deffn
7306
7307 @deffn Command {mflash config storage}
7308 Configure storage information.
7309 For the normal storage operation, this information must be
7310 written.
7311 @end deffn
7312
7313 @deffn Command {mflash dump} num filename offset size
7314 Dump @var{size} bytes, starting at @var{offset} bytes from the
7315 beginning of the bank @var{num}, to the file named @var{filename}.
7316 @end deffn
7317
7318 @deffn Command {mflash probe}
7319 Probe mflash.
7320 @end deffn
7321
7322 @deffn Command {mflash write} num filename offset
7323 Write the binary file @var{filename} to mflash bank @var{num}, starting at
7324 @var{offset} bytes from the beginning of the bank.
7325 @end deffn
7326
7327 @node Flash Programming
7328 @chapter Flash Programming
7329
7330 OpenOCD implements numerous ways to program the target flash, whether internal or external.
7331 Programming can be achieved by either using GDB @ref{programmingusinggdb,,Programming using GDB},
7332 or using the commands given in @ref{flashprogrammingcommands,,Flash Programming Commands}.
7333
7334 @*To simplify using the flash commands directly a jimtcl script is available that handles the programming and verify stage.
7335 OpenOCD will program/verify/reset the target and optionally shutdown.
7336
7337 The script is executed as follows and by default the following actions will be performed.
7338 @enumerate
7339 @item 'init' is executed.
7340 @item 'reset init' is called to reset and halt the target, any 'reset init' scripts are executed.
7341 @item @code{flash write_image} is called to erase and write any flash using the filename given.
7342 @item @code{verify_image} is called if @option{verify} parameter is given.
7343 @item @code{reset run} is called if @option{reset} parameter is given.
7344 @item OpenOCD is shutdown if @option{exit} parameter is given.
7345 @end enumerate
7346
7347 An example of usage is given below. @xref{program}.
7348
7349 @example
7350 # program and verify using elf/hex/s19. verify and reset
7351 # are optional parameters
7352 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7353 -c "program filename.elf verify reset exit"
7354
7355 # binary files need the flash address passing
7356 openocd -f board/stm32f3discovery.cfg \
7357 -c "program filename.bin exit 0x08000000"
7358 @end example
7359
7360 @node PLD/FPGA Commands
7361 @chapter PLD/FPGA Commands
7362 @cindex PLD
7363 @cindex FPGA
7364
7365 Programmable Logic Devices (PLDs) and the more flexible
7366 Field Programmable Gate Arrays (FPGAs) are both types of programmable hardware.
7367 OpenOCD can support programming them.
7368 Although PLDs are generally restrictive (cells are less functional, and
7369 there are no special purpose cells for memory or computational tasks),
7370 they share the same OpenOCD infrastructure.
7371 Accordingly, both are called PLDs here.
7372
7373 @section PLD/FPGA Configuration and Commands
7374
7375 As it does for JTAG TAPs, debug targets, and flash chips (both NOR and NAND),
7376 OpenOCD maintains a list of PLDs available for use in various commands.
7377 Also, each such PLD requires a driver.
7378
7379 They are referenced by the number shown by the @command{pld devices} command,
7380 and new PLDs are defined by @command{pld device driver_name}.
7381
7382 @deffn {Config Command} {pld device} driver_name tap_name [driver_options]
7383 Defines a new PLD device, supported by driver @var{driver_name},
7384 using the TAP named @var{tap_name}.
7385 The driver may make use of any @var{driver_options} to configure its
7386 behavior.
7387 @end deffn
7388
7389 @deffn {Command} {pld devices}
7390 Lists the PLDs and their numbers.
7391 @end deffn
7392
7393 @deffn {Command} {pld load} num filename
7394 Loads the file @file{filename} into the PLD identified by @var{num}.
7395 The file format must be inferred by the driver.
7396 @end deffn
7397
7398 @section PLD/FPGA Drivers, Options, and Commands
7399
7400 Drivers may support PLD-specific options to the @command{pld device}
7401 definition command, and may also define commands usable only with
7402 that particular type of PLD.
7403
7404 @deffn {FPGA Driver} virtex2 [no_jstart]
7405 Virtex-II is a family of FPGAs sold by Xilinx.
7406 It supports the IEEE 1532 standard for In-System Configuration (ISC).
7407
7408 If @var{no_jstart} is non-zero, the JSTART instruction is not used after
7409 loading the bitstream. While required for Series2, Series3, and Series6, it
7410 breaks bitstream loading on Series7.
7411
7412 @deffn {Command} {virtex2 read_stat} num
7413 Reads and displays the Virtex-II status register (STAT)
7414 for FPGA @var{num}.
7415 @end deffn
7416 @end deffn
7417
7418 @node General Commands
7419 @chapter General Commands
7420 @cindex commands
7421
7422 The commands documented in this chapter here are common commands that
7423 you, as a human, may want to type and see the output of. Configuration type
7424 commands are documented elsewhere.
7425
7426 Intent:
7427 @itemize @bullet
7428 @item @b{Source Of Commands}
7429 @* OpenOCD commands can occur in a configuration script (discussed
7430 elsewhere) or typed manually by a human or supplied programmatically,
7431 or via one of several TCP/IP Ports.
7432
7433 @item @b{From the human}
7434 @* A human should interact with the telnet interface (default port: 4444)
7435 or via GDB (default port 3333).
7436
7437 To issue commands from within a GDB session, use the @option{monitor}
7438 command, e.g. use @option{monitor poll} to issue the @option{poll}
7439 command. All output is relayed through the GDB session.
7440
7441 @item @b{Machine Interface}
7442 The Tcl interface's intent is to be a machine interface. The default Tcl
7443 port is 5555.
7444 @end itemize
7445
7446
7447 @section Server Commands
7448
7449 @deffn {Command} exit
7450 Exits the current telnet session.
7451 @end deffn
7452
7453 @deffn {Command} help [string]
7454 With no parameters, prints help text for all commands.
7455 Otherwise, prints each helptext containing @var{string}.
7456 Not every command provides helptext.
7457
7458 Configuration commands, and commands valid at any time, are
7459 explicitly noted in parenthesis.
7460 In most cases, no such restriction is listed; this indicates commands
7461 which are only available after the configuration stage has completed.
7462 @end deffn
7463
7464 @deffn Command sleep msec [@option{busy}]
7465 Wait for at least @var{msec} milliseconds before resuming.
7466 If @option{busy} is passed, busy-wait instead of sleeping.
7467 (This option is strongly discouraged.)
7468 Useful in connection with script files
7469 (@command{script} command and @command{target_name} configuration).
7470 @end deffn
7471
7472 @deffn Command shutdown [@option{error}]
7473 Close the OpenOCD server, disconnecting all clients (GDB, telnet,
7474 other). If option @option{error} is used, OpenOCD will return a
7475 non-zero exit code to the parent process.
7476
7477 Like any TCL commands, also @command{shutdown} can be redefined, e.g.:
7478 @example
7479 # redefine shutdown
7480 rename shutdown original_shutdown
7481 proc shutdown @{@} @{
7482 puts "This is my implementation of shutdown"
7483 # my own stuff before exit OpenOCD
7484 original_shutdown
7485 @}
7486 @end example
7487 If user types CTRL-C or kills OpenOCD, either the command @command{shutdown}
7488 or its replacement will be automatically executed before OpenOCD exits.
7489 @end deffn
7490
7491 @anchor{debuglevel}
7492 @deffn Command debug_level [n]
7493 @cindex message level
7494 Display debug level.
7495 If @var{n} (from 0..4) is provided, then set it to that level.
7496 This affects the kind of messages sent to the server log.
7497 Level 0 is error messages only;
7498 level 1 adds warnings;
7499 level 2 adds informational messages;
7500 level 3 adds debugging messages;
7501 and level 4 adds verbose low-level debug messages.
7502 The default is level 2, but that can be overridden on
7503 the command line along with the location of that log
7504 file (which is normally the server's standard output).
7505 @xref{Running}.
7506 @end deffn
7507
7508 @deffn Command echo [-n] message
7509 Logs a message at "user" priority.
7510 Output @var{message} to stdout.
7511 Option "-n" suppresses trailing newline.
7512 @example
7513 echo "Downloading kernel -- please wait"
7514 @end example
7515 @end deffn
7516
7517 @deffn Command log_output [filename]
7518 Redirect logging to @var{filename};
7519 the initial log output channel is stderr.
7520 @end deffn
7521
7522 @deffn Command add_script_search_dir [directory]
7523 Add @var{directory} to the file/script search path.
7524 @end deffn
7525
7526 @deffn Command bindto [@var{name}]
7527 Specify hostname or IPv4 address on which to listen for incoming
7528 TCP/IP connections. By default, OpenOCD will listen on the loopback
7529 interface only. If your network environment is safe, @code{bindto
7530 0.0.0.0} can be used to cover all available interfaces.
7531 @end deffn
7532
7533 @anchor{targetstatehandling}
7534 @section Target State handling
7535 @cindex reset
7536 @cindex halt
7537 @cindex target initialization
7538
7539 In this section ``target'' refers to a CPU configured as
7540 shown earlier (@pxref{CPU Configuration}).
7541 These commands, like many, implicitly refer to
7542 a current target which is used to perform the
7543 various operations. The current target may be changed
7544 by using @command{targets} command with the name of the
7545 target which should become current.
7546
7547 @deffn Command reg [(number|name) [(value|'force')]]
7548 Access a single register by @var{number} or by its @var{name}.
7549 The target must generally be halted before access to CPU core
7550 registers is allowed. Depending on the hardware, some other
7551 registers may be accessible while the target is running.
7552
7553 @emph{With no arguments}:
7554 list all available registers for the current target,
7555 showing number, name, size, value, and cache status.
7556 For valid entries, a value is shown; valid entries
7557 which are also dirty (and will be written back later)
7558 are flagged as such.
7559
7560 @emph{With number/name}: display that register's value.
7561 Use @var{force} argument to read directly from the target,
7562 bypassing any internal cache.
7563
7564 @emph{With both number/name and value}: set register's value.
7565 Writes may be held in a writeback cache internal to OpenOCD,
7566 so that setting the value marks the register as dirty instead
7567 of immediately flushing that value. Resuming CPU execution
7568 (including by single stepping) or otherwise activating the
7569 relevant module will flush such values.
7570
7571 Cores may have surprisingly many registers in their
7572 Debug and trace infrastructure:
7573
7574 @example
7575 > reg
7576 ===== ARM registers
7577 (0) r0 (/32): 0x0000D3C2 (dirty)
7578 (1) r1 (/32): 0xFD61F31C
7579 (2) r2 (/32)
7580 ...
7581 (164) ETM_contextid_comparator_mask (/32)
7582 >
7583 @end example
7584 @end deffn
7585
7586 @deffn Command halt [ms]
7587 @deffnx Command wait_halt [ms]
7588 The @command{halt} command first sends a halt request to the target,
7589 which @command{wait_halt} doesn't.
7590 Otherwise these behave the same: wait up to @var{ms} milliseconds,
7591 or 5 seconds if there is no parameter, for the target to halt
7592 (and enter debug mode).
7593 Using 0 as the @var{ms} parameter prevents OpenOCD from waiting.
7594
7595 @quotation Warning
7596 On ARM cores, software using the @emph{wait for interrupt} operation
7597 often blocks the JTAG access needed by a @command{halt} command.
7598 This is because that operation also puts the core into a low
7599 power mode by gating the core clock;
7600 but the core clock is needed to detect JTAG clock transitions.
7601
7602 One partial workaround uses adaptive clocking: when the core is
7603 interrupted the operation completes, then JTAG clocks are accepted
7604 at least until the interrupt handler completes.
7605 However, this workaround is often unusable since the processor, board,
7606 and JTAG adapter must all support adaptive JTAG clocking.
7607 Also, it can't work until an interrupt is issued.
7608
7609 A more complete workaround is to not use that operation while you
7610 work with a JTAG debugger.
7611 Tasking environments generally have idle loops where the body is the
7612 @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
7613 (On older cores, it is a coprocessor action;
7614 newer cores have a @option{wfi} instruction.)
7615 Such loops can just remove that operation, at the cost of higher
7616 power consumption (because the CPU is needlessly clocked).
7617 @end quotation
7618
7619 @end deffn
7620
7621 @deffn Command resume [address]
7622 Resume the target at its current code position,
7623 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7624 OpenOCD will wait 5 seconds for the target to resume.
7625 @end deffn
7626
7627 @deffn Command step [address]
7628 Single-step the target at its current code position,
7629 or the optional @var{address} if it is provided.
7630 @end deffn
7631
7632 @anchor{resetcommand}
7633 @deffn Command reset
7634 @deffnx Command {reset run}
7635 @deffnx Command {reset halt}
7636 @deffnx Command {reset init}
7637 Perform as hard a reset as possible, using SRST if possible.
7638 @emph{All defined targets will be reset, and target
7639 events will fire during the reset sequence.}
7640
7641 The optional parameter specifies what should
7642 happen after the reset.
7643 If there is no parameter, a @command{reset run} is executed.
7644 The other options will not work on all systems.
7645 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
7646
7647 @itemize @minus
7648 @item @b{run} Let the target run
7649 @item @b{halt} Immediately halt the target
7650 @item @b{init} Immediately halt the target, and execute the reset-init script
7651 @end itemize
7652 @end deffn
7653
7654 @deffn Command soft_reset_halt
7655 Requesting target halt and executing a soft reset. This is often used
7656 when a target cannot be reset and halted. The target, after reset is
7657 released begins to execute code. OpenOCD attempts to stop the CPU and
7658 then sets the program counter back to the reset vector. Unfortunately
7659 the code that was executed may have left the hardware in an unknown
7660 state.
7661 @end deffn
7662
7663 @section I/O Utilities
7664
7665 These commands are available when
7666 OpenOCD is built with @option{--enable-ioutil}.
7667 They are mainly useful on embedded targets,
7668 notably the ZY1000.
7669 Hosts with operating systems have complementary tools.
7670
7671 @emph{Note:} there are several more such commands.
7672
7673 @deffn Command append_file filename [string]*
7674 Appends the @var{string} parameters to
7675 the text file @file{filename}.
7676 Each string except the last one is followed by one space.
7677 The last string is followed by a newline.
7678 @end deffn
7679
7680 @deffn Command cat filename
7681 Reads and displays the text file @file{filename}.
7682 @end deffn
7683
7684 @deffn Command cp src_filename dest_filename
7685 Copies contents from the file @file{src_filename}
7686 into @file{dest_filename}.
7687 @end deffn
7688
7689 @deffn Command ip
7690 @emph{No description provided.}
7691 @end deffn
7692
7693 @deffn Command ls
7694 @emph{No description provided.}
7695 @end deffn
7696
7697 @deffn Command mac
7698 @emph{No description provided.}
7699 @end deffn
7700
7701 @deffn Command meminfo
7702 Display available RAM memory on OpenOCD host.
7703 Used in OpenOCD regression testing scripts.
7704 @end deffn
7705
7706 @deffn Command peek
7707 @emph{No description provided.}
7708 @end deffn
7709
7710 @deffn Command poke
7711 @emph{No description provided.}
7712 @end deffn
7713
7714 @deffn Command rm filename
7715 @c "rm" has both normal and Jim-level versions??
7716 Unlinks the file @file{filename}.
7717 @end deffn
7718
7719 @deffn Command trunc filename
7720 Removes all data in the file @file{filename}.
7721 @end deffn
7722
7723 @anchor{memoryaccess}
7724 @section Memory access commands
7725 @cindex memory access
7726
7727 These commands allow accesses of a specific size to the memory
7728 system. Often these are used to configure the current target in some
7729 special way. For example - one may need to write certain values to the
7730 SDRAM controller to enable SDRAM.
7731
7732 @enumerate
7733 @item Use the @command{targets} (plural) command
7734 to change the current target.
7735 @item In system level scripts these commands are deprecated.
7736 Please use their TARGET object siblings to avoid making assumptions
7737 about what TAP is the current target, or about MMU configuration.
7738 @end enumerate
7739
7740 @deffn Command mdw [phys] addr [count]
7741 @deffnx Command mdh [phys] addr [count]
7742 @deffnx Command mdb [phys] addr [count]
7743 Display contents of address @var{addr}, as
7744 32-bit words (@command{mdw}), 16-bit halfwords (@command{mdh}),
7745 or 8-bit bytes (@command{mdb}).
7746 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7747 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7748 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7749 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7750 If @var{count} is specified, displays that many units.
7751 (If you want to manipulate the data instead of displaying it,
7752 see the @code{mem2array} primitives.)
7753 @end deffn
7754
7755 @deffn Command mww [phys] addr word
7756 @deffnx Command mwh [phys] addr halfword
7757 @deffnx Command mwb [phys] addr byte
7758 Writes the specified @var{word} (32 bits),
7759 @var{halfword} (16 bits), or @var{byte} (8-bit) value,
7760 at the specified address @var{addr}.
7761 When the current target has an MMU which is present and active,
7762 @var{addr} is interpreted as a virtual address.
7763 Otherwise, or if the optional @var{phys} flag is specified,
7764 @var{addr} is interpreted as a physical address.
7765 @end deffn
7766
7767 @anchor{imageaccess}
7768 @section Image loading commands
7769 @cindex image loading
7770 @cindex image dumping
7771
7772 @deffn Command {dump_image} filename address size
7773 Dump @var{size} bytes of target memory starting at @var{address} to the
7774 binary file named @var{filename}.
7775 @end deffn
7776
7777 @deffn Command {fast_load}
7778 Loads an image stored in memory by @command{fast_load_image} to the
7779 current target. Must be preceded by fast_load_image.
7780 @end deffn
7781
7782 @deffn Command {fast_load_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}]
7783 Normally you should be using @command{load_image} or GDB load. However, for
7784 testing purposes or when I/O overhead is significant(OpenOCD running on an embedded
7785 host), storing the image in memory and uploading the image to the target
7786 can be a way to upload e.g. multiple debug sessions when the binary does not change.
7787 Arguments are the same as @command{load_image}, but the image is stored in OpenOCD host
7788 memory, i.e. does not affect target. This approach is also useful when profiling
7789 target programming performance as I/O and target programming can easily be profiled
7790 separately.
7791 @end deffn
7792
7793 @deffn Command {load_image} filename address [[@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}|@option{s19}] @option{min_addr} @option{max_length}]
7794 Load image from file @var{filename} to target memory offset by @var{address} from its load address.
7795 The file format may optionally be specified
7796 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, @option{elf}, or @option{s19}).
7797 In addition the following arguments may be specified:
7798 @var{min_addr} - ignore data below @var{min_addr} (this is w.r.t. to the target's load address + @var{address})
7799 @var{max_length} - maximum number of bytes to load.
7800 @example
7801 proc load_image_bin @{fname foffset address length @} @{
7802 # Load data from fname filename at foffset offset to
7803 # target at address. Load at most length bytes.
7804 load_image $fname [expr $address - $foffset] bin \
7805 $address $length
7806 @}
7807 @end example
7808 @end deffn
7809
7810 @deffn Command {test_image} filename [address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]]
7811 Displays image section sizes and addresses
7812 as if @var{filename} were loaded into target memory
7813 starting at @var{address} (defaults to zero).
7814 The file format may optionally be specified
7815 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7816 @end deffn
7817
7818 @deffn Command {verify_image} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7819 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7820 The file format may optionally be specified
7821 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7822 This will first attempt a comparison using a CRC checksum, if this fails it will try a binary compare.
7823 @end deffn
7824
7825 @deffn Command {verify_image_checksum} filename address [@option{bin}|@option{ihex}|@option{elf}]
7826 Verify @var{filename} against target memory starting at @var{address}.
7827 The file format may optionally be specified
7828 (@option{bin}, @option{ihex}, or @option{elf})
7829 This perform a comparison using a CRC checksum only
7830 @end deffn
7831
7832
7833 @section Breakpoint and Watchpoint commands
7834 @cindex breakpoint
7835 @cindex watchpoint
7836
7837 CPUs often make debug modules accessible through JTAG, with
7838 hardware support for a handful of code breakpoints and data
7839 watchpoints.
7840 In addition, CPUs almost always support software breakpoints.
7841
7842 @deffn Command {bp} [address len [@option{hw}]]
7843 With no parameters, lists all active breakpoints.
7844 Else sets a breakpoint on code execution starting
7845 at @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7846 This is a software breakpoint, unless @option{hw} is specified
7847 in which case it will be a hardware breakpoint.
7848
7849 (@xref{arm9vectorcatch,,arm9 vector_catch}, or @pxref{xscalevectorcatch,,xscale vector_catch},
7850 for similar mechanisms that do not consume hardware breakpoints.)
7851 @end deffn
7852
7853 @deffn Command {rbp} address
7854 Remove the breakpoint at @var{address}.
7855 @end deffn
7856
7857 @deffn Command {rwp} address
7858 Remove data watchpoint on @var{address}
7859 @end deffn
7860
7861 @deffn Command {wp} [address len [(@option{r}|@option{w}|@option{a}) [value [mask]]]]
7862 With no parameters, lists all active watchpoints.
7863 Else sets a data watchpoint on data from @var{address} for @var{length} bytes.
7864 The watch point is an "access" watchpoint unless
7865 the @option{r} or @option{w} parameter is provided,
7866 defining it as respectively a read or write watchpoint.
7867 If a @var{value} is provided, that value is used when determining if
7868 the watchpoint should trigger. The value may be first be masked
7869 using @var{mask} to mark ``don't care'' fields.
7870 @end deffn
7871
7872 @section Misc Commands
7873
7874 @cindex profiling
7875 @deffn Command {profile} seconds filename [start end]
7876 Profiling samples the CPU's program counter as quickly as possible,
7877 which is useful for non-intrusive stochastic profiling.
7878 Saves up to 10000 samples in @file{filename} using ``gmon.out''
7879 format. Optional @option{start} and @option{end} parameters allow to
7880 limit the address range.
7881 @end deffn
7882
7883 @deffn Command {version}
7884 Displays a string identifying the version of this OpenOCD server.
7885 @end deffn
7886
7887 @deffn Command {virt2phys} virtual_address
7888 Requests the current target to map the specified @var{virtual_address}
7889 to its corresponding physical address, and displays the result.
7890 @end deffn
7891
7892 @node Architecture and Core Commands
7893 @chapter Architecture and Core Commands
7894 @cindex Architecture Specific Commands
7895 @cindex Core Specific Commands
7896
7897 Most CPUs have specialized JTAG operations to support debugging.
7898 OpenOCD packages most such operations in its standard command framework.
7899 Some of those operations don't fit well in that framework, so they are
7900 exposed here as architecture or implementation (core) specific commands.
7901
7902 @anchor{armhardwaretracing}
7903 @section ARM Hardware Tracing
7904 @cindex tracing
7905 @cindex ETM
7906 @cindex ETB
7907
7908 CPUs based on ARM cores may include standard tracing interfaces,
7909 based on an ``Embedded Trace Module'' (ETM) which sends voluminous
7910 address and data bus trace records to a ``Trace Port''.
7911
7912 @itemize
7913 @item
7914 Development-oriented boards will sometimes provide a high speed
7915 trace connector for collecting that data, when the particular CPU
7916 supports such an interface.
7917 (The standard connector is a 38-pin Mictor, with both JTAG
7918 and trace port support.)
7919 Those trace connectors are supported by higher end JTAG adapters
7920 and some logic analyzer modules; frequently those modules can
7921 buffer several megabytes of trace data.
7922 Configuring an ETM coupled to such an external trace port belongs
7923 in the board-specific configuration file.
7924 @item
7925 If the CPU doesn't provide an external interface, it probably
7926 has an ``Embedded Trace Buffer'' (ETB) on the chip, which is a
7927 dedicated SRAM. 4KBytes is one common ETB size.
7928 Configuring an ETM coupled only to an ETB belongs in the CPU-specific
7929 (target) configuration file, since it works the same on all boards.
7930 @end itemize
7931
7932 ETM support in OpenOCD doesn't seem to be widely used yet.
7933
7934 @quotation Issues
7935 ETM support may be buggy, and at least some @command{etm config}
7936 parameters should be detected by asking the ETM for them.
7937
7938 ETM trigger events could also implement a kind of complex
7939 hardware breakpoint, much more powerful than the simple
7940 watchpoint hardware exported by EmbeddedICE modules.
7941 @emph{Such breakpoints can be triggered even when using the
7942 dummy trace port driver}.
7943
7944 It seems like a GDB hookup should be possible,
7945 as well as tracing only during specific states
7946 (perhaps @emph{handling IRQ 23} or @emph{calls foo()}).
7947
7948 There should be GUI tools to manipulate saved trace data and help
7949 analyse it in conjunction with the source code.
7950 It's unclear how much of a common interface is shared
7951 with the current XScale trace support, or should be
7952 shared with eventual Nexus-style trace module support.
7953
7954 At this writing (November 2009) only ARM7, ARM9, and ARM11 support
7955 for ETM modules is available. The code should be able to
7956 work with some newer cores; but not all of them support
7957 this original style of JTAG access.
7958 @end quotation
7959
7960 @subsection ETM Configuration
7961 ETM setup is coupled with the trace port driver configuration.
7962
7963 @deffn {Config Command} {etm config} target width mode clocking driver
7964 Declares the ETM associated with @var{target}, and associates it
7965 with a given trace port @var{driver}. @xref{traceportdrivers,,Trace Port Drivers}.
7966
7967 Several of the parameters must reflect the trace port capabilities,
7968 which are a function of silicon capabilities (exposed later
7969 using @command{etm info}) and of what hardware is connected to
7970 that port (such as an external pod, or ETB).
7971 The @var{width} must be either 4, 8, or 16,
7972 except with ETMv3.0 and newer modules which may also
7973 support 1, 2, 24, 32, 48, and 64 bit widths.
7974 (With those versions, @command{etm info} also shows whether
7975 the selected port width and mode are supported.)
7976
7977 The @var{mode} must be @option{normal}, @option{multiplexed},
7978 or @option{demultiplexed}.
7979 The @var{clocking} must be @option{half} or @option{full}.
7980
7981 @quotation Warning
7982 With ETMv3.0 and newer, the bits set with the @var{mode} and
7983 @var{clocking} parameters both control the mode.
7984 This modified mode does not map to the values supported by
7985 previous ETM modules, so this syntax is subject to change.
7986 @end quotation
7987
7988 @quotation Note
7989 You can see the ETM registers using the @command{reg} command.
7990 Not all possible registers are present in every ETM.
7991 Most of the registers are write-only, and are used to configure
7992 what CPU activities are traced.
7993 @end quotation
7994 @end deffn
7995
7996 @deffn Command {etm info}
7997 Displays information about the current target's ETM.
7998 This includes resource counts from the @code{ETM_CONFIG} register,
7999 as well as silicon capabilities (except on rather old modules).
8000 from the @code{ETM_SYS_CONFIG} register.
8001 @end deffn
8002
8003 @deffn Command {etm status}
8004 Displays status of the current target's ETM and trace port driver:
8005 is the ETM idle, or is it collecting data?
8006 Did trace data overflow?
8007 Was it triggered?
8008 @end deffn
8009
8010 @deffn Command {etm tracemode} [type context_id_bits cycle_accurate branch_output]
8011 Displays what data that ETM will collect.
8012 If arguments are provided, first configures that data.
8013 When the configuration changes, tracing is stopped
8014 and any buffered trace data is invalidated.
8015
8016 @itemize
8017 @item @var{type} ... describing how data accesses are traced,
8018 when they pass any ViewData filtering that that was set up.
8019 The value is one of
8020 @option{none} (save nothing),
8021 @option{data} (save data),
8022 @option{address} (save addresses),
8023 @option{all} (save data and addresses)
8024 @item @var{context_id_bits} ... 0, 8, 16, or 32
8025 @item @var{cycle_accurate} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}
8026 cycle-accurate instruction tracing.
8027 Before ETMv3, enabling this causes much extra data to be recorded.
8028 @item @var{branch_output} ... @option{enable} or @option{disable}.
8029 Disable this unless you need to try reconstructing the instruction
8030 trace stream without an image of the code.
8031 @end itemize
8032 @end deffn
8033
8034 @deffn Command {etm trigger_debug} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
8035 Displays whether ETM triggering debug entry (like a breakpoint) is
8036 enabled or disabled, after optionally modifying that configuration.
8037 The default behaviour is @option{disable}.
8038 Any change takes effect after the next @command{etm start}.
8039
8040 By using script commands to configure ETM registers, you can make the
8041 processor enter debug state automatically when certain conditions,
8042 more complex than supported by the breakpoint hardware, happen.
8043 @end deffn
8044
8045 @subsection ETM Trace Operation
8046
8047 After setting up the ETM, you can use it to collect data.
8048 That data can be exported to files for later analysis.
8049 It can also be parsed with OpenOCD, for basic sanity checking.
8050
8051 To configure what is being traced, you will need to write
8052 various trace registers using @command{reg ETM_*} commands.
8053 For the definitions of these registers, read ARM publication
8054 @emph{IHI 0014, ``Embedded Trace Macrocell, Architecture Specification''}.
8055 Be aware that most of the relevant registers are write-only,
8056 and that ETM resources are limited. There are only a handful
8057 of address comparators, data comparators, counters, and so on.
8058
8059 Examples of scenarios you might arrange to trace include:
8060
8061 @itemize
8062 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{excluding} subroutines
8063 it calls. Use address range comparators to enable tracing
8064 for instruction access within that function's body.
8065 @item Code flow within a function, @emph{including} subroutines
8066 it calls. Use the sequencer and address comparators to activate
8067 tracing on an ``entered function'' state, then deactivate it by
8068 exiting that state when the function's exit code is invoked.
8069 @item Code flow starting at the fifth invocation of a function,
8070 combining one of the above models with a counter.
8071 @item CPU data accesses to the registers for a particular device,
8072 using address range comparators and the ViewData logic.
8073 @item Such data accesses only during IRQ handling, combining the above
8074 model with sequencer triggers which on entry and exit to the IRQ handler.
8075 @item @emph{... more}
8076 @end itemize
8077
8078 At this writing, September 2009, there are no Tcl utility
8079 procedures to help set up any common tracing scenarios.
8080
8081 @deffn Command {etm analyze}
8082 Reads trace data into memory, if it wasn't already present.
8083 Decodes and prints the data that was collected.
8084 @end deffn
8085
8086 @deffn Command {etm dump} filename
8087 Stores the captured trace data in @file{filename}.
8088 @end deffn
8089
8090 @deffn Command {etm image} filename [base_address] [type]
8091 Opens an image file.
8092 @end deffn
8093
8094 @deffn Command {etm load} filename
8095 Loads captured trace data from @file{filename}.
8096 @end deffn
8097
8098 @deffn Command {etm start}
8099 Starts trace data collection.
8100 @end deffn
8101
8102 @deffn Command {etm stop}
8103 Stops trace data collection.
8104 @end deffn
8105
8106 @anchor{traceportdrivers}
8107 @subsection Trace Port Drivers
8108
8109 To use an ETM trace port it must be associated with a driver.
8110
8111 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} dummy
8112 Use the @option{dummy} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8113 not connected to anything (on-chip ETB or off-chip trace connector).
8114 @emph{This driver lets OpenOCD talk to the ETM, but it does not expose
8115 any trace data collection.}
8116 @deffn {Config Command} {etm_dummy config} target
8117 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a dummy driver.
8118 @end deffn
8119 @end deffn
8120
8121 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} etb
8122 Use the @option{etb} driver if you are configuring an ETM
8123 to use on-chip ETB memory.
8124 @deffn {Config Command} {etb config} target etb_tap
8125 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with the ETB at @var{etb_tap}.
8126 You can see the ETB registers using the @command{reg} command.
8127 @end deffn
8128 @deffn Command {etb trigger_percent} [percent]
8129 This displays, or optionally changes, ETB behavior after the
8130 ETM's configured @emph{trigger} event fires.
8131 It controls how much more trace data is saved after the (single)
8132 trace trigger becomes active.
8133
8134 @itemize
8135 @item The default corresponds to @emph{trace around} usage,
8136 recording 50 percent data before the event and the rest
8137 afterwards.
8138 @item The minimum value of @var{percent} is 2 percent,
8139 recording almost exclusively data before the trigger.
8140 Such extreme @emph{trace before} usage can help figure out
8141 what caused that event to happen.
8142 @item The maximum value of @var{percent} is 100 percent,
8143 recording data almost exclusively after the event.
8144 This extreme @emph{trace after} usage might help sort out
8145 how the event caused trouble.
8146 @end itemize
8147 @c REVISIT allow "break" too -- enter debug mode.
8148 @end deffn
8149
8150 @end deffn
8151
8152 @deffn {Trace Port Driver} oocd_trace
8153 This driver isn't available unless OpenOCD was explicitly configured
8154 with the @option{--enable-oocd_trace} option. You probably don't want
8155 to configure it unless you've built the appropriate prototype hardware;
8156 it's @emph{proof-of-concept} software.
8157
8158 Use the @option{oocd_trace} driver if you are configuring an ETM that's
8159 connected to an off-chip trace connector.
8160
8161 @deffn {Config Command} {oocd_trace config} target tty
8162 Associates the ETM for @var{target} with a trace driver which
8163 collects data through the serial port @var{tty}.
8164 @end deffn
8165
8166 @deffn Command {oocd_trace resync}
8167 Re-synchronizes with the capture clock.
8168 @end deffn
8169
8170 @deffn Command {oocd_trace status}
8171 Reports whether the capture clock is locked or not.
8172 @end deffn
8173 @end deffn
8174
8175 @anchor{armcrosstrigger}
8176 @section ARM Cross-Trigger Interface
8177 @cindex CTI
8178
8179 The ARM Cross-Trigger Interface (CTI) is a generic CoreSight component
8180 that connects event sources like tracing components or CPU cores with each
8181 other through a common trigger matrix (CTM). For ARMv8 architecture, a
8182 CTI is mandatory for core run control and each core has an individual
8183 CTI instance attached to it. OpenOCD has limited support for CTI using
8184 the @emph{cti} group of commands.
8185
8186 @deffn Command {cti create} cti_name @option{-dap} dap_name @option{-ap-num} apn @option{-ctibase} base_address
8187 Creates a CTI instance @var{cti_name} on the DAP instance @var{dap_name} on MEM-AP
8188 @var{apn}. The @var{base_address} must match the base address of the CTI
8189 on the respective MEM-AP. All arguments are mandatory. This creates a
8190 new command @command{$cti_name} which is used for various purposes
8191 including additional configuration.
8192 @end deffn
8193
8194 @deffn Command {$cti_name enable} @option{on|off}
8195 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the CTI.
8196 @end deffn
8197
8198 @deffn Command {$cti_name dump}
8199 Displays a register dump of the CTI.
8200 @end deffn
8201
8202 @deffn Command {$cti_name write } @var{reg_name} @var{value}
8203 Write @var{value} to the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8204 @end deffn
8205
8206 @deffn Command {$cti_name read} @var{reg_name}
8207 Print the value read from the CTI register with the symbolic name @var{reg_name}.
8208 @end deffn
8209
8210 @deffn Command {$cti_name testmode} @option{on|off}
8211 Enable (@option{on}) or disable (@option{off}) the integration test mode
8212 of the CTI.
8213 @end deffn
8214
8215 @deffn Command {cti names}
8216 Prints a list of names of all CTI objects created. This command is mainly
8217 useful in TCL scripting.
8218 @end deffn
8219
8220 @section Generic ARM
8221 @cindex ARM
8222
8223 These commands should be available on all ARM processors.
8224 They are available in addition to other core-specific
8225 commands that may be available.
8226
8227 @deffn Command {arm core_state} [@option{arm}|@option{thumb}]
8228 Displays the core_state, optionally changing it to process
8229 either @option{arm} or @option{thumb} instructions.
8230 The target may later be resumed in the currently set core_state.
8231 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8232 that is not currently supported in OpenOCD.)
8233 @end deffn
8234
8235 @deffn Command {arm disassemble} address [count [@option{thumb}]]
8236 @cindex disassemble
8237 Disassembles @var{count} instructions starting at @var{address}.
8238 If @var{count} is not specified, a single instruction is disassembled.
8239 If @option{thumb} is specified, or the low bit of the address is set,
8240 Thumb2 (mixed 16/32-bit) instructions are used;
8241 else ARM (32-bit) instructions are used.
8242 (Processors may also support the Jazelle state, but
8243 those instructions are not currently understood by OpenOCD.)
8244
8245 Note that all Thumb instructions are Thumb2 instructions,
8246 so older processors (without Thumb2 support) will still
8247 see correct disassembly of Thumb code.
8248 Also, ThumbEE opcodes are the same as Thumb2,
8249 with a handful of exceptions.
8250 ThumbEE disassembly currently has no explicit support.
8251 @end deffn
8252
8253 @deffn Command {arm mcr} pX op1 CRn CRm op2 value
8254 Write @var{value} to a coprocessor @var{pX} register
8255 passing parameters @var{CRn},
8256 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8257 and using the MCR instruction.
8258 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8259 an ARM register.)
8260 @end deffn
8261
8262 @deffn Command {arm mrc} pX coproc op1 CRn CRm op2
8263 Read a coprocessor @var{pX} register passing parameters @var{CRn},
8264 @var{CRm}, opcodes @var{opc1} and @var{opc2},
8265 and the MRC instruction.
8266 Returns the result so it can be manipulated by Jim scripts.
8267 (Parameter sequence matches the ARM instruction, but omits
8268 an ARM register.)
8269 @end deffn
8270
8271 @deffn Command {arm reg}
8272 Display a table of all banked core registers, fetching the current value from every
8273 core mode if necessary.
8274 @end deffn
8275
8276 @deffn Command {arm semihosting} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8277 @cindex ARM semihosting
8278 Display status of semihosting, after optionally changing that status.
8279
8280 Semihosting allows for code executing on an ARM target to use the
8281 I/O facilities on the host computer i.e. the system where OpenOCD
8282 is running. The target application must be linked against a library
8283 implementing the ARM semihosting convention that forwards operation
8284 requests by using a special SVC instruction that is trapped at the
8285 Supervisor Call vector by OpenOCD.
8286 @end deffn
8287
8288 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_cmdline} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8289 @cindex ARM semihosting
8290 Set the command line to be passed to the debugger.
8291
8292 @example
8293 arm semihosting_cmdline argv0 argv1 argv2 ...
8294 @end example
8295
8296 This option lets one set the command line arguments to be passed to
8297 the program. The first argument (argv0) is the program name in a
8298 standard C environment (argv[0]). Depending on the program (not much
8299 programs look at argv[0]), argv0 is ignored and can be any string.
8300 @end deffn
8301
8302 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_fileio} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8303 @cindex ARM semihosting
8304 Display status of semihosting fileio, after optionally changing that
8305 status.
8306
8307 Enabling this option forwards semihosting I/O to GDB process using the
8308 File-I/O remote protocol extension. This is especially useful for
8309 interacting with remote files or displaying console messages in the
8310 debugger.
8311 @end deffn
8312
8313 @deffn Command {arm semihosting_resexit} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8314 @cindex ARM semihosting
8315 Enable resumable SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT.
8316
8317 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called outside a debug session,
8318 things are simple, the openocd process calls exit() and passes
8319 the value returned by the target.
8320
8321 When SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT is called during a debug session,
8322 by default execution returns to the debugger, leaving the
8323 debugger in a HALT state, similar to the state entered when
8324 encountering a break.
8325
8326 In some use cases, it is useful to have SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT
8327 return normally, as any semihosting call, and do not break
8328 to the debugger.
8329 The standard allows this to happen, but the condition
8330 to trigger it is a bit obscure ("by performing an RDI_Execute
8331 request or equivalent").
8332
8333 To make the SEMIHOSTING_SYS_EXIT call return normally, enable
8334 this option (default: disabled).
8335 @end deffn
8336
8337 @section ARMv4 and ARMv5 Architecture
8338 @cindex ARMv4
8339 @cindex ARMv5
8340
8341 The ARMv4 and ARMv5 architectures are widely used in embedded systems,
8342 and introduced core parts of the instruction set in use today.
8343 That includes the Thumb instruction set, introduced in the ARMv4T
8344 variant.
8345
8346 @subsection ARM7 and ARM9 specific commands
8347 @cindex ARM7
8348 @cindex ARM9
8349
8350 These commands are specific to ARM7 and ARM9 cores, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T,
8351 ARM9TDMI, ARM920T or ARM926EJ-S.
8352 They are available in addition to the ARM commands,
8353 and any other core-specific commands that may be available.
8354
8355 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dbgrq} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8356 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the
8357 the EmbeddedIce DBGRQ signal to force entry into debug mode,
8358 instead of breakpoints.
8359 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8360
8361 This should be
8362 safe for all but ARM7TDMI-S cores (like NXP LPC).
8363 This feature is enabled by default on most ARM9 cores,
8364 including ARM9TDMI, ARM920T, and ARM926EJ-S.
8365 @end deffn
8366
8367 @deffn Command {arm7_9 dcc_downloads} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8368 @cindex DCC
8369 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of the debug communications
8370 channel (DCC) to write larger (>128 byte) amounts of memory.
8371 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8372
8373 DCC downloads offer a huge speed increase, but might be
8374 unsafe, especially with targets running at very low speeds. This command was introduced
8375 with OpenOCD rev. 60, and requires a few bytes of working area.
8376 @end deffn
8377
8378 @deffn Command {arm7_9 fast_memory_access} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8379 Displays the value of the flag controlling use of memory writes and reads
8380 that don't check completion of the operation.
8381 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8382
8383 This provides a huge speed increase, especially with USB JTAG
8384 cables (FT2232), but might be unsafe if used with targets running at very low
8385 speeds, like the 32kHz startup clock of an AT91RM9200.
8386 @end deffn
8387
8388 @subsection ARM720T specific commands
8389 @cindex ARM720T
8390
8391 These commands are available to ARM720T based CPUs,
8392 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8393 based on the ARM7TDMI-S integer core.
8394 They are available in addition to the ARM and ARM7/ARM9 commands.
8395
8396 @deffn Command {arm720t cp15} opcode [value]
8397 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8398 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8399
8400 Display cp15 register returned by the ARM instruction @var{opcode};
8401 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8402 The @var{opcode} should be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction.
8403 @end deffn
8404
8405 @subsection ARM9 specific commands
8406 @cindex ARM9
8407
8408 ARM9-family cores are built around ARM9TDMI or ARM9E (including ARM9EJS)
8409 integer processors.
8410 Such cores include the ARM920T, ARM926EJ-S, and ARM966.
8411
8412 @c 9-june-2009: tried this on arm920t, it didn't work.
8413 @c no-params always lists nothing caught, and that's how it acts.
8414 @c 23-oct-2009: doesn't work _consistently_ ... as if the ICE
8415 @c versions have different rules about when they commit writes.
8416
8417 @anchor{arm9vectorcatch}
8418 @deffn Command {arm9 vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8419 @cindex vector_catch
8420 Vector Catch hardware provides a sort of dedicated breakpoint
8421 for hardware events such as reset, interrupt, and abort.
8422 You can use this to conserve normal breakpoint resources,
8423 so long as you're not concerned with code that branches directly
8424 to those hardware vectors.
8425
8426 This always finishes by listing the current configuration.
8427 If parameters are provided, it first reconfigures the
8428 vector catch hardware to intercept
8429 @option{all} of the hardware vectors,
8430 @option{none} of them,
8431 or a list with one or more of the following:
8432 @option{reset} @option{undef} @option{swi} @option{pabt} @option{dabt}
8433 @option{irq} @option{fiq}.
8434 @end deffn
8435
8436 @subsection ARM920T specific commands
8437 @cindex ARM920T
8438
8439 These commands are available to ARM920T based CPUs,
8440 which are implementations of the ARMv4T architecture
8441 built using the ARM9TDMI integer core.
8442 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8443 and ARM9 commands.
8444
8445 @deffn Command {arm920t cache_info}
8446 Print information about the caches found. This allows to see whether your target
8447 is an ARM920T (2x16kByte cache) or ARM922T (2x8kByte cache).
8448 @end deffn
8449
8450 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15} regnum [value]
8451 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8452 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8453 This uses "physical access" and the register number is as
8454 shown in bits 38..33 of table 9-9 in the ARM920T TRM.
8455 (Not all registers can be written.)
8456 @end deffn
8457
8458 @deffn Command {arm920t cp15i} opcode [value [address]]
8459 @emph{DEPRECATED -- avoid using this.
8460 Use the @command{arm mrc} or @command{arm mcr} commands instead.}
8461
8462 Interpreted access using ARM instruction @var{opcode}, which should
8463 be the value of either an MRC or MCR instruction
8464 (as shown tables 9-11, 9-12, and 9-13 in the ARM920T TRM).
8465 If no @var{value} is provided, the result is displayed.
8466 Else if that value is written using the specified @var{address},
8467 or using zero if no other address is provided.
8468 @end deffn
8469
8470 @deffn Command {arm920t read_cache} filename
8471 Dump the content of ICache and DCache to a file named @file{filename}.
8472 @end deffn
8473
8474 @deffn Command {arm920t read_mmu} filename
8475 Dump the content of the ITLB and DTLB to a file named @file{filename}.
8476 @end deffn
8477
8478 @subsection ARM926ej-s specific commands
8479 @cindex ARM926ej-s
8480
8481 These commands are available to ARM926ej-s based CPUs,
8482 which are implementations of the ARMv5TEJ architecture
8483 based on the ARM9EJ-S integer core.
8484 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8485 and ARM9 commands.
8486
8487 The Feroceon cores also support these commands, although
8488 they are not built from ARM926ej-s designs.
8489
8490 @deffn Command {arm926ejs cache_info}
8491 Print information about the caches found.
8492 @end deffn
8493
8494 @subsection ARM966E specific commands
8495 @cindex ARM966E
8496
8497 These commands are available to ARM966 based CPUs,
8498 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8499 They are available in addition to the ARM, ARM7/ARM9,
8500 and ARM9 commands.
8501
8502 @deffn Command {arm966e cp15} regnum [value]
8503 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8504 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8505 The six bit @var{regnum} values are bits 37..32 from table 7-2 of the
8506 ARM966E-S TRM.
8507 There is no current control over bits 31..30 from that table,
8508 as required for BIST support.
8509 @end deffn
8510
8511 @subsection XScale specific commands
8512 @cindex XScale
8513
8514 Some notes about the debug implementation on the XScale CPUs:
8515
8516 The XScale CPU provides a special debug-only mini-instruction cache
8517 (mini-IC) in which exception vectors and target-resident debug handler
8518 code are placed by OpenOCD. In order to get access to the CPU, OpenOCD
8519 must point vector 0 (the reset vector) to the entry of the debug
8520 handler. However, this means that the complete first cacheline in the
8521 mini-IC is marked valid, which makes the CPU fetch all exception
8522 handlers from the mini-IC, ignoring the code in RAM.
8523
8524 To address this situation, OpenOCD provides the @code{xscale
8525 vector_table} command, which allows the user to explicitly write
8526 individual entries to either the high or low vector table stored in
8527 the mini-IC.
8528
8529 It is recommended to place a pc-relative indirect branch in the vector
8530 table, and put the branch destination somewhere in memory. Doing so
8531 makes sure the code in the vector table stays constant regardless of
8532 code layout in memory:
8533 @example
8534 _vectors:
8535 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8536 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8537 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8538 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8539 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8540 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8541 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8542 ldr pc,[pc,#0x100-8]
8543 .org 0x100
8544 .long real_reset_vector
8545 .long real_ui_handler
8546 .long real_swi_handler
8547 .long real_pf_abort
8548 .long real_data_abort
8549 .long 0 /* unused */
8550 .long real_irq_handler
8551 .long real_fiq_handler
8552 @end example
8553
8554 Alternatively, you may choose to keep some or all of the mini-IC
8555 vector table entries synced with those written to memory by your
8556 system software. The mini-IC can not be modified while the processor
8557 is executing, but for each vector table entry not previously defined
8558 using the @code{xscale vector_table} command, OpenOCD will copy the
8559 value from memory to the mini-IC every time execution resumes from a
8560 halt. This is done for both high and low vector tables (although the
8561 table not in use may not be mapped to valid memory, and in this case
8562 that copy operation will silently fail). This means that you will
8563 need to briefly halt execution at some strategic point during system
8564 start-up; e.g., after the software has initialized the vector table,
8565 but before exceptions are enabled. A breakpoint can be used to
8566 accomplish this once the appropriate location in the start-up code has
8567 been identified. A watchpoint over the vector table region is helpful
8568 in finding the location if you're not sure. Note that the same
8569 situation exists any time the vector table is modified by the system
8570 software.
8571
8572 The debug handler must be placed somewhere in the address space using
8573 the @code{xscale debug_handler} command. The allowed locations for the
8574 debug handler are either (0x800 - 0x1fef800) or (0xfe000800 -
8575 0xfffff800). The default value is 0xfe000800.
8576
8577 XScale has resources to support two hardware breakpoints and two
8578 watchpoints. However, the following restrictions on watchpoint
8579 functionality apply: (1) the value and mask arguments to the @code{wp}
8580 command are not supported, (2) the watchpoint length must be a
8581 power of two and not less than four, and can not be greater than the
8582 watchpoint address, and (3) a watchpoint with a length greater than
8583 four consumes all the watchpoint hardware resources. This means that
8584 at any one time, you can have enabled either two watchpoints with a
8585 length of four, or one watchpoint with a length greater than four.
8586
8587 These commands are available to XScale based CPUs,
8588 which are implementations of the ARMv5TE architecture.
8589
8590 @deffn Command {xscale analyze_trace}
8591 Displays the contents of the trace buffer.
8592 @end deffn
8593
8594 @deffn Command {xscale cache_clean_address} address
8595 Changes the address used when cleaning the data cache.
8596 @end deffn
8597
8598 @deffn Command {xscale cache_info}
8599 Displays information about the CPU caches.
8600 @end deffn
8601
8602 @deffn Command {xscale cp15} regnum [value]
8603 Display cp15 register @var{regnum};
8604 else if a @var{value} is provided, that value is written to that register.
8605 @end deffn
8606
8607 @deffn Command {xscale debug_handler} target address
8608 Changes the address used for the specified target's debug handler.
8609 @end deffn
8610
8611 @deffn Command {xscale dcache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8612 Enables or disable the CPU's data cache.
8613 @end deffn
8614
8615 @deffn Command {xscale dump_trace} filename
8616 Dumps the raw contents of the trace buffer to @file{filename}.
8617 @end deffn
8618
8619 @deffn Command {xscale icache} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8620 Enables or disable the CPU's instruction cache.
8621 @end deffn
8622
8623 @deffn Command {xscale mmu} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8624 Enables or disable the CPU's memory management unit.
8625 @end deffn
8626
8627 @deffn Command {xscale trace_buffer} [@option{enable}|@option{disable} [@option{fill} [n] | @option{wrap}]]
8628 Displays the trace buffer status, after optionally
8629 enabling or disabling the trace buffer
8630 and modifying how it is emptied.
8631 @end deffn
8632
8633 @deffn Command {xscale trace_image} filename [offset [type]]
8634 Opens a trace image from @file{filename}, optionally rebasing
8635 its segment addresses by @var{offset}.
8636 The image @var{type} may be one of
8637 @option{bin} (binary), @option{ihex} (Intel hex),
8638 @option{elf} (ELF file), @option{s19} (Motorola s19),
8639 @option{mem}, or @option{builder}.
8640 @end deffn
8641
8642 @anchor{xscalevectorcatch}
8643 @deffn Command {xscale vector_catch} [mask]
8644 @cindex vector_catch
8645 Display a bitmask showing the hardware vectors to catch.
8646 If the optional parameter is provided, first set the bitmask to that value.
8647
8648 The mask bits correspond with bit 16..23 in the DCSR:
8649 @example
8650 0x01 Trap Reset
8651 0x02 Trap Undefined Instructions
8652 0x04 Trap Software Interrupt
8653 0x08 Trap Prefetch Abort
8654 0x10 Trap Data Abort
8655 0x20 reserved
8656 0x40 Trap IRQ
8657 0x80 Trap FIQ
8658 @end example
8659 @end deffn
8660
8661 @deffn Command {xscale vector_table} [(@option{low}|@option{high}) index value]
8662 @cindex vector_table
8663
8664 Set an entry in the mini-IC vector table. There are two tables: one for
8665 low vectors (at 0x00000000), and one for high vectors (0xFFFF0000), each
8666 holding the 8 exception vectors. @var{index} can be 1-7, because vector 0
8667 points to the debug handler entry and can not be overwritten.
8668 @var{value} holds the 32-bit opcode that is placed in the mini-IC.
8669
8670 Without arguments, the current settings are displayed.
8671
8672 @end deffn
8673
8674 @section ARMv6 Architecture
8675 @cindex ARMv6
8676
8677 @subsection ARM11 specific commands
8678 @cindex ARM11
8679
8680 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite burst} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8681 Displays the value of the memwrite burst-enable flag,
8682 which is enabled by default.
8683 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8684 Burst writes are only used for memory writes larger than 1 word.
8685 They improve performance by assuming that the CPU has read each data
8686 word over JTAG and completed its write before the next word arrives,
8687 instead of polling for a status flag to verify that completion.
8688 This is usually safe, because JTAG runs much slower than the CPU.
8689 @end deffn
8690
8691 @deffn Command {arm11 memwrite error_fatal} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8692 Displays the value of the memwrite error_fatal flag,
8693 which is enabled by default.
8694 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that flag.
8695 When set, certain memory write errors cause earlier transfer termination.
8696 @end deffn
8697
8698 @deffn Command {arm11 step_irq_enable} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}]
8699 Displays the value of the flag controlling whether
8700 IRQs are enabled during single stepping;
8701 they are disabled by default.
8702 If a boolean parameter is provided, first assigns that.
8703 @end deffn
8704
8705 @deffn Command {arm11 vcr} [value]
8706 @cindex vector_catch
8707 Displays the value of the @emph{Vector Catch Register (VCR)},
8708 coprocessor 14 register 7.
8709 If @var{value} is defined, first assigns that.
8710
8711 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8712 for certain hardware events.
8713 The specific bit values are core-specific (as in fact is using
8714 coprocessor 14 register 7 itself) but all current ARM11
8715 cores @emph{except the ARM1176} use the same six bits.
8716 @end deffn
8717
8718 @section ARMv7 and ARMv8 Architecture
8719 @cindex ARMv7
8720 @cindex ARMv8
8721
8722 @subsection ARMv7-A specific commands
8723 @cindex Cortex-A
8724
8725 @deffn Command {cortex_a cache_info}
8726 display information about target caches
8727 @end deffn
8728
8729 @deffn Command {cortex_a dacrfixup [@option{on}|@option{off}]}
8730 Work around issues with software breakpoints when the program text is
8731 mapped read-only by the operating system. This option sets the CP15 DACR
8732 to "all-manager" to bypass MMU permission checks on memory access.
8733 Defaults to 'off'.
8734 @end deffn
8735
8736 @deffn Command {cortex_a dbginit}
8737 Initialize core debug
8738 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8739 @end deffn
8740
8741 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_off}
8742 Disable SMP mode
8743 @end deffn
8744
8745 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_on}
8746 Enable SMP mode
8747 @end deffn
8748
8749 @deffn Command {cortex_a smp_gdb} [core_id]
8750 Display/set the current core displayed in GDB
8751 @end deffn
8752
8753 @deffn Command {cortex_a maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8754 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8755 @end deffn
8756
8757 @deffn Command {cache_config l2x} [base way]
8758 configure l2x cache
8759 @end deffn
8760
8761
8762 @subsection ARMv7-R specific commands
8763 @cindex Cortex-R
8764
8765 @deffn Command {cortex_r dbginit}
8766 Initialize core debug
8767 Enables debug by unlocking the Software Lock and clearing sticky powerdown indications
8768 @end deffn
8769
8770 @deffn Command {cortex_r maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8771 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping
8772 @end deffn
8773
8774
8775 @subsection ARMv7-M specific commands
8776 @cindex tracing
8777 @cindex SWO
8778 @cindex SWV
8779 @cindex TPIU
8780 @cindex ITM
8781 @cindex ETM
8782
8783 @deffn Command {tpiu config} (@option{disable} | ((@option{external} | @option{internal (@var{filename} | -)}) @
8784 (@option{sync @var{port_width}} | ((@option{manchester} | @option{uart}) @var{formatter_enable})) @
8785 @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} [@var{trace_freq}]))
8786
8787 ARMv7-M architecture provides several modules to generate debugging
8788 information internally (ITM, DWT and ETM). Their output is directed
8789 through TPIU to be captured externally either on an SWO pin (this
8790 configuration is called SWV) or on a synchronous parallel trace port.
8791
8792 This command configures the TPIU module of the target and, if internal
8793 capture mode is selected, starts to capture trace output by using the
8794 debugger adapter features.
8795
8796 Some targets require additional actions to be performed in the
8797 @b{trace-config} handler for trace port to be activated.
8798
8799 Command options:
8800 @itemize @minus
8801 @item @option{disable} disable TPIU handling;
8802 @item @option{external} configure TPIU to let user capture trace
8803 output externally (with an additional UART or logic analyzer hardware);
8804 @item @option{internal @var{filename}} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8805 gather trace data and append it to @var{filename} (which can be
8806 either a regular file or a named pipe);
8807 @item @option{internal -} configure TPIU and debug adapter to
8808 gather trace data, but not write to any file. Useful in conjunction with the @command{tcl_trace} command;
8809 @item @option{sync @var{port_width}} use synchronous parallel trace output
8810 mode, and set port width to @var{port_width};
8811 @item @option{manchester} use asynchronous SWO mode with Manchester
8812 coding;
8813 @item @option{uart} use asynchronous SWO mode with NRZ (same as
8814 regular UART 8N1) coding;
8815 @item @var{formatter_enable} is @option{on} or @option{off} to enable
8816 or disable TPIU formatter which needs to be used when both ITM and ETM
8817 data is to be output via SWO;
8818 @item @var{TRACECLKIN_freq} this should be specified to match target's
8819 current TRACECLKIN frequency (usually the same as HCLK);
8820 @item @var{trace_freq} trace port frequency. Can be omitted in
8821 internal mode to let the adapter driver select the maximum supported
8822 rate automatically.
8823 @end itemize
8824
8825 Example usage:
8826 @enumerate
8827 @item STM32L152 board is programmed with an application that configures
8828 PLL to provide core clock with 24MHz frequency; to use ITM output it's
8829 enough to:
8830 @example
8831 #include <libopencm3/cm3/itm.h>
8832 ...
8833 ITM_STIM8(0) = c;
8834 ...
8835 @end example
8836 (the most obvious way is to use the first stimulus port for printf,
8837 for that this ITM_STIM8 assignment can be used inside _write(); to make it
8838 blocking to avoid data loss, add @code{while (!(ITM_STIM8(0) &
8839 ITM_STIM_FIFOREADY));});
8840 @item An FT2232H UART is connected to the SWO pin of the board;
8841 @item Commands to configure UART for 12MHz baud rate:
8842 @example
8843 $ setserial /dev/ttyUSB1 spd_cust divisor 5
8844 $ stty -F /dev/ttyUSB1 38400
8845 @end example
8846 (FT2232H's base frequency is 60MHz, spd_cust allows to alias 38400
8847 baud with our custom divisor to get 12MHz)
8848 @item @code{itmdump -f /dev/ttyUSB1 -d1}
8849 @item OpenOCD invocation line:
8850 @example
8851 openocd -f interface/stlink.cfg \
8852 -c "transport select hla_swd" \
8853 -f target/stm32l1.cfg \
8854 -c "tpiu config external uart off 24000000 12000000"
8855 @end example
8856 @end enumerate
8857 @end deffn
8858
8859 @deffn Command {itm port} @var{port} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8860 Enable or disable trace output for ITM stimulus @var{port} (counting
8861 from 0). Port 0 is enabled on target creation automatically.
8862 @end deffn
8863
8864 @deffn Command {itm ports} (@option{0}|@option{1}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8865 Enable or disable trace output for all ITM stimulus ports.
8866 @end deffn
8867
8868 @subsection Cortex-M specific commands
8869 @cindex Cortex-M
8870
8871 @deffn Command {cortex_m maskisr} (@option{auto}|@option{on}|@option{off})
8872 Control masking (disabling) interrupts during target step/resume.
8873
8874 The @option{auto} option handles interrupts during stepping in a way that they
8875 get served but don't disturb the program flow. The step command first allows
8876 pending interrupt handlers to execute, then disables interrupts and steps over
8877 the next instruction where the core was halted. After the step interrupts
8878 are enabled again. If the interrupt handlers don't complete within 500ms,
8879 the step command leaves with the core running.
8880
8881 Note that a free hardware (FPB) breakpoint is required for the @option{auto}
8882 option. If no breakpoint is available at the time of the step, then the step
8883 is taken with interrupts enabled, i.e. the same way the @option{off} option
8884 does.
8885
8886 Default is @option{auto}.
8887 @end deffn
8888
8889 @deffn Command {cortex_m vector_catch} [@option{all}|@option{none}|list]
8890 @cindex vector_catch
8891 Vector Catch hardware provides dedicated breakpoints
8892 for certain hardware events.
8893
8894 Parameters request interception of
8895 @option{all} of these hardware event vectors,
8896 @option{none} of them,
8897 or one or more of the following:
8898 @option{hard_err} for a HardFault exception;
8899 @option{mm_err} for a MemManage exception;
8900 @option{bus_err} for a BusFault exception;
8901 @option{irq_err},
8902 @option{state_err},
8903 @option{chk_err}, or
8904 @option{nocp_err} for various UsageFault exceptions; or
8905 @option{reset}.
8906 If NVIC setup code does not enable them,
8907 MemManage, BusFault, and UsageFault exceptions
8908 are mapped to HardFault.
8909 UsageFault checks for
8910 divide-by-zero and unaligned access
8911 must also be explicitly enabled.
8912
8913 This finishes by listing the current vector catch configuration.
8914 @end deffn
8915
8916 @deffn Command {cortex_m reset_config} (@option{srst}|@option{sysresetreq}|@option{vectreset})
8917 Control reset handling. The default @option{srst} is to use srst if fitted,
8918 otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8919 @itemize @minus
8920 @item @option{srst} use hardware srst if fitted otherwise fallback to @option{vectreset}.
8921 @item @option{sysresetreq} use NVIC SYSRESETREQ to reset system.
8922 @item @option{vectreset} use NVIC VECTRESET to reset system.
8923 @end itemize
8924 Using @option{vectreset} is a safe option for all current Cortex-M cores.
8925 This however has the disadvantage of only resetting the core, all peripherals
8926 are unaffected. A solution would be to use a @code{reset-init} event handler to manually reset
8927 the peripherals.
8928 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
8929 @end deffn
8930
8931 @subsection ARMv8-A specific commands
8932 @cindex ARMv8-A
8933 @cindex aarch64
8934
8935 @deffn Command {aarch64 cache_info}
8936 Display information about target caches
8937 @end deffn
8938
8939 @deffn Command {aarch64 dbginit}
8940 This command enables debugging by clearing the OS Lock and sticky power-down and reset
8941 indications. It also establishes the expected, basic cross-trigger configuration the aarch64
8942 target code relies on. In a configuration file, the command would typically be called from a
8943 @code{reset-end} or @code{reset-deassert-post} handler, to re-enable debugging after a system reset.
8944 However, normally it is not necessary to use the command at all.
8945 @end deffn
8946
8947 @deffn Command {aarch64 smp_on|smp_off}
8948 Enable and disable SMP handling. The state of SMP handling influences the way targets in an SMP group
8949 are handled by the run control. With SMP handling enabled, issuing halt or resume to one core will trigger
8950 halting or resuming of all cores in the group. The command @code{target smp} defines which targets are in the SMP
8951 group. With SMP handling disabled, all targets need to be treated individually.
8952 @end deffn
8953
8954 @deffn Command {aarch64 maskisr} [@option{on}|@option{off}]
8955 Selects whether interrupts will be processed when single stepping. The default configuration is
8956 @option{on}.
8957 @end deffn
8958
8959 @section EnSilica eSi-RISC Architecture
8960
8961 eSi-RISC is a highly configurable microprocessor architecture for embedded systems
8962 provided by EnSilica. (See: @url{http://www.ensilica.com/risc-ip/}.)
8963
8964 @subsection esirisc specific commands
8965 @deffn Command {esirisc cache_arch} (@option{harvard}|@option{von_neumann})
8966 Configure the caching architecture. Targets with the @code{UNIFIED_ADDRESS_SPACE}
8967 option disabled employ a Harvard architecture. By default, @option{von_neumann} is assumed.
8968 @end deffn
8969
8970 @deffn Command {esirisc flush_caches}
8971 Flush instruction and data caches. This command requires that the target is halted
8972 when the command is issued and configured with an instruction or data cache.
8973 @end deffn
8974
8975 @deffn Command {esirisc hwdc} (@option{all}|@option{none}|mask ...)
8976 Configure hardware debug control. The HWDC register controls which exceptions return
8977 control back to the debugger. Possible masks are @option{all}, @option{none},
8978 @option{reset}, @option{interrupt}, @option{syscall}, @option{error}, and @option{debug}.
8979 By default, @option{reset}, @option{error}, and @option{debug} are enabled.
8980 @end deffn
8981
8982 @section Intel Architecture
8983
8984 Intel Quark X10xx is the first product in the Quark family of SoCs. It is an IA-32
8985 (Pentium x86 ISA) compatible SoC. The core CPU in the X10xx is codenamed Lakemont.
8986 Lakemont version 1 (LMT1) is used in X10xx. The CPU TAP (Lakemont TAP) is used for
8987 software debug and the CLTAP is used for SoC level operations.
8988 Useful docs are here: https://communities.intel.com/community/makers/documentation
8989 @itemize
8990 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 OpenOCD/GDB/Eclipse App Note (web search for doc num 330015)
8991 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Debug Operations User Guide (web search for doc num 329866)
8992 @item Intel Quark SoC X1000 Datasheet (web search for doc num 329676)
8993 @end itemize
8994
8995 @subsection x86 32-bit specific commands
8996 The three main address spaces for x86 are memory, I/O and configuration space.
8997 These commands allow a user to read and write to the 64Kbyte I/O address space.
8998
8999 @deffn Command {x86_32 idw} address
9000 Display the contents of a 32-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9001 @end deffn
9002
9003 @deffn Command {x86_32 idh} address
9004 Display the contents of a 16-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9005 @end deffn
9006
9007 @deffn Command {x86_32 idb} address
9008 Display the contents of a 8-bit I/O port from address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9009 @end deffn
9010
9011 @deffn Command {x86_32 iww} address
9012 Write the contents of a 32-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9013 @end deffn
9014
9015 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwh} address
9016 Write the contents of a 16-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9017 @end deffn
9018
9019 @deffn Command {x86_32 iwb} address
9020 Write the contents of a 8-bit I/O port to address range 0x0000 - 0xffff.
9021 @end deffn
9022
9023 @section OpenRISC Architecture
9024
9025 The OpenRISC CPU is a soft core. It is used in a programmable SoC which can be
9026 configured with any of the TAP / Debug Unit available.
9027
9028 @subsection TAP and Debug Unit selection commands
9029 @deffn Command {tap_select} (@option{vjtag}|@option{mohor}|@option{xilinx_bscan})
9030 Select between the Altera Virtual JTAG , Xilinx Virtual JTAG and Mohor TAP.
9031 @end deffn
9032 @deffn Command {du_select} (@option{adv}|@option{mohor}) [option]
9033 Select between the Advanced Debug Interface and the classic one.
9034
9035 An option can be passed as a second argument to the debug unit.
9036
9037 When using the Advanced Debug Interface, option = 1 means the RTL core is
9038 configured with ADBG_USE_HISPEED = 1. This configuration skips status checking
9039 between bytes while doing read or write bursts.
9040 @end deffn
9041
9042 @subsection Registers commands
9043 @deffn Command {addreg} [name] [address] [feature] [reg_group]
9044 Add a new register in the cpu register list. This register will be
9045 included in the generated target descriptor file.
9046
9047 @strong{[feature]} must be "org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group[0..10]".
9048
9049 @strong{[reg_group]} can be anything. The default register list defines "system",
9050 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic"
9051 and "timer" groups.
9052
9053 @emph{example:}
9054 @example
9055 addreg rtest 0x1234 org.gnu.gdb.or1k.group0 system
9056 @end example
9057
9058
9059 @end deffn
9060 @deffn Command {readgroup} (@option{group})
9061 Display all registers in @emph{group}.
9062
9063 @emph{group} can be "system",
9064 "dmmu", "immu", "dcache", "icache", "mac", "debug", "perf", "power", "pic",
9065 "timer" or any new group created with addreg command.
9066 @end deffn
9067
9068 @section RISC-V Architecture
9069
9070 @uref{http://riscv.org/, RISC-V} is a free and open ISA. OpenOCD supports JTAG
9071 debug of RV32 and RV64 cores in heterogeneous multicore systems of up to 32
9072 harts. (It's possible to increase this limit to 1024 by changing
9073 RISCV_MAX_HARTS in riscv.h.) OpenOCD primarily supports 0.13 of the RISC-V
9074 Debug Specification, but there is also support for legacy targets that
9075 implement version 0.11.
9076
9077 @subsection RISC-V Terminology
9078
9079 A @emph{hart} is a hardware thread. A hart may share resources (eg. FPU) with
9080 another hart, or may be a separate core. RISC-V treats those the same, and
9081 OpenOCD exposes each hart as a separate core.
9082
9083 @subsection RISC-V Debug Configuration Commands
9084
9085 @deffn Command {riscv expose_csrs} n0[-m0][,n1[-m1]]...
9086 Configure a list of inclusive ranges for CSRs to expose in addition to the
9087 standard ones. This must be executed before `init`.
9088
9089 By default OpenOCD attempts to expose only CSRs that are mentioned in a spec,
9090 and then only if the corresponding extension appears to be implemented. This
9091 command can be used if OpenOCD gets this wrong, or a target implements custom
9092 CSRs.
9093 @end deffn
9094
9095 @deffn Command {riscv set_command_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9096 Set the wall-clock timeout (in seconds) for individual commands. The default
9097 should work fine for all but the slowest targets (eg. simulators).
9098 @end deffn
9099
9100 @deffn Command {riscv set_reset_timeout_sec} [seconds]
9101 Set the maximum time to wait for a hart to come out of reset after reset is
9102 deasserted.
9103 @end deffn
9104
9105 @deffn Command {riscv set_scratch_ram} none|[address]
9106 Set the address of 16 bytes of scratch RAM the debugger can use, or 'none'.
9107 This is used to access 64-bit floating point registers on 32-bit targets.
9108 @end deffn
9109
9110 @deffn Command {riscv set_prefer_sba} on|off
9111 When on, prefer to use System Bus Access to access memory. When off, prefer to
9112 use the Program Buffer to access memory.
9113 @end deffn
9114
9115 @subsection RISC-V Authentication Commands
9116
9117 The following commands can be used to authenticate to a RISC-V system. Eg. a
9118 trivial challenge-response protocol could be implemented as follows in a
9119 configuration file, immediately following @command{init}:
9120 @example
9121 set challenge [ocd_riscv authdata_read]
9122 riscv authdata_write [expr $challenge + 1]
9123 @end example
9124
9125 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_read}
9126 Return the 32-bit value read from authdata. Note that to get read value back in
9127 a TCL script, it needs to be invoked as @command{ocd_riscv authdata_read}.
9128 @end deffn
9129
9130 @deffn Command {riscv authdata_write} value
9131 Write the 32-bit value to authdata.
9132 @end deffn
9133
9134 @subsection RISC-V DMI Commands
9135
9136 The following commands allow direct access to the Debug Module Interface, which
9137 can be used to interact with custom debug features.
9138
9139 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_read}
9140 Perform a 32-bit DMI read at address, returning the value. Note that to get
9141 read value back in a TCL script, it needs to be invoked as @command{ocd_riscv
9142 dmi_read}.
9143 @end deffn
9144
9145 @deffn Command {riscv dmi_write} address value
9146 Perform a 32-bit DMI write of value at address.
9147 @end deffn
9148
9149 @anchor{softwaredebugmessagesandtracing}
9150 @section Software Debug Messages and Tracing
9151 @cindex Linux-ARM DCC support
9152 @cindex tracing
9153 @cindex libdcc
9154 @cindex DCC
9155 OpenOCD can process certain requests from target software, when
9156 the target uses appropriate libraries.
9157 The most powerful mechanism is semihosting, but there is also
9158 a lighter weight mechanism using only the DCC channel.
9159
9160 Currently @command{target_request debugmsgs}
9161 is supported only for @option{arm7_9} and @option{cortex_m} cores.
9162 These messages are received as part of target polling, so
9163 you need to have @command{poll on} active to receive them.
9164 They are intrusive in that they will affect program execution
9165 times. If that is a problem, @pxref{armhardwaretracing,,ARM Hardware Tracing}.
9166
9167 See @file{libdcc} in the contrib dir for more details.
9168 In addition to sending strings, characters, and
9169 arrays of various size integers from the target,
9170 @file{libdcc} also exports a software trace point mechanism.
9171 The target being debugged may
9172 issue trace messages which include a 24-bit @dfn{trace point} number.
9173 Trace point support includes two distinct mechanisms,
9174 each supported by a command:
9175
9176 @itemize
9177 @item @emph{History} ... A circular buffer of trace points
9178 can be set up, and then displayed at any time.
9179 This tracks where code has been, which can be invaluable in
9180 finding out how some fault was triggered.
9181
9182 The buffer may overflow, since it collects records continuously.
9183 It may be useful to use some of the 24 bits to represent a
9184 particular event, and other bits to hold data.
9185
9186 @item @emph{Counting} ... An array of counters can be set up,
9187 and then displayed at any time.
9188 This can help establish code coverage and identify hot spots.
9189
9190 The array of counters is directly indexed by the trace point
9191 number, so trace points with higher numbers are not counted.
9192 @end itemize
9193
9194 Linux-ARM kernels have a ``Kernel low-level debugging
9195 via EmbeddedICE DCC channel'' option (CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC,
9196 depends on CONFIG_DEBUG_LL) which uses this mechanism to
9197 deliver messages before a serial console can be activated.
9198 This is not the same format used by @file{libdcc}.
9199 Other software, such as the U-Boot boot loader, sometimes
9200 does the same thing.
9201
9202 @deffn Command {target_request debugmsgs} [@option{enable}|@option{disable}|@option{charmsg}]
9203 Displays current handling of target DCC message requests.
9204 These messages may be sent to the debugger while the target is running.
9205 The optional @option{enable} and @option{charmsg} parameters
9206 both enable the messages, while @option{disable} disables them.
9207
9208 With @option{charmsg} the DCC words each contain one character,
9209 as used by Linux with CONFIG_DEBUG_ICEDCC;
9210 otherwise the libdcc format is used.
9211 @end deffn
9212
9213 @deffn Command {trace history} [@option{clear}|count]
9214 With no parameter, displays all the trace points that have triggered
9215 in the order they triggered.
9216 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace history records.
9217 With a @var{count} parameter, allocates space for that many
9218 history records.
9219 @end deffn
9220
9221 @deffn Command {trace point} [@option{clear}|identifier]
9222 With no parameter, displays all trace point identifiers and how many times
9223 they have been triggered.
9224 With the parameter @option{clear}, erases all current trace point counters.
9225 With a numeric @var{identifier} parameter, creates a new a trace point counter
9226 and associates it with that identifier.
9227
9228 @emph{Important:} The identifier and the trace point number
9229 are not related except by this command.
9230 These trace point numbers always start at zero (from server startup,
9231 or after @command{trace point clear}) and count up from there.
9232 @end deffn
9233
9234
9235 @node JTAG Commands
9236 @chapter JTAG Commands
9237 @cindex JTAG Commands
9238 Most general purpose JTAG commands have been presented earlier.
9239 (@xref{jtagspeed,,JTAG Speed}, @ref{Reset Configuration}, and @ref{TAP Declaration}.)
9240 Lower level JTAG commands, as presented here,
9241 may be needed to work with targets which require special
9242 attention during operations such as reset or initialization.
9243
9244 To use these commands you will need to understand some
9245 of the basics of JTAG, including:
9246
9247 @itemize @bullet
9248 @item A JTAG scan chain consists of a sequence of individual TAP
9249 devices such as a CPUs.
9250 @item Control operations involve moving each TAP through the same
9251 standard state machine (in parallel)
9252 using their shared TMS and clock signals.
9253 @item Data transfer involves shifting data through the chain of
9254 instruction or data registers of each TAP, writing new register values
9255 while the reading previous ones.
9256 @item Data register sizes are a function of the instruction active in
9257 a given TAP, while instruction register sizes are fixed for each TAP.
9258 All TAPs support a BYPASS instruction with a single bit data register.
9259 @item The way OpenOCD differentiates between TAP devices is by
9260 shifting different instructions into (and out of) their instruction
9261 registers.
9262 @end itemize
9263
9264 @section Low Level JTAG Commands
9265
9266 These commands are used by developers who need to access
9267 JTAG instruction or data registers, possibly controlling
9268 the order of TAP state transitions.
9269 If you're not debugging OpenOCD internals, or bringing up a
9270 new JTAG adapter or a new type of TAP device (like a CPU or
9271 JTAG router), you probably won't need to use these commands.
9272 In a debug session that doesn't use JTAG for its transport protocol,
9273 these commands are not available.
9274
9275 @deffn Command {drscan} tap [numbits value]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9276 Loads the data register of @var{tap} with a series of bit fields
9277 that specify the entire register.
9278 Each field is @var{numbits} bits long with
9279 a numeric @var{value} (hexadecimal encouraged).
9280 The return value holds the original value of each
9281 of those fields.
9282
9283 For example, a 38 bit number might be specified as one
9284 field of 32 bits then one of 6 bits.
9285 @emph{For portability, never pass fields which are more
9286 than 32 bits long. Many OpenOCD implementations do not
9287 support 64-bit (or larger) integer values.}
9288
9289 All TAPs other than @var{tap} must be in BYPASS mode.
9290 The single bit in their data registers does not matter.
9291
9292 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9293 in that state.
9294 For example @sc{drpause} might be specified, so that more
9295 instructions can be issued before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9296 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9297
9298 @quotation Warning
9299 OpenOCD does not record information about data register lengths,
9300 so @emph{it is important that you get the bit field lengths right}.
9301 Remember that different JTAG instructions refer to different
9302 data registers, which may have different lengths.
9303 Moreover, those lengths may not be fixed;
9304 the SCAN_N instruction can change the length of
9305 the register accessed by the INTEST instruction
9306 (by connecting a different scan chain).
9307 @end quotation
9308 @end deffn
9309
9310 @deffn Command {flush_count}
9311 Returns the number of times the JTAG queue has been flushed.
9312 This may be used for performance tuning.
9313
9314 For example, flushing a queue over USB involves a
9315 minimum latency, often several milliseconds, which does
9316 not change with the amount of data which is written.
9317 You may be able to identify performance problems by finding
9318 tasks which waste bandwidth by flushing small transfers too often,
9319 instead of batching them into larger operations.
9320 @end deffn
9321
9322 @deffn Command {irscan} [tap instruction]+ [@option{-endstate} tap_state]
9323 For each @var{tap} listed, loads the instruction register
9324 with its associated numeric @var{instruction}.
9325 (The number of bits in that instruction may be displayed
9326 using the @command{scan_chain} command.)
9327 For other TAPs, a BYPASS instruction is loaded.
9328
9329 When @var{tap_state} is specified, the JTAG state machine is left
9330 in that state.
9331 For example @sc{irpause} might be specified, so the data register
9332 can be loaded before re-entering the @sc{run/idle} state.
9333 If the end state is not specified, the @sc{run/idle} state is entered.
9334
9335 @quotation Note
9336 OpenOCD currently supports only a single field for instruction
9337 register values, unlike data register values.
9338 For TAPs where the instruction register length is more than 32 bits,
9339 portable scripts currently must issue only BYPASS instructions.
9340 @end quotation
9341 @end deffn
9342
9343 @deffn Command {jtag_reset} trst srst
9344 Set values of reset signals.
9345 The @var{trst} and @var{srst} parameter values may be
9346 @option{0}, indicating that reset is inactive (pulled or driven high),
9347 or @option{1}, indicating it is active (pulled or driven low).
9348 The @command{reset_config} command should already have been used
9349 to configure how the board and JTAG adapter treat these two
9350 signals, and to say if either signal is even present.
9351 @xref{Reset Configuration}.
9352
9353 Note that TRST is specially handled.
9354 It actually signifies JTAG's @sc{reset} state.
9355 So if the board doesn't support the optional TRST signal,
9356 or it doesn't support it along with the specified SRST value,
9357 JTAG reset is triggered with TMS and TCK signals
9358 instead of the TRST signal.
9359 And no matter how that JTAG reset is triggered, once
9360 the scan chain enters @sc{reset} with TRST inactive,
9361 TAP @code{post-reset} events are delivered to all TAPs
9362 with handlers for that event.
9363 @end deffn
9364
9365 @deffn Command {pathmove} start_state [next_state ...]
9366 Start by moving to @var{start_state}, which
9367 must be one of the @emph{stable} states.
9368 Unless it is the only state given, this will often be the
9369 current state, so that no TCK transitions are needed.
9370 Then, in a series of single state transitions
9371 (conforming to the JTAG state machine) shift to
9372 each @var{next_state} in sequence, one per TCK cycle.
9373 The final state must also be stable.
9374 @end deffn
9375
9376 @deffn Command {runtest} @var{num_cycles}
9377 Move to the @sc{run/idle} state, and execute at least
9378 @var{num_cycles} of the JTAG clock (TCK).
9379 Instructions often need some time
9380 to execute before they take effect.
9381 @end deffn
9382
9383 @c tms_sequence (short|long)
9384 @c ... temporary, debug-only, other than USBprog bug workaround...
9385
9386 @deffn Command {verify_ircapture} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9387 Verify values captured during @sc{ircapture} and returned
9388 during IR scans. Default is enabled, but this can be
9389 overridden by @command{verify_jtag}.
9390 This flag is ignored when validating JTAG chain configuration.
9391 @end deffn
9392
9393 @deffn Command {verify_jtag} (@option{enable}|@option{disable})
9394 Enables verification of DR and IR scans, to help detect
9395 programming errors. For IR scans, @command{verify_ircapture}
9396 must also be enabled.
9397 Default is enabled.
9398 @end deffn
9399
9400 @section TAP state names
9401 @cindex TAP state names
9402
9403 The @var{tap_state} names used by OpenOCD in the @command{drscan},
9404 @command{irscan}, and @command{pathmove} commands are the same
9405 as those used in SVF boundary scan documents, except that
9406 SVF uses @sc{idle} instead of @sc{run/idle}.
9407
9408 @itemize @bullet
9409 @item @b{RESET} ... @emph{stable} (with TMS high);
9410 acts as if TRST were pulsed
9411 @item @b{RUN/IDLE} ... @emph{stable}; don't assume this always means IDLE
9412 @item @b{DRSELECT}
9413 @item @b{DRCAPTURE}
9414 @item @b{DRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9415 through the data register
9416 @item @b{DREXIT1}
9417 @item @b{DRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; data register ready
9418 for update or more shifting
9419 @item @b{DREXIT2}
9420 @item @b{DRUPDATE}
9421 @item @b{IRSELECT}
9422 @item @b{IRCAPTURE}
9423 @item @b{IRSHIFT} ... @emph{stable}; TDI/TDO shifting
9424 through the instruction register
9425 @item @b{IREXIT1}
9426 @item @b{IRPAUSE} ... @emph{stable}; instruction register ready
9427 for update or more shifting
9428 @item @b{IREXIT2}
9429 @item @b{IRUPDATE}
9430 @end itemize
9431
9432 Note that only six of those states are fully ``stable'' in the
9433 face of TMS fixed (low except for @sc{reset})
9434 and a free-running JTAG clock. For all the
9435 others, the next TCK transition changes to a new state.
9436
9437 @itemize @bullet
9438 @item From @sc{drshift} and @sc{irshift}, clock transitions will
9439 produce side effects by changing register contents. The values
9440 to be latched in upcoming @sc{drupdate} or @sc{irupdate} states
9441 may not be as expected.
9442 @item @sc{run/idle}, @sc{drpause}, and @sc{irpause} are reasonable
9443 choices after @command{drscan} or @command{irscan} commands,
9444 since they are free of JTAG side effects.
9445 @item @sc{run/idle} may have side effects that appear at non-JTAG
9446 levels, such as advancing the ARM9E-S instruction pipeline.
9447 Consult the documentation for the TAP(s) you are working with.
9448 @end itemize
9449
9450 @node Boundary Scan Commands
9451 @chapter Boundary Scan Commands
9452
9453 One of the original purposes of JTAG was to support
9454 boundary scan based hardware testing.
9455 Although its primary focus is to support On-Chip Debugging,
9456 OpenOCD also includes some boundary scan commands.
9457
9458 @section SVF: Serial Vector Format
9459 @cindex Serial Vector Format
9460 @cindex SVF
9461
9462 The Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{SVF}, is a
9463 way to represent JTAG test patterns in text files.
9464 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9465 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9466
9467 @deffn Command {svf} @file{filename} [@option{-tap @var{tapname}}] [@option{[-]quiet}] @
9468 [@option{[-]nil}] [@option{[-]progress}] [@option{[-]ignore_error}]
9469 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9470 runs the SVF script from @file{filename}.
9471
9472 Arguments can be specified in any order; the optional dash doesn't
9473 affect their semantics.
9474
9475 Command options:
9476 @itemize @minus
9477 @item @option{-tap @var{tapname}} ignore IR and DR headers and footers
9478 specified by the SVF file with HIR, TIR, HDR and TDR commands;
9479 instead, calculate them automatically according to the current JTAG
9480 chain configuration, targeting @var{tapname};
9481 @item @option{[-]quiet} do not log every command before execution;
9482 @item @option{[-]nil} ``dry run'', i.e., do not perform any operations
9483 on the real interface;
9484 @item @option{[-]progress} enable progress indication;
9485 @item @option{[-]ignore_error} continue execution despite TDO check
9486 errors.
9487 @end itemize
9488 @end deffn
9489
9490 @section XSVF: Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9491 @cindex Xilinx Serial Vector Format
9492 @cindex XSVF
9493
9494 The Xilinx Serial Vector Format, better known as @dfn{XSVF}, is a
9495 binary representation of SVF which is optimized for use with
9496 Xilinx devices.
9497 In a debug session using JTAG for its transport protocol,
9498 OpenOCD supports running such test files.
9499
9500 @quotation Important
9501 Not all XSVF commands are supported.
9502 @end quotation
9503
9504 @deffn Command {xsvf} (tapname|@option{plain}) filename [@option{virt2}] [@option{quiet}]
9505 This issues a JTAG reset (Test-Logic-Reset) and then
9506 runs the XSVF script from @file{filename}.
9507 When a @var{tapname} is specified, the commands are directed at
9508 that TAP.
9509 When @option{virt2} is specified, the @sc{xruntest} command counts
9510 are interpreted as TCK cycles instead of microseconds.
9511 Unless the @option{quiet} option is specified,
9512 messages are logged for comments and some retries.
9513 @end deffn
9514
9515 The OpenOCD sources also include two utility scripts
9516 for working with XSVF; they are not currently installed
9517 after building the software.
9518 You may find them useful:
9519
9520 @itemize
9521 @item @emph{svf2xsvf} ... converts SVF files into the extended XSVF
9522 syntax understood by the @command{xsvf} command; see notes below.
9523 @item @emph{xsvfdump} ... converts XSVF files into a text output format;
9524 understands the OpenOCD extensions.
9525 @end itemize
9526
9527 The input format accepts a handful of non-standard extensions.
9528 These include three opcodes corresponding to SVF extensions
9529 from Lattice Semiconductor (LCOUNT, LDELAY, LDSR), and
9530 two opcodes supporting a more accurate translation of SVF
9531 (XTRST, XWAITSTATE).
9532 If @emph{xsvfdump} shows a file is using those opcodes, it
9533 probably will not be usable with other XSVF tools.
9534
9535
9536 @node Utility Commands
9537 @chapter Utility Commands
9538 @cindex Utility Commands
9539
9540 @section RAM testing
9541 @cindex RAM testing
9542
9543 There is often a need to stress-test random access memory (RAM) for
9544 errors. OpenOCD comes with a Tcl implementation of well-known memory
9545 testing procedures allowing the detection of all sorts of issues with
9546 electrical wiring, defective chips, PCB layout and other common
9547 hardware problems.
9548
9549 To use them, you usually need to initialise your RAM controller first;
9550 consult your SoC's documentation to get the recommended list of
9551 register operations and translate them to the corresponding
9552 @command{mww}/@command{mwb} commands.
9553
9554 Load the memory testing functions with
9555
9556 @example
9557 source [find tools/memtest.tcl]
9558 @end example
9559
9560 to get access to the following facilities:
9561
9562 @deffn Command {memTestDataBus} address
9563 Test the data bus wiring in a memory region by performing a walking
9564 1's test at a fixed address within that region.
9565 @end deffn
9566
9567 @deffn Command {memTestAddressBus} baseaddress size
9568 Perform a walking 1's test on the relevant bits of the address and
9569 check for aliasing. This test will find single-bit address failures
9570 such as stuck-high, stuck-low, and shorted pins.
9571 @end deffn
9572
9573 @deffn Command {memTestDevice} baseaddress size
9574 Test the integrity of a physical memory device by performing an
9575 increment/decrement test over the entire region. In the process every
9576 storage bit in the device is tested as zero and as one.
9577 @end deffn
9578
9579 @deffn Command {runAllMemTests} baseaddress size
9580 Run all of the above tests over a specified memory region.
9581 @end deffn
9582
9583 @section Firmware recovery helpers
9584 @cindex Firmware recovery
9585
9586 OpenOCD includes an easy-to-use script to facilitate mass-market
9587 devices recovery with JTAG.
9588
9589 For quickstart instructions run:
9590 @example
9591 openocd -f tools/firmware-recovery.tcl -c firmware_help
9592 @end example
9593
9594 @node TFTP
9595 @chapter TFTP
9596 @cindex TFTP
9597 If OpenOCD runs on an embedded host (as ZY1000 does), then TFTP can
9598 be used to access files on PCs (either the developer's PC or some other PC).
9599
9600 The way this works on the ZY1000 is to prefix a filename by
9601 "/tftp/ip/" and append the TFTP path on the TFTP
9602 server (tftpd). For example,
9603
9604 @example
9605 load_image /tftp/10.0.0.96/c:\temp\abc.elf
9606 @end example
9607
9608 will load c:\temp\abc.elf from the developer pc (10.0.0.96) into memory as
9609 if the file was hosted on the embedded host.
9610
9611 In order to achieve decent performance, you must choose a TFTP server
9612 that supports a packet size bigger than the default packet size (512 bytes). There
9613 are numerous TFTP servers out there (free and commercial) and you will have to do
9614 a bit of googling to find something that fits your requirements.
9615
9616 @node GDB and OpenOCD
9617 @chapter GDB and OpenOCD
9618 @cindex GDB
9619 OpenOCD complies with the remote gdbserver protocol and, as such, can be used
9620 to debug remote targets.
9621 Setting up GDB to work with OpenOCD can involve several components:
9622
9623 @itemize
9624 @item The OpenOCD server support for GDB may need to be configured.
9625 @xref{gdbconfiguration,,GDB Configuration}.
9626 @item GDB's support for OpenOCD may need configuration,
9627 as shown in this chapter.
9628 @item If you have a GUI environment like Eclipse,
9629 that also will probably need to be configured.
9630 @end itemize
9631
9632 Of course, the version of GDB you use will need to be one which has
9633 been built to know about the target CPU you're using. It's probably
9634 part of the tool chain you're using. For example, if you are doing
9635 cross-development for ARM on an x86 PC, instead of using the native
9636 x86 @command{gdb} command you might use @command{arm-none-eabi-gdb}
9637 if that's the tool chain used to compile your code.
9638
9639 @section Connecting to GDB
9640 @cindex Connecting to GDB
9641 Use GDB 6.7 or newer with OpenOCD if you run into trouble. For
9642 instance GDB 6.3 has a known bug that produces bogus memory access
9643 errors, which has since been fixed; see
9644 @url{http://osdir.com/ml/gdb.bugs.discuss/2004-12/msg00018.html}
9645
9646 OpenOCD can communicate with GDB in two ways:
9647
9648 @enumerate
9649 @item
9650 A socket (TCP/IP) connection is typically started as follows:
9651 @example
9652 target remote localhost:3333
9653 @end example
9654 This would cause GDB to connect to the gdbserver on the local pc using port 3333.
9655
9656 It is also possible to use the GDB extended remote protocol as follows:
9657 @example
9658 target extended-remote localhost:3333
9659 @end example
9660 @item
9661 A pipe connection is typically started as follows:
9662 @example
9663 target remote | openocd -c "gdb_port pipe; log_output openocd.log"
9664 @end example
9665 This would cause GDB to run OpenOCD and communicate using pipes (stdin/stdout).
9666 Using this method has the advantage of GDB starting/stopping OpenOCD for the debug
9667 session. log_output sends the log output to a file to ensure that the pipe is
9668 not saturated when using higher debug level outputs.
9669 @end enumerate
9670
9671 To list the available OpenOCD commands type @command{monitor help} on the
9672 GDB command line.
9673
9674 @section Sample GDB session startup
9675
9676 With the remote protocol, GDB sessions start a little differently
9677 than they do when you're debugging locally.
9678 Here's an example showing how to start a debug session with a
9679 small ARM program.
9680 In this case the program was linked to be loaded into SRAM on a Cortex-M3.
9681 Most programs would be written into flash (address 0) and run from there.
9682
9683 @example
9684 $ arm-none-eabi-gdb example.elf
9685 (gdb) target remote localhost:3333
9686 Remote debugging using localhost:3333
9687 ...
9688 (gdb) monitor reset halt
9689 ...
9690 (gdb) load
9691 Loading section .vectors, size 0x100 lma 0x20000000
9692 Loading section .text, size 0x5a0 lma 0x20000100
9693 Loading section .data, size 0x18 lma 0x200006a0
9694 Start address 0x2000061c, load size 1720
9695 Transfer rate: 22 KB/sec, 573 bytes/write.
9696 (gdb) continue
9697 Continuing.
9698 ...
9699 @end example
9700
9701 You could then interrupt the GDB session to make the program break,
9702 type @command{where} to show the stack, @command{list} to show the
9703 code around the program counter, @command{step} through code,
9704 set breakpoints or watchpoints, and so on.
9705
9706 @section Configuring GDB for OpenOCD
9707
9708 OpenOCD supports the gdb @option{qSupported} packet, this enables information
9709 to be sent by the GDB remote server (i.e. OpenOCD) to GDB. Typical information includes
9710 packet size and the device's memory map.
9711 You do not need to configure the packet size by hand,
9712 and the relevant parts of the memory map should be automatically
9713 set up when you declare (NOR) flash banks.
9714
9715 However, there are other things which GDB can't currently query.
9716 You may need to set those up by hand.
9717 As OpenOCD starts up, you will often see a line reporting
9718 something like:
9719
9720 @example
9721 Info : lm3s.cpu: hardware has 6 breakpoints, 4 watchpoints
9722 @end example
9723
9724 You can pass that information to GDB with these commands:
9725
9726 @example
9727 set remote hardware-breakpoint-limit 6
9728 set remote hardware-watchpoint-limit 4
9729 @end example
9730
9731 With that particular hardware (Cortex-M3) the hardware breakpoints
9732 only work for code running from flash memory. Most other ARM systems
9733 do not have such restrictions.
9734
9735 Rather than typing such commands interactively, you may prefer to
9736 save them in a file and have GDB execute them as it starts, perhaps
9737 using a @file{.gdbinit} in your project directory or starting GDB
9738 using @command{gdb -x filename}.
9739
9740 @section Programming using GDB
9741 @cindex Programming using GDB
9742 @anchor{programmingusinggdb}
9743
9744 By default the target memory map is sent to GDB. This can be disabled by
9745 the following OpenOCD configuration option:
9746 @example
9747 gdb_memory_map disable
9748 @end example
9749 For this to function correctly a valid flash configuration must also be set
9750 in OpenOCD. For faster performance you should also configure a valid
9751 working area.
9752
9753 Informing GDB of the memory map of the target will enable GDB to protect any
9754 flash areas of the target and use hardware breakpoints by default. This means
9755 that the OpenOCD option @command{gdb_breakpoint_override} is not required when
9756 using a memory map. @xref{gdbbreakpointoverride,,gdb_breakpoint_override}.
9757
9758 To view the configured memory map in GDB, use the GDB command @option{info mem}.
9759 All other unassigned addresses within GDB are treated as RAM.
9760
9761 GDB 6.8 and higher set any memory area not in the memory map as inaccessible.
9762 This can be changed to the old behaviour by using the following GDB command
9763 @example
9764 set mem inaccessible-by-default off
9765 @end example
9766
9767 If @command{gdb_flash_program enable} is also used, GDB will be able to
9768 program any flash memory using the vFlash interface.
9769
9770 GDB will look at the target memory map when a load command is given, if any
9771 areas to be programmed lie within the target flash area the vFlash packets
9772 will be used.
9773
9774 If the target needs configuring before GDB programming, set target
9775 event gdb-flash-erase-start:
9776 @example
9777 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-flash-erase-start BODY
9778 @end example
9779 @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}, for other GDB programming related events.
9780
9781 To verify any flash programming the GDB command @option{compare-sections}
9782 can be used.
9783
9784 @section Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
9785 @cindex Using GDB as a non-intrusive memory inspector
9786 @anchor{gdbmeminspect}
9787
9788 If your project controls more than a blinking LED, let's say a heavy industrial
9789 robot or an experimental nuclear reactor, stopping the controlling process
9790 just because you want to attach GDB is not a good option.
9791
9792 OpenOCD does not support GDB non-stop mode (might be implemented in the future).
9793 Though there is a possible setup where the target does not get stopped
9794 and GDB treats it as it were running.
9795 If the target supports background access to memory while it is running,
9796 you can use GDB in this mode to inspect memory (mainly global variables)
9797 without any intrusion of the target process.
9798
9799 Remove default setting of gdb-attach event. @xref{targetevents,,Target Events}.
9800 Place following command after target configuration:
9801 @example
9802 $_TARGETNAME configure -event gdb-attach @{@}
9803 @end example
9804
9805 If any of installed flash banks does not support probe on running target,
9806 switch off gdb_memory_map:
9807 @example
9808 gdb_memory_map disable
9809 @end example
9810
9811 Ensure GDB is configured without interrupt-on-connect.
9812 Some GDB versions set it by default, some does not.
9813 @example
9814 set remote interrupt-on-connect off
9815 @end example
9816
9817 If you switched gdb_memory_map off, you may want to setup GDB memory map
9818 manually or issue @command{set mem inaccessible-by-default off}
9819
9820 Now you can issue GDB command @command{target remote ...} and inspect memory
9821 of a running target. Do not use GDB commands @command{continue},
9822 @command{step} or @command{next} as they synchronize GDB with your target
9823 and GDB would require stopping the target to get the prompt back.
9824
9825 Do not use this mode under an IDE like Eclipse as it caches values of
9826 previously shown varibles.
9827
9828 @anchor{usingopenocdsmpwithgdb}
9829 @section Using OpenOCD SMP with GDB
9830 @cindex SMP
9831 For SMP support following GDB serial protocol packet have been defined :
9832 @itemize @bullet
9833 @item j - smp status request
9834 @item J - smp set request
9835 @end itemize
9836
9837 OpenOCD implements :
9838 @itemize @bullet
9839 @item @option{jc} packet for reading core id displayed by
9840 GDB connection. Reply is @option{XXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits giving core id) or
9841 @option{E01} for target not smp.
9842 @item @option{JcXXXXXXXX} (8 hex digits) packet for setting core id displayed at next GDB continue
9843 (core id -1 is reserved for returning to normal resume mode). Reply @option{E01}
9844 for target not smp or @option{OK} on success.
9845 @end itemize
9846
9847 Handling of this packet within GDB can be done :
9848 @itemize @bullet
9849 @item by the creation of an internal variable (i.e @option{_core}) by mean
9850 of function allocate_computed_value allowing following GDB command.
9851 @example
9852 set $_core 1
9853 #Jc01 packet is sent
9854 print $_core
9855 #jc packet is sent and result is affected in $
9856 @end example
9857
9858 @item by the usage of GDB maintenance command as described in following example (2 cpus in SMP with
9859 core id 0 and 1 @pxref{definecputargetsworkinginsmp,,Define CPU targets working in SMP}).
9860
9861 @example
9862 # toggle0 : force display of coreid 0
9863 define toggle0
9864 maint packet Jc0
9865 continue
9866 main packet Jc-1
9867 end
9868 # toggle1 : force display of coreid 1
9869 define toggle1
9870 maint packet Jc1
9871 continue
9872 main packet Jc-1
9873 end
9874 @end example
9875 @end itemize
9876
9877 @section RTOS Support
9878 @cindex RTOS Support
9879 @anchor{gdbrtossupport}
9880
9881 OpenOCD includes RTOS support, this will however need enabling as it defaults to disabled.
9882 It can be enabled by passing @option{-rtos} arg to the target. @xref{rtostype,,RTOS Type}.
9883
9884 @xref{Threads, Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads,
9885 Debugging Programs with Multiple Threads, gdb, GDB manual}, for details about relevant
9886 GDB commands.
9887
9888 @* An example setup is below:
9889
9890 @example
9891 $_TARGETNAME configure -rtos auto
9892 @end example
9893
9894 This will attempt to auto detect the RTOS within your application.
9895
9896 Currently supported rtos's include:
9897 @itemize @bullet
9898 @item @option{eCos}
9899 @item @option{ThreadX}
9900 @item @option{FreeRTOS}
9901 @item @option{linux}
9902 @item @option{ChibiOS}
9903 @item @option{embKernel}
9904 @item @option{mqx}
9905 @item @option{uCOS-III}
9906 @item @option{nuttx}
9907 @end itemize
9908
9909 @quotation Note
9910 Before an RTOS can be detected, it must export certain symbols; otherwise, it cannot
9911 be used by OpenOCD. Below is a list of the required symbols for each supported RTOS.
9912 @end quotation
9913
9914 @table @code
9915 @item eCos symbols
9916 Cyg_Thread::thread_list, Cyg_Scheduler_Base::current_thread.
9917 @item ThreadX symbols
9918 _tx_thread_current_ptr, _tx_thread_created_ptr, _tx_thread_created_count.
9919 @item FreeRTOS symbols
9920 @c The following is taken from recent texinfo to provide compatibility
9921 @c with ancient versions that do not support @raggedright
9922 @tex
9923 \begingroup
9924 \rightskip0pt plus2em \spaceskip.3333em \xspaceskip.5em\relax
9925 pxCurrentTCB, pxReadyTasksLists, xDelayedTaskList1, xDelayedTaskList2,
9926 pxDelayedTaskList, pxOverflowDelayedTaskList, xPendingReadyList,
9927 uxCurrentNumberOfTasks, uxTopUsedPriority.
9928 \par
9929 \endgroup
9930 @end tex
9931 @item linux symbols
9932 init_task.
9933 @item ChibiOS symbols
9934 rlist, ch_debug, chSysInit.
9935 @item embKernel symbols
9936 Rtos::sCurrentTask, Rtos::sListReady, Rtos::sListSleep,
9937 Rtos::sListSuspended, Rtos::sMaxPriorities, Rtos::sCurrentTaskCount.
9938 @item mqx symbols
9939 _mqx_kernel_data, MQX_init_struct.
9940 @item uC/OS-III symbols
9941 OSRunning, OSTCBCurPtr, OSTaskDbgListPtr, OSTaskQty
9942 @item nuttx symbols
9943 g_readytorun, g_tasklisttable
9944 @end table
9945
9946 For most RTOS supported the above symbols will be exported by default. However for
9947 some, eg. FreeRTOS and uC/OS-III, extra steps must be taken.
9948
9949 These RTOSes may require additional OpenOCD-specific file to be linked
9950 along with the project:
9951
9952 @table @code
9953 @item FreeRTOS
9954 contrib/rtos-helpers/FreeRTOS-openocd.c
9955 @item uC/OS-III
9956 contrib/rtos-helpers/uCOS-III-openocd.c
9957 @end table
9958
9959 @node Tcl Scripting API
9960 @chapter Tcl Scripting API
9961 @cindex Tcl Scripting API
9962 @cindex Tcl scripts
9963 @section API rules
9964
9965 Tcl commands are stateless; e.g. the @command{telnet} command has
9966 a concept of currently active target, the Tcl API proc's take this sort
9967 of state information as an argument to each proc.
9968
9969 There are three main types of return values: single value, name value
9970 pair list and lists.
9971
9972 Name value pair. The proc 'foo' below returns a name/value pair
9973 list.
9974
9975 @example
9976 > set foo(me) Duane
9977 > set foo(you) Oyvind
9978 > set foo(mouse) Micky
9979 > set foo(duck) Donald
9980 @end example
9981
9982 If one does this:
9983
9984 @example
9985 > set foo
9986 @end example
9987
9988 The result is:
9989
9990 @example
9991 me Duane you Oyvind mouse Micky duck Donald
9992 @end example
9993
9994 Thus, to get the names of the associative array is easy:
9995
9996 @verbatim
9997 foreach { name value } [set foo] {
9998 puts "Name: $name, Value: $value"
9999 }
10000 @end verbatim
10001
10002 Lists returned should be relatively small. Otherwise, a range
10003 should be passed in to the proc in question.
10004
10005 @section Internal low-level Commands
10006
10007 By "low-level," we mean commands that a human would typically not
10008 invoke directly.
10009
10010 Some low-level commands need to be prefixed with "ocd_"; e.g.
10011 @command{ocd_flash_banks}
10012 is the low-level API upon which @command{flash banks} is implemented.
10013
10014 @itemize @bullet
10015 @item @b{mem2array} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10016
10017 Read memory and return as a Tcl array for script processing
10018 @item @b{array2mem} <@var{varname}> <@var{width}> <@var{addr}> <@var{nelems}>
10019
10020 Convert a Tcl array to memory locations and write the values
10021 @item @b{ocd_flash_banks} <@var{driver}> <@var{base}> <@var{size}> <@var{chip_width}> <@var{bus_width}> <@var{target}> [@option{driver options} ...]
10022
10023 Return information about the flash banks
10024
10025 @item @b{capture} <@var{command}>
10026
10027 Run <@var{command}> and return full log output that was produced during
10028 its execution. Example:
10029
10030 @example
10031 > capture "reset init"
10032 @end example
10033
10034 @end itemize
10035
10036 OpenOCD commands can consist of two words, e.g. "flash banks". The
10037 @file{startup.tcl} "unknown" proc will translate this into a Tcl proc
10038 called "flash_banks".
10039
10040 @section OpenOCD specific Global Variables
10041
10042 Real Tcl has ::tcl_platform(), and platform::identify, and many other
10043 variables. JimTCL, as implemented in OpenOCD creates $ocd_HOSTOS which
10044 holds one of the following values:
10045
10046 @itemize @bullet
10047 @item @b{cygwin} Running under Cygwin
10048 @item @b{darwin} Darwin (Mac-OS) is the underlying operating system.
10049 @item @b{freebsd} Running under FreeBSD
10050 @item @b{openbsd} Running under OpenBSD
10051 @item @b{netbsd} Running under NetBSD
10052 @item @b{linux} Linux is the underlying operating system
10053 @item @b{mingw32} Running under MingW32
10054 @item @b{winxx} Built using Microsoft Visual Studio
10055 @item @b{ecos} Running under eCos
10056 @item @b{other} Unknown, none of the above.
10057 @end itemize
10058
10059 Note: 'winxx' was chosen because today (March-2009) no distinction is made between Win32 and Win64.
10060
10061 @quotation Note
10062 We should add support for a variable like Tcl variable
10063 @code{tcl_platform(platform)}, it should be called
10064 @code{jim_platform} (because it
10065 is jim, not real tcl).
10066 @end quotation
10067
10068 @section Tcl RPC server
10069 @cindex RPC
10070
10071 OpenOCD provides a simple RPC server that allows to run arbitrary Tcl
10072 commands and receive the results.
10073
10074 To access it, your application needs to connect to a configured TCP port
10075 (see @command{tcl_port}). Then it can pass any string to the
10076 interpreter terminating it with @code{0x1a} and wait for the return
10077 value (it will be terminated with @code{0x1a} as well). This can be
10078 repeated as many times as desired without reopening the connection.
10079
10080 Remember that most of the OpenOCD commands need to be prefixed with
10081 @code{ocd_} to get the results back. Sometimes you might also need the
10082 @command{capture} command.
10083
10084 See @file{contrib/rpc_examples/} for specific client implementations.
10085
10086 @section Tcl RPC server notifications
10087 @cindex RPC Notifications
10088
10089 Notifications are sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10090 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10091
10092 Target event, state and reset notifications are emitted as Tcl associative arrays
10093 in the following format.
10094
10095 @verbatim
10096 type target_event event [event-name]
10097 type target_state state [state-name]
10098 type target_reset mode [reset-mode]
10099 @end verbatim
10100
10101 @deffn {Command} tcl_notifications [on/off]
10102 Toggle output of target notifications to the current Tcl RPC server.
10103 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10104 Defaults to off.
10105
10106 @end deffn
10107
10108 @section Tcl RPC server trace output
10109 @cindex RPC trace output
10110
10111 Trace data is sent asynchronously to other commands being executed over
10112 the RPC server, so the port must be polled continuously.
10113
10114 Target trace data is emitted as a Tcl associative array in the following format.
10115
10116 @verbatim
10117 type target_trace data [trace-data-hex-encoded]
10118 @end verbatim
10119
10120 @deffn {Command} tcl_trace [on/off]
10121 Toggle output of target trace data to the current Tcl RPC server.
10122 Only available from the Tcl RPC server.
10123 Defaults to off.
10124
10125 See an example application here:
10126 @url{https://github.com/apmorton/OpenOcdTraceUtil} [OpenOcdTraceUtil]
10127
10128 @end deffn
10129
10130 @node FAQ
10131 @chapter FAQ
10132 @cindex faq
10133 @enumerate
10134 @anchor{faqrtck}
10135 @item @b{RTCK, also known as: Adaptive Clocking - What is it?}
10136 @cindex RTCK
10137 @cindex adaptive clocking
10138 @*
10139
10140 In digital circuit design it is often referred to as ``clock
10141 synchronisation'' the JTAG interface uses one clock (TCK or TCLK)
10142 operating at some speed, your CPU target is operating at another.
10143 The two clocks are not synchronised, they are ``asynchronous''
10144
10145 In order for the two to work together they must be synchronised
10146 well enough to work; JTAG can't go ten times faster than the CPU,
10147 for example. There are 2 basic options:
10148 @enumerate
10149 @item
10150 Use a special "adaptive clocking" circuit to change the JTAG
10151 clock rate to match what the CPU currently supports.
10152 @item
10153 The JTAG clock must be fixed at some speed that's enough slower than
10154 the CPU clock that all TMS and TDI transitions can be detected.
10155 @end enumerate
10156
10157 @b{Does this really matter?} For some chips and some situations, this
10158 is a non-issue, like a 500MHz ARM926 with a 5 MHz JTAG link;
10159 the CPU has no difficulty keeping up with JTAG.
10160 Startup sequences are often problematic though, as are other
10161 situations where the CPU clock rate changes (perhaps to save
10162 power).
10163
10164 For example, Atmel AT91SAM chips start operation from reset with
10165 a 32kHz system clock. Boot firmware may activate the main oscillator
10166 and PLL before switching to a faster clock (perhaps that 500 MHz
10167 ARM926 scenario).
10168 If you're using JTAG to debug that startup sequence, you must slow
10169 the JTAG clock to sometimes 1 to 4kHz. After startup completes,
10170 JTAG can use a faster clock.
10171
10172 Consider also debugging a 500MHz ARM926 hand held battery powered
10173 device that enters a low power ``deep sleep'' mode, at 32kHz CPU
10174 clock, between keystrokes unless it has work to do. When would
10175 that 5 MHz JTAG clock be usable?
10176
10177 @b{Solution #1 - A special circuit}
10178
10179 In order to make use of this,
10180 your CPU, board, and JTAG adapter must all support the RTCK
10181 feature. Not all of them support this; keep reading!
10182
10183 The RTCK ("Return TCK") signal in some ARM chips is used to help with
10184 this problem. ARM has a good description of the problem described at
10185 this link: @url{http://www.arm.com/support/faqdev/4170.html} [checked
10186 28/nov/2008]. Link title: ``How does the JTAG synchronisation logic
10187 work? / how does adaptive clocking work?''.
10188
10189 The nice thing about adaptive clocking is that ``battery powered hand
10190 held device example'' - the adaptiveness works perfectly all the
10191 time. One can set a break point or halt the system in the deep power
10192 down code, slow step out until the system speeds up.
10193
10194 Note that adaptive clocking may also need to work at the board level,
10195 when a board-level scan chain has multiple chips.
10196 Parallel clock voting schemes are good way to implement this,
10197 both within and between chips, and can easily be implemented
10198 with a CPLD.
10199 It's not difficult to have logic fan a module's input TCK signal out
10200 to each TAP in the scan chain, and then wait until each TAP's RTCK comes
10201 back with the right polarity before changing the output RTCK signal.
10202 Texas Instruments makes some clock voting logic available
10203 for free (with no support) in VHDL form; see
10204 @url{http://tiexpressdsp.com/index.php/Adaptive_Clocking}
10205
10206 @b{Solution #2 - Always works - but may be slower}
10207
10208 Often this is a perfectly acceptable solution.
10209
10210 In most simple terms: Often the JTAG clock must be 1/10 to 1/12 of
10211 the target clock speed. But what that ``magic division'' is varies
10212 depending on the chips on your board.
10213 @b{ARM rule of thumb} Most ARM based systems require an 6:1 division;
10214 ARM11 cores use an 8:1 division.
10215 @b{Xilinx rule of thumb} is 1/12 the clock speed.
10216
10217 Note: most full speed FT2232 based JTAG adapters are limited to a
10218 maximum of 6MHz. The ones using USB high speed chips (FT2232H)
10219 often support faster clock rates (and adaptive clocking).
10220
10221 You can still debug the 'low power' situations - you just need to
10222 either use a fixed and very slow JTAG clock rate ... or else
10223 manually adjust the clock speed at every step. (Adjusting is painful
10224 and tedious, and is not always practical.)
10225
10226 It is however easy to ``code your way around it'' - i.e.: Cheat a little,
10227 have a special debug mode in your application that does a ``high power
10228 sleep''. If you are careful - 98% of your problems can be debugged
10229 this way.
10230
10231 Note that on ARM you may need to avoid using the @emph{wait for interrupt}
10232 operation in your idle loops even if you don't otherwise change the CPU
10233 clock rate.
10234 That operation gates the CPU clock, and thus the JTAG clock; which
10235 prevents JTAG access. One consequence is not being able to @command{halt}
10236 cores which are executing that @emph{wait for interrupt} operation.
10237
10238 To set the JTAG frequency use the command:
10239
10240 @example
10241 # Example: 1.234MHz
10242 adapter_khz 1234
10243 @end example
10244
10245
10246 @item @b{Win32 Pathnames} Why don't backslashes work in Windows paths?
10247
10248 OpenOCD uses Tcl and a backslash is an escape char. Use @{ and @}
10249 around Windows filenames.
10250
10251 @example
10252 > echo \a
10253
10254 > echo @{\a@}
10255 \a
10256 > echo "\a"
10257
10258 >
10259 @end example
10260
10261
10262 @item @b{Missing: cygwin1.dll} OpenOCD complains about a missing cygwin1.dll.
10263
10264 Make sure you have Cygwin installed, or at least a version of OpenOCD that
10265 claims to come with all the necessary DLLs. When using Cygwin, try launching
10266 OpenOCD from the Cygwin shell.
10267
10268 @item @b{Breakpoint Issue} I'm trying to set a breakpoint using GDB (or a front-end like Insight or
10269 Eclipse), but OpenOCD complains that "Info: arm7_9_common.c:213
10270 arm7_9_add_breakpoint(): sw breakpoint requested, but software breakpoints not enabled".
10271
10272 GDB issues software breakpoints when a normal breakpoint is requested, or to implement
10273 source-line single-stepping. On ARMv4T systems, like ARM7TDMI, ARM720T or ARM920T,
10274 software breakpoints consume one of the two available hardware breakpoints.
10275
10276 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} When erasing or writing LPC2000 on-chip flash, the operation fails at random.
10277
10278 Make sure the core frequency specified in the @option{flash lpc2000} line matches the
10279 clock at the time you're programming the flash. If you've specified the crystal's
10280 frequency, make sure the PLL is disabled. If you've specified the full core speed
10281 (e.g. 60MHz), make sure the PLL is enabled.
10282
10283 @item @b{Amontec Chameleon} When debugging using an Amontec Chameleon in its JTAG Accelerator configuration,
10284 I keep getting "Error: amt_jtagaccel.c:184 amt_wait_scan_busy(): amt_jtagaccel timed
10285 out while waiting for end of scan, rtck was disabled".
10286
10287 Make sure your PC's parallel port operates in EPP mode. You might have to try several
10288 settings in your PC BIOS (ECP, EPP, and different versions of those).
10289
10290 @item @b{Data Aborts} When debugging with OpenOCD and GDB (plain GDB, Insight, or Eclipse),
10291 I get lots of "Error: arm7_9_common.c:1771 arm7_9_read_memory():
10292 memory read caused data abort".
10293
10294 The errors are non-fatal, and are the result of GDB trying to trace stack frames
10295 beyond the last valid frame. It might be possible to prevent this by setting up
10296 a proper "initial" stack frame, if you happen to know what exactly has to
10297 be done, feel free to add this here.
10298
10299 @b{Simple:} In your startup code - push 8 registers of zeros onto the
10300 stack before calling main(). What GDB is doing is ``climbing'' the run
10301 time stack by reading various values on the stack using the standard
10302 call frame for the target. GDB keeps going - until one of 2 things
10303 happen @b{#1} an invalid frame is found, or @b{#2} some huge number of
10304 stackframes have been processed. By pushing zeros on the stack, GDB
10305 gracefully stops.
10306
10307 @b{Debugging Interrupt Service Routines} - In your ISR before you call
10308 your C code, do the same - artificially push some zeros onto the stack,
10309 remember to pop them off when the ISR is done.
10310
10311 @b{Also note:} If you have a multi-threaded operating system, they
10312 often do not @b{in the intrest of saving memory} waste these few
10313 bytes. Painful...
10314
10315
10316 @item @b{JTAG Reset Config} I get the following message in the OpenOCD console (or log file):
10317 "Warning: arm7_9_common.c:679 arm7_9_assert_reset(): srst resets test logic, too".
10318
10319 This warning doesn't indicate any serious problem, as long as you don't want to
10320 debug your core right out of reset. Your .cfg file specified @option{jtag_reset
10321 trst_and_srst srst_pulls_trst} to tell OpenOCD that either your board,
10322 your debugger or your target uC (e.g. LPC2000) can't assert the two reset signals
10323 independently. With this setup, it's not possible to halt the core right out of
10324 reset, everything else should work fine.
10325
10326 @item @b{USB Power} When using OpenOCD in conjunction with Amontec JTAGkey and the Yagarto
10327 toolchain (Eclipse, arm-elf-gcc, arm-elf-gdb), the debugging seems to be
10328 unstable. When single-stepping over large blocks of code, GDB and OpenOCD
10329 quit with an error message. Is there a stability issue with OpenOCD?
10330
10331 No, this is not a stability issue concerning OpenOCD. Most users have solved
10332 this issue by simply using a self-powered USB hub, which they connect their
10333 Amontec JTAGkey to. Apparently, some computers do not provide a USB power
10334 supply stable enough for the Amontec JTAGkey to be operated.
10335
10336 @b{Laptops running on battery have this problem too...}
10337
10338 @item @b{GDB Disconnects} When using the Amontec JTAGkey, sometimes OpenOCD crashes with the following
10339 error message: "Error: gdb_server.c:101 gdb_get_char(): read: 10054".
10340 What does that mean and what might be the reason for this?
10341
10342 Error code 10054 corresponds to WSAECONNRESET, which means that the debugger (GDB)
10343 has closed the connection to OpenOCD. This might be a GDB issue.
10344
10345 @item @b{LPC2000 Flash} In the configuration file in the section where flash device configurations
10346 are described, there is a parameter for specifying the clock frequency
10347 for LPC2000 internal flash devices (e.g. @option{flash bank $_FLASHNAME lpc2000
10348 0x0 0x40000 0 0 $_TARGETNAME lpc2000_v1 14746 calc_checksum}), which must be
10349 specified in kilohertz. However, I do have a quartz crystal of a
10350 frequency that contains fractions of kilohertz (e.g. 14,745,600 Hz,
10351 i.e. 14,745.600 kHz). Is it possible to specify real numbers for the
10352 clock frequency?
10353
10354 No. The clock frequency specified here must be given as an integral number.
10355 However, this clock frequency is used by the In-Application-Programming (IAP)
10356 routines of the LPC2000 family only, which seems to be very tolerant concerning
10357 the given clock frequency, so a slight difference between the specified clock
10358 frequency and the actual clock frequency will not cause any trouble.
10359
10360 @item @b{Command Order} Do I have to keep a specific order for the commands in the configuration file?
10361
10362 Well, yes and no. Commands can be given in arbitrary order, yet the
10363 devices listed for the JTAG scan chain must be given in the right
10364 order (jtag newdevice), with the device closest to the TDO-Pin being
10365 listed first. In general, whenever objects of the same type exist
10366 which require an index number, then these objects must be given in the
10367 right order (jtag newtap, targets and flash banks - a target
10368 references a jtag newtap and a flash bank references a target).
10369
10370 You can use the ``scan_chain'' command to verify and display the tap order.
10371
10372 Also, some commands can't execute until after @command{init} has been
10373 processed. Such commands include @command{nand probe} and everything
10374 else that needs to write to controller registers, perhaps for setting
10375 up DRAM and loading it with code.
10376
10377 @anchor{faqtaporder}
10378 @item @b{JTAG TAP Order} Do I have to declare the TAPS in some
10379 particular order?
10380
10381 Yes; whenever you have more than one, you must declare them in
10382 the same order used by the hardware.
10383
10384 Many newer devices have multiple JTAG TAPs. For example:
10385 STMicroelectronics STM32 chips have two TAPs, a ``boundary scan TAP'' and
10386 ``Cortex-M3'' TAP. Example: The STM32 reference manual, Document ID:
10387 RM0008, Section 26.5, Figure 259, page 651/681, the ``TDI'' pin is
10388 connected to the boundary scan TAP, which then connects to the
10389 Cortex-M3 TAP, which then connects to the TDO pin.
10390
10391 Thus, the proper order for the STM32 chip is: (1) The Cortex-M3, then
10392 (2) The boundary scan TAP. If your board includes an additional JTAG
10393 chip in the scan chain (for example a Xilinx CPLD or FPGA) you could
10394 place it before or after the STM32 chip in the chain. For example:
10395
10396 @itemize @bullet
10397 @item OpenOCD_TDI(output) -> STM32 TDI Pin (BS Input)
10398 @item STM32 BS TDO (output) -> STM32 Cortex-M3 TDI (input)
10399 @item STM32 Cortex-M3 TDO (output) -> SM32 TDO Pin
10400 @item STM32 TDO Pin (output) -> Xilinx TDI Pin (input)
10401 @item Xilinx TDO Pin -> OpenOCD TDO (input)
10402 @end itemize
10403
10404 The ``jtag device'' commands would thus be in the order shown below. Note:
10405
10406 @itemize @bullet
10407 @item jtag newtap Xilinx tap -irlen ...
10408 @item jtag newtap stm32 cpu -irlen ...
10409 @item jtag newtap stm32 bs -irlen ...
10410 @item # Create the debug target and say where it is
10411 @item target create stm32.cpu -chain-position stm32.cpu ...
10412 @end itemize
10413
10414
10415 @item @b{SYSCOMP} Sometimes my debugging session terminates with an error. When I look into the
10416 log file, I can see these error messages: Error: arm7_9_common.c:561
10417 arm7_9_execute_sys_speed(): timeout waiting for SYSCOMP
10418
10419 TODO.
10420
10421 @end enumerate
10422
10423 @node Tcl Crash Course
10424 @chapter Tcl Crash Course
10425 @cindex Tcl
10426
10427 Not everyone knows Tcl - this is not intended to be a replacement for
10428 learning Tcl, the intent of this chapter is to give you some idea of
10429 how the Tcl scripts work.
10430
10431 This chapter is written with two audiences in mind. (1) OpenOCD users
10432 who need to understand a bit more of how Jim-Tcl works so they can do
10433 something useful, and (2) those that want to add a new command to
10434 OpenOCD.
10435
10436 @section Tcl Rule #1
10437 There is a famous joke, it goes like this:
10438 @enumerate
10439 @item Rule #1: The wife is always correct
10440 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10441 @end enumerate
10442
10443 The Tcl equal is this:
10444
10445 @enumerate
10446 @item Rule #1: Everything is a string
10447 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10448 @end enumerate
10449
10450 As in the famous joke, the consequences of Rule #1 are profound. Once
10451 you understand Rule #1, you will understand Tcl.
10452
10453 @section Tcl Rule #1b
10454 There is a second pair of rules.
10455 @enumerate
10456 @item Rule #1: Control flow does not exist. Only commands
10457 @* For example: the classic FOR loop or IF statement is not a control
10458 flow item, they are commands, there is no such thing as control flow
10459 in Tcl.
10460 @item Rule #2: If you think otherwise, See Rule #1
10461 @* Actually what happens is this: There are commands that by
10462 convention, act like control flow key words in other languages. One of
10463 those commands is the word ``for'', another command is ``if''.
10464 @end enumerate
10465
10466 @section Per Rule #1 - All Results are strings
10467 Every Tcl command results in a string. The word ``result'' is used
10468 deliberately. No result is just an empty string. Remember: @i{Rule #1 -
10469 Everything is a string}
10470
10471 @section Tcl Quoting Operators
10472 In life of a Tcl script, there are two important periods of time, the
10473 difference is subtle.
10474 @enumerate
10475 @item Parse Time
10476 @item Evaluation Time
10477 @end enumerate
10478
10479 The two key items here are how ``quoted things'' work in Tcl. Tcl has
10480 three primary quoting constructs, the [square-brackets] the
10481 @{curly-braces@} and ``double-quotes''
10482
10483 By now you should know $VARIABLES always start with a $DOLLAR
10484 sign. BTW: To set a variable, you actually use the command ``set'', as
10485 in ``set VARNAME VALUE'' much like the ancient BASIC language ``let x
10486 = 1'' statement, but without the equal sign.
10487
10488 @itemize @bullet
10489 @item @b{[square-brackets]}
10490 @* @b{[square-brackets]} are command substitutions. It operates much
10491 like Unix Shell `back-ticks`. The result of a [square-bracket]
10492 operation is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything is a
10493 string}. These two statements are roughly identical:
10494 @example
10495 # bash example
10496 X=`date`
10497 echo "The Date is: $X"
10498 # Tcl example
10499 set X [date]
10500 puts "The Date is: $X"
10501 @end example
10502 @item @b{``double-quoted-things''}
10503 @* @b{``double-quoted-things''} are just simply quoted
10504 text. $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are expanded in place - the
10505 result however is exactly 1 string. @i{Remember Rule #1 - Everything
10506 is a string}
10507 @example
10508 set x "Dinner"
10509 puts "It is now \"[date]\", $x is in 1 hour"
10510 @end example
10511 @item @b{@{Curly-Braces@}}
10512 @*@b{@{Curly-Braces@}} are magic: $VARIABLES and [square-brackets] are
10513 parsed, but are NOT expanded or executed. @{Curly-Braces@} are like
10514 'single-quote' operators in BASH shell scripts, with the added
10515 feature: @{curly-braces@} can be nested, single quotes can not. @{@{@{this is
10516 nested 3 times@}@}@} NOTE: [date] is a bad example;
10517 at this writing, Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command.
10518 @end itemize
10519
10520 @section Consequences of Rule 1/2/3/4
10521
10522 The consequences of Rule 1 are profound.
10523
10524 @subsection Tokenisation & Execution.
10525
10526 Of course, whitespace, blank lines and #comment lines are handled in
10527 the normal way.
10528
10529 As a script is parsed, each (multi) line in the script file is
10530 tokenised and according to the quoting rules. After tokenisation, that
10531 line is immediately executed.
10532
10533 Multi line statements end with one or more ``still-open''
10534 @{curly-braces@} which - eventually - closes a few lines later.
10535
10536 @subsection Command Execution
10537
10538 Remember earlier: There are no ``control flow''
10539 statements in Tcl. Instead there are COMMANDS that simply act like
10540 control flow operators.
10541
10542 Commands are executed like this:
10543
10544 @enumerate
10545 @item Parse the next line into (argc) and (argv[]).
10546 @item Look up (argv[0]) in a table and call its function.
10547 @item Repeat until End Of File.
10548 @end enumerate
10549
10550 It sort of works like this:
10551 @example
10552 for(;;)@{
10553 ReadAndParse( &argc, &argv );
10554
10555 cmdPtr = LookupCommand( argv[0] );
10556
10557 (*cmdPtr->Execute)( argc, argv );
10558 @}
10559 @end example
10560
10561 When the command ``proc'' is parsed (which creates a procedure
10562 function) it gets 3 parameters on the command line. @b{1} the name of
10563 the proc (function), @b{2} the list of parameters, and @b{3} the body
10564 of the function. Not the choice of words: LIST and BODY. The PROC
10565 command stores these items in a table somewhere so it can be found by
10566 ``LookupCommand()''
10567
10568 @subsection The FOR command
10569
10570 The most interesting command to look at is the FOR command. In Tcl,
10571 the FOR command is normally implemented in C. Remember, FOR is a
10572 command just like any other command.
10573
10574 When the ascii text containing the FOR command is parsed, the parser
10575 produces 5 parameter strings, @i{(If in doubt: Refer to Rule #1)} they
10576 are:
10577
10578 @enumerate 0
10579 @item The ascii text 'for'
10580 @item The start text
10581 @item The test expression
10582 @item The next text
10583 @item The body text
10584 @end enumerate
10585
10586 Sort of reminds you of ``main( int argc, char **argv )'' does it not?
10587 Remember @i{Rule #1 - Everything is a string.} The key point is this:
10588 Often many of those parameters are in @{curly-braces@} - thus the
10589 variables inside are not expanded or replaced until later.
10590
10591 Remember that every Tcl command looks like the classic ``main( argc,
10592 argv )'' function in C. In JimTCL - they actually look like this:
10593
10594 @example
10595 int
10596 MyCommand( Jim_Interp *interp,
10597 int *argc,
10598 Jim_Obj * const *argvs );
10599 @end example
10600
10601 Real Tcl is nearly identical. Although the newer versions have
10602 introduced a byte-code parser and interpreter, but at the core, it
10603 still operates in the same basic way.
10604
10605 @subsection FOR command implementation
10606
10607 To understand Tcl it is perhaps most helpful to see the FOR
10608 command. Remember, it is a COMMAND not a control flow structure.
10609
10610 In Tcl there are two underlying C helper functions.
10611
10612 Remember Rule #1 - You are a string.
10613
10614 The @b{first} helper parses and executes commands found in an ascii
10615 string. Commands can be separated by semicolons, or newlines. While
10616 parsing, variables are expanded via the quoting rules.
10617
10618 The @b{second} helper evaluates an ascii string as a numerical
10619 expression and returns a value.
10620
10621 Here is an example of how the @b{FOR} command could be
10622 implemented. The pseudo code below does not show error handling.
10623 @example
10624 void Execute_AsciiString( void *interp, const char *string );
10625
10626 int Evaluate_AsciiExpression( void *interp, const char *string );
10627
10628 int
10629 MyForCommand( void *interp,
10630 int argc,
10631 char **argv )
10632 @{
10633 if( argc != 5 )@{
10634 SetResult( interp, "WRONG number of parameters");
10635 return ERROR;
10636 @}
10637
10638 // argv[0] = the ascii string just like C
10639
10640 // Execute the start statement.
10641 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[1] );
10642
10643 // Top of loop test
10644 for(;;)@{
10645 i = Evaluate_AsciiExpression(interp, argv[2]);
10646 if( i == 0 )
10647 break;
10648
10649 // Execute the body
10650 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[3] );
10651
10652 // Execute the LOOP part
10653 Execute_AsciiString( interp, argv[4] );
10654 @}
10655
10656 // Return no error
10657 SetResult( interp, "" );
10658 return SUCCESS;
10659 @}
10660 @end example
10661
10662 Every other command IF, WHILE, FORMAT, PUTS, EXPR, everything works
10663 in the same basic way.
10664
10665 @section OpenOCD Tcl Usage
10666
10667 @subsection source and find commands
10668 @b{Where:} In many configuration files
10669 @* Example: @b{ source [find FILENAME] }
10670 @*Remember the parsing rules
10671 @enumerate
10672 @item The @command{find} command is in square brackets,
10673 and is executed with the parameter FILENAME. It should find and return
10674 the full path to a file with that name; it uses an internal search path.
10675 The RESULT is a string, which is substituted into the command line in
10676 place of the bracketed @command{find} command.
10677 (Don't try to use a FILENAME which includes the "#" character.
10678 That character begins Tcl comments.)
10679 @item The @command{source} command is executed with the resulting filename;
10680 it reads a file and executes as a script.
10681 @end enumerate
10682 @subsection format command
10683 @b{Where:} Generally occurs in numerous places.
10684 @* Tcl has no command like @b{printf()}, instead it has @b{format}, which is really more like
10685 @b{sprintf()}.
10686 @b{Example}
10687 @example
10688 set x 6
10689 set y 7
10690 puts [format "The answer: %d" [expr $x * $y]]
10691 @end example
10692 @enumerate
10693 @item The SET command creates 2 variables, X and Y.
10694 @item The double [nested] EXPR command performs math
10695 @* The EXPR command produces numerical result as a string.
10696 @* Refer to Rule #1
10697 @item The format command is executed, producing a single string
10698 @* Refer to Rule #1.
10699 @item The PUTS command outputs the text.
10700 @end enumerate
10701 @subsection Body or Inlined Text
10702 @b{Where:} Various TARGET scripts.
10703 @example
10704 #1 Good
10705 proc someproc @{@} @{
10706 ... multiple lines of stuff ...
10707 @}
10708 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO someproc
10709 #2 Good - no variables
10710 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "this ; that;"
10711 #3 Good Curly Braces
10712 $_TARGETNAME configure -event FOO @{
10713 puts "Time: [date]"
10714 @}
10715 #4 DANGER DANGER DANGER
10716 $_TARGETNAME configure -event foo "puts \"Time: [date]\""
10717 @end example
10718 @enumerate
10719 @item The $_TARGETNAME is an OpenOCD variable convention.
10720 @*@b{$_TARGETNAME} represents the last target created, the value changes
10721 each time a new target is created. Remember the parsing rules. When
10722 the ascii text is parsed, the @b{$_TARGETNAME} becomes a simple string,
10723 the name of the target which happens to be a TARGET (object)
10724 command.
10725 @item The 2nd parameter to the @option{-event} parameter is a TCBODY
10726 @*There are 4 examples:
10727 @enumerate
10728 @item The TCLBODY is a simple string that happens to be a proc name
10729 @item The TCLBODY is several simple commands separated by semicolons
10730 @item The TCLBODY is a multi-line @{curly-brace@} quoted string
10731 @item The TCLBODY is a string with variables that get expanded.
10732 @end enumerate
10733
10734 In the end, when the target event FOO occurs the TCLBODY is
10735 evaluated. Method @b{#1} and @b{#2} are functionally identical. For
10736 Method @b{#3} and @b{#4} it is more interesting. What is the TCLBODY?
10737
10738 Remember the parsing rules. In case #3, @{curly-braces@} mean the
10739 $VARS and [square-brackets] are expanded later, when the EVENT occurs,
10740 and the text is evaluated. In case #4, they are replaced before the
10741 ``Target Object Command'' is executed. This occurs at the same time
10742 $_TARGETNAME is replaced. In case #4 the date will never
10743 change. @{BTW: [date] is a bad example; at this writing,
10744 Jim/OpenOCD does not have a date command@}
10745 @end enumerate
10746 @subsection Global Variables
10747 @b{Where:} You might discover this when writing your own procs @* In
10748 simple terms: Inside a PROC, if you need to access a global variable
10749 you must say so. See also ``upvar''. Example:
10750 @example
10751 proc myproc @{ @} @{
10752 set y 0 #Local variable Y
10753 global x #Global variable X
10754 puts [format "X=%d, Y=%d" $x $y]
10755 @}
10756 @end example
10757 @section Other Tcl Hacks
10758 @b{Dynamic variable creation}
10759 @example
10760 # Dynamically create a bunch of variables.
10761 for @{ set x 0 @} @{ $x < 32 @} @{ set x [expr $x + 1]@} @{
10762 # Create var name
10763 set vn [format "BIT%d" $x]
10764 # Make it a global
10765 global $vn
10766 # Set it.
10767 set $vn [expr (1 << $x)]
10768 @}
10769 @end example
10770 @b{Dynamic proc/command creation}
10771 @example
10772 # One "X" function - 5 uart functions.
10773 foreach who @{A B C D E@}
10774 proc [format "show_uart%c" $who] @{ @} "show_UARTx $who"
10775 @}
10776 @end example
10777
10778 @include fdl.texi
10779
10780 @node OpenOCD Concept Index
10781 @comment DO NOT use the plain word ``Index'', reason: CYGWIN filename
10782 @comment case issue with ``Index.html'' and ``index.html''
10783 @comment Occurs when creating ``--html --no-split'' output
10784 @comment This fix is based on: http://sourceware.org/ml/binutils/2006-05/msg00215.html
10785 @unnumbered OpenOCD Concept Index
10786
10787 @printindex cp
10788
10789 @node Command and Driver Index
10790 @unnumbered Command and Driver Index
10791 @printindex fn
10792
10793 @bye

Linking to existing account procedure

If you already have an account and want to add another login method you MUST first sign in with your existing account and then change URL to read https://review.openocd.org/login/?link to get to this page again but this time it'll work for linking. Thank you.

SSH host keys fingerprints

1024 SHA256:YKx8b7u5ZWdcbp7/4AeXNaqElP49m6QrwfXaqQGJAOk gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (DSA)
384 SHA256:jHIbSQa4REvwCFG4cq5LBlBLxmxSqelQPem/EXIrxjk gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
521 SHA256:UAOPYkU9Fjtcao0Ul/Rrlnj/OsQvt+pgdYSZ4jOYdgs gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:A13M5QlnozFOvTllybRZH6vm7iSt0XLxbA48yfc2yfY gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ECDSA)
256 SHA256:spYMBqEYoAOtK7yZBrcwE8ZpYt6b68Cfh9yEVetvbXg gerrit-code-review@openocd.org (ED25519)
+--[ED25519 256]--+
|=..              |
|+o..   .         |
|*.o   . .        |
|+B . . .         |
|Bo. = o S        |
|Oo.+ + =         |
|oB=.* = . o      |
| =+=.+   + E     |
|. .=o   . o      |
+----[SHA256]-----+
2048 SHA256:0Onrb7/PHjpo6iVZ7xQX2riKN83FJ3KGU0TvI0TaFG4 gerrit-code-review@openocd.zylin.com (RSA)